Quarterlytics / Healthcare / Medical - Devices / Cutera

Cutera

cutr · NASDAQ Healthcare
Claim this profile
Ticker cutr
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Healthcare
Industry Medical - Devices
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2021 Annual Report · Cutera
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Table of Contents

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

☒

☐

Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For fiscal year ended December 31, 2021
or

Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the transition period from ____ to ____
Commission file number: 000-50644

CUTERA, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware

(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)

77-0492262

(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

3240 Bayshore Blvd., Brisbane, California 94005
(Address of principal executive offices)

(415) 657-5500
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class

Trading Symbol(s)

Name of each exchange on which registered

Common Stock ($0.001 par value)

CUTR

The NASDAQ Stock Market, LLC

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☐ No x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ☐ No x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days. Yes x No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of
Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files).
Yes x No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, smaller reporting company, or an

emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth
company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer

☒ Accelerated filer

☐ Non-accelerated filer

☐ Smaller reporting company

☐ Emerging growth company

☐

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new

or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal

control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared
or issued its audit report. Yes x No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes ☐ No x

The aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock, held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of June 30, 2021 (which is the last business day of
registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter) based upon the closing price of such stock on the NASDAQ Global Select Market on June 30,
2021, was approximately $796 million.

The number of shares of Registrant’s common stock issued and outstanding as of February 22, 2022 was 18,060,261.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Part III incorporates by reference certain information from the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for the 2022 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, which
will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after December 31, 2021.

Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

PART I

Item 1.
Item 1A.

Item 1B.

Item 2.

Item 3.

Item 4.

PART II

Item 5.

Item 6.

Item 7.

Item 7A.

Item 8.

Item 9.

Item 9A.

Item 9B.
Item 9C.

PART III

Item 10.

Item 11.

Item 12.

Item 13.

Item 14.

PART IV

Item 15.

Item 16.

Business

Risk Factors

Unresolved Staff Comments

Properties

Legal Proceedings

Mine Safety Disclosures

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Reserved

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Controls and Procedures
Other Information
Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Executive Compensation

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
Principal Accounting Fees and Services

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

Form 10K Summary

2

Page

4

22

55

56

56

56

57

59

60

71

73

113

113

114
114

114

114

115

115

115

116

119

Table of Contents

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains “forward-looking statements” that involve risks and uncertainties. The Company’s actual results could differ
materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements. The statements contained in this report that are not purely historical are forward-looking
statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange
Act. Forward-looking statements are often identified by the use of words such as, but not limited to, “anticipate,” “believe,” “can,” “continue,” “could,”
“estimate,” “might,” “expect,” “intend,” “may,” “plan,” “project,” “seek,” “should,” “strategy,” “target,” “will,” “would” or variations of these terms and
similar expressions, or the negative of these terms or similar expressions intended to identify forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are
necessarily based on estimates and assumptions that, while considered reasonable by the Company and its management based on their knowledge and
understanding of the business and industry, are inherently uncertain. Forward-looking statements are subject to risks, uncertainties and other important
factors that could cause actual results and the timing of certain events to differ materially from future results expressed or implied by such forward-looking
statements. Factors that could cause or contribute to such differences include, but are not limited to, those identified below and those discussed in the section
titled “Risk Factors” included under Part I, Item 1A below. Furthermore, such forward-looking statements speak only as of the date of this report. Except as
required by law, the Company undertakes no obligation to update any forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date of such
statements.

The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the discussions included in Item
1A - Risk Factors, Item 7 - Management’s Discussion & Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and elsewhere in this Annual Report on
Form 10-K.

In this Annual Report on Form 10-K, unless the context otherwise requires, references to the “Company,” “Cutera,” “we,” “us” and “the Company’s” refers
to Cutera, Inc.

3

Table of Contents

PART I

ITEM 1.    BUSINESS

In this Annual Report on Form 10-K, “Cutera,” “the Company,” “we,” “us,” and “the Company’s” refer to Cutera, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries.

Company Background

Cutera was formed in 1988 as a Delaware corporation and is a global provider of laser and energy-based aesthetic systems for practitioners worldwide. The
Company  designs,  develops,  manufactures,  distributes,  and  markets  light  and  energy-based  product  platforms  for  use  by  physicians  and  other  qualified
practitioners  (collectively,  “practitioners”),  enabling  them  to  offer  safe  and  effective  aesthetic  treatments  to  their  customers.  In  addition,  the  Company
distributes  third-party  manufactured  skincare  products.  The  Company  currently  offers  easy-to-use  products  based  on  the  following  key  platforms:
enlighten®, enlighten SR®, excel® HR, excel® V, excel® V+, truSculpt® iD, truSculpt® flex, Secret PRO, Secret RF®, and xeo® — each of which enables
physicians and other qualified practitioners to perform safe and effective aesthetic procedures, including treatment for body contouring, skin resurfacing and
revitalization, tattoo removal, removal of benign pigmented lesions, vascular conditions, hair removal, and toenail fungus. The Company’s platforms are
designed to be easily upgraded to add additional applications and hand pieces, which provide flexibility for the Company’s customers as they expand their
practices.  The  Company’s  ongoing  research  and  development  activities  primarily  focus  on  developing  new  products  and  improving  and  enhancing  the
Company’s portfolio of existing products. The Company also explores ways to expand the Company’s product offerings through alternative arrangements
with other companies, such as distribution arrangements. The Company introduced Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization,
in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019 and truSculpt flex  in  June  2019,  Secret  PRO  in  July
2020,  and  a  product  extension  of  excel  V+  during  the  fourth  quarter  of  2020.  In  2021  the  Company  introduced  truSculpt  flex+,  a  treatment  mode  that
decreased the treatment time from approximately 45 minutes to 15 minutes.

TM

The Company’s trademarks include: "Cutera®," "AccuTip 500®," “CoolGlide®,” “CoolGlide excel®,” “enlighten®,” “excel HR®,” “excel V®,” “excel
V+®,” “LimeLight®,”  "MyQ®,"  “Pearl®,” “PICO Genesis®,” “ProWave 770®,”  “Solera®,”  “Titan®,”  “truSculpt®,”  “truSculpt  iD ,”  “truSculpt
flex
,”"Secret PRO,” “Secret RF®,” and “xeo®.” The Company’s logo and other trade names, trademarks, and service marks appearing in this document
are  the  Company’s  property.  Other  trade  names,  trademarks,  and  service  marks  appearing  in  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K  are  the  property  of  their
respective owners. Solely for convenience, the Company’s trademarks and trade names referred to in this Annual Report on Form 10-K appear without the
® or symbols, but those references are not intended to indicate, in any way, that the Company will not assert, to the fullest extent under applicable law, the
Company’s rights, or the right of the applicable licensor to these trademarks and trade names.

TM

A description of each of the Company’s devices and a summary of the features of the Company’s primary platforms are as follows:

•
Secret PRO  –  In  2020,  the  Company  expanded  its  distribution  of  the  Secret  PRO  device.  Secret  PRO  features  two  proven  technologies  –  RF
microneedling  and  fractional  CO .  Secret  PRO  utilizes  fractional  CO   for  skin  resurfacing  and  radio  frequency  microneedling  for  deep  dermal
remodeling.  The  pairing  of  technologies  provides  practitioners  the  ability  to  tailor  each  treatment  for  a  patients  individual  skin  concerns.  Used
individually or in combination for best outcomes with minimal downtime. Each time a procedure is performed, the physician must use a new handpiece
tip. The sale of the replacement tip results in recurring revenue.

2

2

•
truSculpt flex – In June 2019, the Company introduced the truSculpt flex for the muscle-sculpting market. This product is a bio-electrical muscle
stimulation device designed to strengthen, firm and tone the abdomen, buttocks and thighs, and can treat patients at all fitness levels. The truSculpt flex
delivers  Multi-Direction  Stimulation  with  truControl,  inducing  muscle  hypertrophy  and  hyperplasia.  Johari  Digital  Healthcare  Ltd.  (the  Company’s
contract manufacturing organization) received 510(k) clearance from the United States (“U.S.”) Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”) for muscle
conditioning in 2013. It is sold in the USA, Canada, Japan, certain Asia Pacific markets, and the European Union (“EU”) and is expected to be sold to a
broader international customer base upon required regulatory approvals. The truSculpt flex includes a consumable handpiece that needs to be "refilled"
after a set number of treatments are performed, resulting in recurring revenue. In 2021, the company introduced truSculpt flex+, a treatment mode that
decreased the treatment time from approximately 45 minutes to 15 minutes.

excel V+ – In February 2019, the Company introduced the excel V+, a new iteration of the excel V vascular platform originally introduced in 2011.

•
Excel V+, is a high-performance, vascular and benign pigmented lesion treatment platform

4

Table of Contents

explicitly designed for the market of dermatologists and plastic surgeons. The excel V+ has 50% more power than its predecessor and provides a greater
range of parameters for faster, more customizable treatments. The excel V and excel V+ are solid-state laser platforms providing a combination of the
532 nanometers (“nm”) green laser with 1064 nm Nd:YAG technology to provide a single, compact and efficient system that treats the entire range of
cosmetic vascular and benign pigmented lesion conditions. In Q4 of 2020, the Company introduced a product extension to its excel V+ platform, which
included  a  new,  1  mm  Dermastat  handpiece  and  expanded  specifications.  The  new  excel  V+,  expanded  treatment  capabilities  and  provided
dermatologists and aesthetic providers a higher level of precision and versatility for vascular and pigmented lesions. The excel V+ continues to boast
50% more power than its predecessor (excel V) and provides a greater range of parameters for faster, more customizable treatments. excel V+ is a solid-
state laser platform combining the 532 nanometers (“nm”) green laser with 1064 nm Nd:YAG technology to provide a single, compact and efficient
system that treats the entire range of cosmetic vascular and benign pigmented lesion conditions. The excel V+ device includes Cutera’s signature laser
genesis treatment, and introduced the ‘green genesis’ treatment – a micro-pulsed 532 treatment.

•
truSculpt iD  –  In  July  2018,  the  Company  introduced  a  hands-free  version  of  the  Company’s  truSculpt platform, the truSculpt iD, for the non-
surgical body sculpting market. It includes consumable cycles that need to be ordered by the practitioner after a set number of treatments are performed,
resulting  in  recurring  revenue.  This  product  is  a  high-powered  radio  frequency  (“RF”)  system  designed  for  circumferential  reduction,  lipolysis,  and
deep tissue heating and can treat all body and skin types. The truSculpt iD  delivers  targeted  energy  at  2  MHz,  causing  subcutaneous  adipose  tissue
lipolysis. The Company received 510(k) clearance from the FDA for lipolysis of abdominal fat in 2018. Prior truSculpt platforms include the truSculpt
3D, a 2 MHz device for tissue heating and circumferential reduction of fat in the abdomen and flank, and the original truSculpt platform launched in
August 2012 and delivered treatments at 1 MHz. In December 2016, the Company received 510(k) clearance from the FDA to market the truSculpt
platform for the temporary reduction in circumference of the abdomen. The truSculpt 3D includes a consumable handpiece that needs to be “refilled”
after a set number of treatments are performed, resulting in recurring revenue.

Secret RF – In January 2018, the Company introduced a new fractional RF microneedling device that delivers heat into the deeper layers of the
•
skin using controlled RF energy. The targeted energy revitalizes the tissue, via hemostasis, and coagulation of the tissue, minimizing downtime. Each
time a procedure is performed, the physician must use a new handpiece tip. The sale of the replacement tip results in recurring revenue. The Company
is the distributor of Secret RF.

enlighten – In December 2014, the Company introduced the enlighten laser platform with a dual wavelength (1064 nm + 532 nm). In December
•
2016, the Company introduced a three wavelength model (1064 nm + 532 nm + 670 nm), enlighten III. The enlighten system is a dual pulse duration
(750 picoseconds, or “ps,” and two nanoseconds, or “ns”) laser system cleared for multi-colored tattoo removal and the treatment of benign pigmented
lesions and acne scars. In 2018, the Company introduced an expanded performance enlighten III, and in April 2018, the Company introduced enlighten
SR, a lighter version of enlighten with reduced optical performance. Clinical studies were conducted to support an FDA clearance in October 2018 for
treatment  of  acne  scars  on  patients  with  Fitzpatrick  skin  types  II-V  when  used  with  the  PICO  Genesis  FX  Micro  Lens  Array  (“MLA”)  handpiece
attachment.

excel HR  –  In  June  2014,  the  Company  introduced  the  excel HR  platform,  a  premium  hair  removal  solution  for  all  skin  types,  combining  the

•
Company’s proven long-pulse 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser and a high-power 755 nm Alexandrite laser with sapphire contact cooling.

•
xeo  –  In  2003,  the  Company  introduced  the  xeo  platform,  which  combines  intense  pulsed  light  technology  with  laser  applications  in  a  single
system. The xeo is a multi-application platform on which a customer can purchase hand piece applications for the removal of unwanted hair, treatment
of vascular lesions, and skin revitalization by treating discoloration, fine lines, and laxity.

In addition to the above-mentioned primary systems, the Company generates revenue from the distribution of skincare products, which are manufactured by
ZO Skin Health, Inc. (“ZO”), and sold in the Japanese market. The Company also generates revenue from the sale of post-warranty services.

The Company offers its customers the ability to select the systems and applications that best fit their practice and subsequently upgrade their systems to add
new applications. This upgrade path allows the Company’s customers to cost-effectively build their aesthetic practices and provides the Company with a
source of incremental revenue.

The Market for Non-Surgical Aesthetic Procedures

The Company believes several factors are contributing to the global growth of aesthetic treatment procedures and aesthetic laser equipment sales, including:

5

Table of Contents

• Growing  Improvement  in  Economic  Environment,  Aesthetic  Accessibility,  and  Expanded  Practitioner  Base  –  The  improvements  in  overall
global economic conditions since the financial crisis of 2007-2008 have created an increased demand for aesthetic procedures, which has resulted in an
expanding practitioner base to satisfy the demand. An expanding practitioner base paired with digital and mobile advancements has led to a broader
range of accessibility options for potential patients.
•
Aging Demographics of Industrialized Countries – The aging population of industrialized countries, the amount of discretionary income available
to the “baby boomer” demographic segment ─ ages 57 to 75 as of 2021 ─ and their desire to retain a youthful appearance contribute to the increased
demand for aesthetic procedures. With millennials entering their 40's the demand and preference for non-invasive aesthetic treatments are also rising.
Millennials who are currently entering their 30's, including those in their 30's, have been earlier adopters of aesthetic treatments in comparison to older
generations.
•
Broader  Range  of  Safe  and  Effective  Treatments  –  Technical  developments  and  an  increase  in  treatable  conditions  due  to  new  product
introductions,  have  led  to  safe,  effective,  easy-to-use,  and  low-cost  treatments  with  fewer  side  effects,  resulting  in  broader  adoption  of  aesthetic
procedures  by  practitioners.  In  addition,  technical  advancements  enable  practitioners  to  offer  a  broader  range  of  treatments.  These  technical
developments reduce treatment and recovery times, leading to greater patient demand.
Broader Base of Customers – Managed care and government payor reimbursement restrictions motivate physicians to establish or expand their
•
elective aesthetic practices with procedures paid for directly by patients. As a result, in addition to core practitioners such as dermatologists and plastic
surgeons, many other practitioners, such as gynecologists, family practitioners, primary care physicians, physicians performing aesthetic treatments in
non-medical offices, and other qualified practitioners (“non-core practitioners”) expanded their practices to offer aesthetic procedures.
•
few years. This attracts a broader base of customers and patients seeking aesthetic procedures.
• Wide  Acceptance  of  Aesthetic  Procedures  and  Increased  Focus  on  Body  Image  and  Appearance  –  According  to  the  American  Society  for
Aesthetic  Plastic  Surgery  survey  in  2019,  both  surgical  and  non-surgical  procedures  increased  compared  to  2015.  Surgical  procedures  increased  by
6.2%, while non-surgical procedures increased by 13.3% over this four-year period.

Reductions in Cost per Procedure – Due partly to increased competition in the aesthetic market, the cost per procedure has decreased in the past

Non-Surgical Aesthetic Procedures for Improving the Body and/or Skin’s Appearance and Their Limitations

Many  alternative  therapies  are  available  for  improving  a  person’s  appearance  by  treating  specific  structures  within  the  skin.  These  procedures  utilize
injections or abrasive agents to reach different depths of the dermis and the epidermis. In addition, non-invasive and minimally invasive treatments have
been developed that employ laser and other energy-based technologies to achieve similar therapeutic results. Some of these common aesthetic procedures
and their limitations are described below.

Non-Invasive Body Contouring – Treatments for non-invasive body sculpting can be done utilizing a variety of technologies, including radio frequency,
laser, cooling, and ultrasound. Procedures address the reduction of unwanted fat on the abdomen, flanks, arms, thighs, submentum, and back and can require
one or more treatments. Systems with the ability to induce non-invasive lipolysis (breakdown of fat) offer a more permanent solution with an average fat
reduction of more than 20%. Common side effects of this approach may include paradoxical hyperplasia with cooling devices, and nodules which typically
resolve over time and the risk of burning the treatment area with radiofrequency devices. In June 2019, the Company introduced the truSculpt flex, a bio-
electrical muscle stimulation device designed to strengthen, firm, and tone the abdomen, buttocks, and thighs. In 2021 the Company introduced truSculpt
flex+, a treatment mode that decreased the treatment time from approximately 45 minutes to 15 minutes.

Tattoo removal – The most effective way to remove tattoos on the body is to utilize laser systems that deliver very short pulse durations with high peak
power in order to break up the ink particles that comprise tattoos.

The global tattoo removal market was valued at $122.8 million in 2019 and is projected to reach $219.0 million by 2026. According to market research,
people tend to remove their tattoos due to career choices, social conditions, personal situations, and more, which have been the key drivers for the tattoo
removal market. Despite the effectiveness of lasers for tattoo removal, common complaints concerning laser tattoo removal include a low rate of complete
clearance  (sometimes  no  better  than  50%  after  several  treatments)  as  well  as  the  high  number  of  treatments  for  satisfactory  clearance  (often  10  or  more
treatments spaced four to eight weeks apart). However, the latest generation of tattoo removal lasers produce picosecond pulse durations, (a trillionth of a
second) and thereby, can meaningfully improve tattoo clearance and reduce the total number of treatments. The Company introduced the enlighten system, a
dual pulse duration laser system, that was cleared for multi-colored tattoo removal.

Hair Removal – Techniques for hair removal include waxing, depilatories, tweezing, shaving, electrolysis, laser as well as other energy-based hair removal
modalities. The only techniques that provide a long-lasting solution are electrolysis, laser, and other

6

Table of Contents

energy-based technology such as Intense Pulsed Light (“IPL”). Electrolysis is usually painful, time-consuming and expensive for large areas, but is the most
common method for removing light-colored hair. During electrolysis, an electrologist inserts a needle directly into a hair follicle and activates an electric
current in the needle. Since electrolysis only treats one hair follicle at a time, the treatment of an area as small as an upper lip may require numerous visits
and many hours of treatment. In addition, electrolysis can cause blemishes and infection related to needle use. In comparison, lasers can quickly treat large
areas with a high degree of safety and efficacy. In 2003, the Company introduced the xeo system platform utilized for hair removal, which combines intense
pulse light technology with laser applications in a single system. In 2014, the Company introduced the excel HR platform, a premium hair removal solution
for all skin types, combining the Company’s proven long-pulse 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser and a high-power 755 nm Alexandrite laser with sapphire contact
cooling.

Skin Revitalization – Skin revitalization treatments include a broad range of popular alternatives, including Botox and collagen injections, chemical peels,
microdermabrasion, radio frequency treatment and laser and other energy-based treatments. With these treatments, patients hope to improve overall skin
tone and texture, reduce pore size, tighten skin and remove other signs of aging, including mottled pigmentation, diffuse redness and wrinkles. All of these
procedures  are  temporary  solutions  and  must  be  repeated  within  several  weeks  or  months  to  sustain  their  effect,  thereby  increasing  the  cost  and
inconvenience  to  patients.  For  example,  the  body  absorbs  Botox  and  collagen,  and  patients  require  supplemental  injections  every  three  to  six  months  to
maintain the benefits of these treatments.

Other skin revitalization treatments, such as chemical peels and microdermabrasion, can have undesirable side effects. Chemical peels use acidic or caustic
solutions to peel away the epidermis, and microdermabrasion generally utilizes sand crystals to resurface the skin. These techniques can lead to stinging,
redness, irritation and scabbing. In addition, more serious complications, such as changes in skin color, can result from deeper chemical peels.

With many modalities available today for skin revitalization and resurfacing, the Company has developed a range of clinically proven solutions uniquely
paired with a patient’s lifestyle and skin concerns, such as Secret PRO, which utilizes fractional CO  for skin resurfacing and radio frequency microneedling
for deep dermal remodeling and Secret RF, a novel fractional RF microneedling system for tissue coagulation and hemostasis designed to stimulate and
remodel collagen and address the common signs of aging.

2

RF Microneedling  –  Also  known  as  collagen  induction  therapy,  microneedling  is  a  minimally  invasive  revitalization  treatment  that  involves  using  fine
needles  to  create  hundreds  of  tiny,  invisible  puncture  wounds  in  the  top  layer  of  the  skin,  which  stimulates  the  body's  natural  wound  healing  processes,
resulting in cell turnover and increased collagen and elastin production via hemostasis and tissue coagulation. In January 2018, the Company introduced
Secret RF  product,  a  RF  fractional  microneedling  system.  In  2020,  the  Company  released  the  Secret PRO,  which  included  the  dual  modality  treatment
options of RF microneedling and CO  laser.

2

Leg  and  Facial  Veins  –  Current  aesthetic  treatment  methods  for  leg  and  facial  veins  include  sclerotherapy,  as  well  as  laser  and  other  energy-based
treatments. With these treatments, patients seek to eliminate visible veins, and improve overall skin appearance. Sclerotherapy requires a skilled practitioner
to inject a saline or detergent-based solution into the target vein, which breaks down the vessel causing it to collapse and be absorbed into the body. The
need to correctly position the needle on the inside of the vein makes it difficult to treat smaller veins, which limits the treatment of facial vessels and small
leg  veins.  In  2019,  the  Company  introduced  the  excel  V+,  a  high-performance,  vascular  and  benign  pigmented  lesion  treatment  platform  designed
specifically  for  the  core-market  of  dermatologists  and  plastic  surgeons,  which  treats  the  entire  range  of  cosmetic  vascular  and  benign  pigmented  lesion
conditions.

Laser and other energy-based non-surgical treatments for hair removal, veins, skin revitalization and body contouring are discussed in the following section.

Laser and Other Energy-Based Aesthetic Treatments

Laser  and  other  energy-based  aesthetic  treatments  can  achieve  therapeutic  results  by  affecting  structures  within  the  skin.  The  development  of  safe  and
effective aesthetic treatments has resulted in a well-established market for these procedures.
Practitioners can use laser and other energy-based technologies to selectively target hair follicles, veins, melanin as well as other chromophores within the
epidermis and dermis, without damaging surrounding tissue. Practitioners can also use these technologies to safely remove portions of the epidermis and
deliver heat to the dermis as a means of generating new collagen growth. Ablative skin resurfacing improves the appearance of the skin by removing the
outer layers of the skin. Ablative skin resurfacing procedures are considered invasive or minimally invasive, depending on how much of the epidermis is
removed during a treatment. Non-ablative skin resurfacing improves the appearance of the skin by treating the underlying structure of the skin.

Safe and effective laser and energy-based treatments require an appropriate combination of four parameters:

7

Table of Contents

Energy Level – the amount of light or radio frequency emitted to heat a target;
Pulse Duration – the time interval over which the energy is delivered;
Spot Size or Electrode Size – the diameter of the energy beam, which affects treatment depth and area; and

•
•
•
• Wavelength or Frequency – the position in the electromagnetic spectrum which impacts the absorption and the effective depth of the energy

delivered.

For example, in the case of hair removal, by utilizing the correct combination of these parameters, a practitioner can use a laser or other light source to
selectively  target  melanin  within  the  hair  follicle  to  absorb  the  laser  energy  and  destroy  the  follicle,  without  damaging  other  delicate  structures  in  the
surrounding tissue.

Technology and Design of the Company’s Systems

The  Company’s  enlighten,  excel,  Secret  PRO,  Secret  RF,  truSculpt  and  xeo  platforms  provide  the  long-lasting  benefits  of  laser  and  other  energy-  based
aesthetic  treatments.  The  Company’s  technology  allows  for  a  wide  variety  of  applications  in  a  single  system.  Key  features  of  the  Company’s  solutions
include:

• Multiple Applications Available in a Single System – Many of the Company’s platforms feature multiple-applications that enable practitioners to perform
a variety of aesthetic procedures using a single device. These procedures include hair removal, vascular treatments and skin revitalization, which address
discoloration, fine lines, and uneven texture. Because practitioners can use the Company’s systems for multiple indications, the investment in a unit is
spread across a greater number of patients and procedures, and the acquisition cost may be more rapidly recovered.

• Technology and Design Leadership –  The  Company’s  innovative  laser  technology  combines  multiple  wavelengths,  adjustable  energy  levels,  variable
spot sizes and a wide range of pulse durations, allowing practitioners to customize treatments for each patient and condition. The Company’s proprietary
pulsed  light  hand  pieces  for  the  treatment  of  discoloration,  hair  removal  and  vascular  treatments  optimize  the  wavelength  used  for  treatments  and
incorporate  a  monitoring  system  to  increase  safety.  The  Company’s  Titan  hand  piece  utilizes  a  novel  light  source  not  previously  used  for  aesthetic
treatments. The Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces, with proprietary YSGG technology, represent the first application of the 2790 nm
wavelength for minimally invasive cosmetic dermatology.

• Upgradeable  Platform  –  The  Company’s  xeo,  excel  V  and  trusculpt  flex  products  allow  the  Company’s  customers  to  upgrade  their  system  to  the
Company’s newest technologies or add new applications to their system, each of which provide the Company with a source of incremental revenue. The
Company  believes  that  product  upgradeability  allows  customers  to  take  advantage  of  the  Company’s  latest  product  offerings  and  provide  additional
treatment options to their patients, thereby expanding the opportunities for their aesthetic practices.

• Treatments for Broad Range of Skin Types and Conditions – For hair removal, the Company’s products are safe and effective on patients of all skin
types, including harder-to-treat patients with dark or tanned skin. In addition, the wide parameter range of the Company’s systems allows practitioners to
effectively treat patients with both fine and coarse hair. Practitioners may use the Company’s products to treat spider veins on the leg; to treat facial veins;
and  perform  skin  revitalization  procedures  for  discoloration,  texture,  fine  lines  and  wrinkles  on  any  type  of  skin.  The  ability  to  customize  treatment
parameters based on skin type enables practitioners to offer safe and effective therapies to a broad base of their patients.

• Ease of Use – The Company designs its products to be easy to use. The Company’s proprietary hand pieces are lightweight and ergonomic, minimize user
fatigue,  and  facilitate  clear  views  of  the  treatment  area,  reducing  the  possibility  of  unintended  damage  and  increasing  the  speed  of  application.  The
Company’s  control  console  contains  an  intuitive  user  interface  with  simple,  independently  adjustable  controls  from  which  to  select  a  wide  range  of
treatment parameters to suit each patient’s profile. For instance, the clinical navigation user interface on the xeo platform provides recommended clinical
treatment parameter ranges based on patient criteria entered. The Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces include a scanner with multiple scan
patterns to allow simple and fast treatments of the face. Finally, the Company’s truSculpt iD embodies the best of many of the above features. Unlike
other  body  sculpting  treatments  on  the  market  that  require  certain  body  types,  or  pinchable  fat,  truSculpt  iD  is  “body  agnostic”  with  the  ability  to
customize treatments to the patient's needs and body type. In addition, the Company’s proprietary algorithms and navigation enable the practitioner to
treat a 300cm  area in only 15 minutes.

2

Business Strategy

The Company’s goal is to maintain and expand its position as a leading worldwide provider of light and energy-based aesthetic devices and complementary
aesthetic products by executing the following strategies:

8

Table of Contents

• Continue  to  Expand  the  Company’s  Product  Offering  –  Though  the  Company  believes  that  its  current  portfolio  of  products  is  comprehensive,  the
Company’s research and development group has a pipeline of potential products under development. The Company launched excel V in 2011, truSculpt in
2012, ProWave LX  in  2013,  and  excel HR  and  enlighten  in  2014.  In  addition,  the  Company  continues  to  expand  offerings  on  the  Company’s  current
platforms  with  further  enhancement  such  as  the  enlighten  III  launched  in  2016,  truSculpt 3D  launched  in  2017,  enlighten SR  launched  in  April  2018,
truSculpt iD launched in July 2018, excel V+ launched in February 2019 and truSculpt flex launched in June 2019. The Company also introduced Secret
RF, in January 2018, and Secret PRO, a fractional CO  and RF microneedling device, in September 2020. In 2021, the company introduced  truSculpt
flex+, a treatment mode that decreased the treatment time from approximately 45 minutes to 15 minutes.

2

• Increase Revenue and Improve Productivity – The Company believes that the market for aesthetic systems will continue to offer growth opportunities.
The Company continues to build brand recognition, add additional products to the Company’s international distribution channels, and focus on enhancing
the Company’s global distribution network, all of which the Company expects will contribute to increased revenue.

• Increase Focus on Practitioners with Established Medical Offices –  The  Company  believes  there  is  growth  opportunity  in  targeting  the  Company’s
products to a broad customer base. The Company also believes that its customers’ success is largely dependent upon having an existing medical practice,
for which the Company’s systems provide incremental revenue sources to augment a customer’s existing practice revenue.

• Leverage the Company’s Installed Base – With the introduction of enlighten, excel V, excel HR and truSculpt, the Company is able to effectively offer
additional  platforms  into  the  existing  installed  base.  In  addition,  each  of  these  platforms  allows  for  potential  future  upgrades  that  offer  additional
capabilities.  The  Company  believes  this  program  aligns  the  Company’s  interest  in  generating  revenue  with  the  Company’s  customers’  interest  in
improving the return on their investment by expanding the range of treatments that can be performed in their practice.

• Generate Revenue from Services and Refillable, Consumable, Hand Pieces – The Company’s Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex cycle
and  pulsed-light  handpieces  are  refillable  products,  while  the  Company’s  single  use  disposable  tips  applicable  to  Secret  PRO,  and  Secret  RF  are
consumable  products.  Each  provides  the  Company  with  the  opportunity  to  participate  in  the  procedure-based  revenue  from  the  Company’s  existing
customers.  The  Company  offers  post-warranty  services  to  its  customers  either  through  extended  service  contracts  to  cover  preventive  maintenance  or
through direct billing for parts and labor. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of revenue.

• Generate Revenue from Skincare Products – The Company generates revenue from distribution of third party manufactured skincare products in Japan.

These skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and sold to licensed physicians and other end users.

Products

The Company’s enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Secret RF, truSculpt, and xeo platforms allow for the delivery of laser light and/or RF energy for aesthetic
applications from a single system. With the Company’s xeo platform, practitioners can purchase customized systems with a variety of the Company’s multi-
technology applications. Each of the Company’s products consists of a control console and one or more hand pieces, depending on the model.

9

Table of Contents

The following table lists the Company’s currently offered products. Each checked box represents the applications included in the product in the years noted.

Applications:

System
Platforms
xeo

Products
Nd:YAG
ProWave 770
AcuTip 500
Titan XL
LimeLight
Pearl
Pearl
Fractional
ProWave LX

excel V
truSculpt 
excel HR 
enlighten(dual wavelength)
enlighten III (MLA)
truSculpt 3D
Secret RF
truSculpt iD
truSculpt flex
excel V+
Secret PRO

EnergySources:

Year
2003
2005
2005
2006
2006
2007
2008

2013
2011
2012
2014
2014
2016
2017
2018
2018
2019
2019
2020

Energy
Source
(a)
(b)
(b)
(c)
(b)
(d)
(d)

(b)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(f)
(j)
(f)
(f)
(e)
(k)

Skin Revitalization

Noninvasive
Body
Contouring*

Hair
Removal
x
x

Vascular
Lesions
x

BPL’s
Dyschromia
& Melasma

Texture,
Lines and
Wrinkles
x

Acne
Scars

Tattoo
Removal

Lipolysis*

x

x

x

x

x

x
x

x

x

x
x
x

x

x
x
x

x

x
x

x

x

x

x
x**

x

x

x
x

x

x

x*
x*

1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
Visible and near-infrared Intense Pulsed Light;
Infrared Intense Pulsed Light;
2790 nm Er:YSGG laser;
Combined frequency-doubled 532 nm and 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
Radio frequency at 1 & 2 MHz – mono-polar
Combined 755 nm Alexandrite laser and 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
Dual wavelength 532 nm and 1064 nm Nd:YAG picosecond laser;
Three wavelength 532 nm, 670 nm, and 1064 nm Nd:YAG picosecond laser;
Radio frequency at 2 MHz mono-polar; and
Radio frequency at 2 MHz Bi-polar.

(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
* The Company’s CE Mark allows it to market truSculpt in the European Union, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for fat reduction,
body shaping and body  contouring.  In  the  U.S.  the  Company  has  510(k)  clearance  for  the  reduction  in  circumference  of  the  abdomen,  non-invasive
lipolysis (breakdown of fat) of  the  abdomen  and  elevating  tissue  temperature  for  the  treatment  of  selected  medical  conditions  such  as  relief  of  pain,
muscle spasms, increase in local circulation, and the temporary improvement in the appearance of cellulite.
**Via Hemostasis and Coagulation

Upgrades

The Company’s xeo, excel V and trusculpt flex products, are designed to allow customers to cost-effectively upgrade to the Company’s newest technologies
or add applications to their system, each of which provides the Company with a source of additional revenue.

10

Table of Contents

Extended Contract Services and Support

The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover parts and labor for terms of one to four years. The
Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for systems and detachable hand piece replacements. Revenue related to services performed on
a  time-and-materials  basis  is  recognized  when  performed.  These  post-warranty  services  serve  as  additional  sources  of  recurring  revenue  from  the
Company’s installed product base.

The  Company’s  products  are  engineered  to  enable  quick  and  efficient  service  and  support.  There  are  several  separate  components  of  the  Company’s
products, each of which can be removed and replaced. The Company believes that quick and effective delivery of service is important to its customers. As
of December 31, 2021, the Company had 40 Field Service employees.

In countries where the Company is represented by distribution partners, customers are serviced through the distributor. Distributors are generally provided
warranty coverage for parts only, with labor customarily provided to the end customer by the distributor. The Company’s Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD,
and truSculpt flex hand pieces generally include a warranty for a set number of shots, rather than for a period of time.

Training

Sales  of  systems  to  customers,  except  system  sales  through  distributors,  include  training  on  the  use  of  the  system  to  be  provided  within  180  days  of
purchase. Training is also sold separately from systems. The Company recognizes revenue for training once the training has been provided.

Consumables (Other accessories)

The Company treats its customers' purchases of replacement cycles for truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex, as well as replacement Titan and truSculpt 3D hand
pieces, as consumable revenue, which provides the Company with a source of recurring revenue from existing customers. The Secret RF and Secret PRO
products  have  single  use  disposable  tips,  which  must  be  replaced  after  every  treatment.  Sales  of  these  consumable  tips  further  enhance  the  Company’s
recurring revenue.

Applications and Procedures

The Company’s products are designed to allow the practitioner to select an appropriate combination of energy level, spot size and pulse duration for each
treatment.  The  ability  to  manipulate  the  combinations  of  these  parameters  allows  the  Company’s  customers  to  treat  the  broadest  range  of  conditions
available with a single energy-based system.

Non-Invasive Body Contouring –  The  Company’s  truSculpt  technology  allows  practitioners  to  apply  a  hand  piece  directly  to  the  skin  and  deliver  high-
powered RF energy that results in the deep and uniform heating of the subcutaneous fat tissue at sustained therapeutic temperatures. This heating can cause
selective destruction of fat cells, which are eliminated from the treatment area through the body’s natural wound healing processes. The treatment takes
approximately 15 minutes and two or more treatments may be required to obtain the desired aesthetic results. The Company’s CE Mark allows the Company
to market truSculpt in the EU, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for fat reduction, body shaping, body contouring and circumferential
reduction. In the U.S., truSculpt has 510(k) clearance for topical heating for the purpose of elevating tissue temperature for the treatment of selected medical
conditions, such as relief of pain and muscle spasms and increase in local circulation. Additionally, the 2 MHz setting for the 40 cm2 hand piece is indicated
for reduction in circumference of the abdomen and non-invasive lipolysis (breakdown of fat) of the abdomen. The truSculpt massage device is intended to
provide a temporary reduction in the appearance of cellulite.

Tattoo Removal – The Company’s enlighten systems, delivering picosecond or dual picosecond and nanosecond pulse durations are used for tattoo removal,
the treatment of benign pigmented lesions, and a laser skin toning procedure that the Company refers to as PICO Genesis.

Hair  Removal  –  The  Company  has  two  platforms,  excel  HR  and  xeo,  which  address  hair  removal  for  all  skin  types  as  well  as  hair  thicknesses.  The
Company’s xeo  platform  allows  practitioners  to  select  between  the  1064  nm  mode  for  darker,  course  hair,  and  the  ProWave LX  hand  piece  designed  to
address finer, vellus hair. Contact cooling is present on both hand pieces for epidermal protection. excel HR employs both a 1064 nm Nd:YAG as well as a
755 nm Alexandrite for hair removal. Like the xeo, the 1064 nm wavelength addresses darker, course hair while the 755 nm wavelength is used for finer,
lighter hair. Both wavelengths are transmitted through the same CoolView hand piece with spot sizes up to 18 mm for the 755 nm wavelength and up to 18
mm for the 1064 nm wavelength. The CoolView hand piece employs sapphire as a means of contact cooling – epidermal protection. Both platforms are
cleared for treating all skin types.

11

Table of Contents

Vascular Lesions – Both the Company’s xeo as well as excel V and excel V+ platforms are capable of treating a wide range of aesthetic vein conditions,
including spider and reticular veins, and small facial veins. xeo employs the LimeLight hand piece for addressing small veins as well as vascular lesions
while the Nd:YAG is appropriate for deeper, larger vessels. LimeLight is a fixed spot size IPL while the Nd:YAG has adjustable spot sizes up to 10mm. The
excel V and excel V+ devices are is a dual wavelength laser – 1064 nm and 532 nm – with adjustable spot sizes ranging from 2 mm to 12 mm for excel V
and 1 mm - 16 mm for the excel V+. The 532 nm and 1064 wavelength can be used to treat over 20 conditions ranging from small veins and vessels to a
variety  of  vascular  lesions.  For  both  of  these  devices,  patients  receive  on  average  between  one  and  six  treatments,  with  six  weeks  or  longer  between
treatments.

Skin Revitalization – The Company’s xeo, excel V, excel HR and enlighten platforms, utilizing an Nd:YAG laser, allow the Company’s customers to perform
non-invasive and minimally-invasive treatments that reduce redness, dyschromia, fine lines, improve skin texture, and treat other aesthetic conditions. When
using a 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser to improve skin texture and treat fine lines, cooling is not applied and the hand piece is held directly above the skin. A large
number of pulses are directed at the treatment site, repeatedly covering an area, such as the cheek. By delivering many pulses of laser light to a treatment
area, a gentle heating of the dermis occurs and collagen growth is stimulated to rejuvenate the skin and reduce wrinkles. Patients typically receive four to six
treatments for this procedure. The treatment typically takes less than a half hour with a spacing of two to four weeks between treatments. Skin revitalization
was expanded with introduction of 'green genesis', a micro-pulsed 532 nm treatment on the excelV+.

Texture, Lines and Wrinkles – The xeo platform can address fine lines and wrinkles using the Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces. When treating fine
lines, texture and wrinkles with a Pearl hand piece, the hand piece is held at a controlled distance from the skin and the scanner delivers a preset pattern of
spots to the treatment area. Cooling is not applied to the epidermis during the treatment. The energy delivered by the hand piece ablates a portion of the
epidermis while leaving a coagulated portion that will gently peel off over the course of a few days. Heat is also delivered into the dermis, which can result
in  the  production  of  new  collagen.  Treatment  of  the  full  face  can  usually  be  performed  in  approximately  15  to  30  minutes.  Patients  receive  on  average
between one and three treatments at monthly intervals.

Additionally, the Company’s Secret RF and Secret PRO platforms feature Radio Frequency microneedling device that employs fractionated RF energy (2
MHz) delivered at different pre-programmed depths in the dermis to produce new collagen. The Secret devices come with four treatment tips: a 25-pin tip,
both insulated and semi-insulated, and a semi-insulated 64-pin tip. The treatment has minimal side effects, negligible downtime and results in improved skin
tone and texture as well as improvement in acne scars.

Dyschromia –  The  Company’s  pulsed-light  technologies  allow  the  Company’s  customers  to  safely  and  effectively  treat  red  and  brown  dyschromia  (skin
discoloration), benign pigmented lesions, and rosacea. The practitioner delivers a narrow spectrum of light to the surface of the skin through the Company’s
LimeLight  hand  pieces.  These  hand  pieces  include  one  of  the  Company’s  proprietary  wavelength  filters,  which  reduce  the  energy  level  required  for
therapeutic effect and minimize the risk of skin injury.

The 532 nm wavelength green laser option of the excel V and enlighten systems, as well as the 755 nm infrared wavelength of the excel HR, can be used to
treat benign pigmented lesions in substantially the same way.

In treating benign pigmented lesions, the hand piece is placed directly on the skin and then the pulse is triggered. The cells forming the pigmented lesion
absorb  the  light  energy,  darken  and  then  flake  off  over  the  course  of  two  to  three  weeks.  Several  treatments  may  be  required  to  completely  remove  the
lesion. The treatment takes a few minutes per area treated and there are typically three to four weeks between treatments.

Practitioners can also treat dyschromia and other skin conditions with the Company’s Pearl hand piece. During these treatments, the heat delivered by the
Pearl hand piece will remove the outer layer of the epidermis while coagulating a portion of the epidermis. That coagulated portion will gently peel off over
the course of a few days, revealing a new layer of skin underneath. Treatment of the full face can usually be performed in 15 to 30 minutes. Patients receive
on average between one and three treatments at monthly intervals.

Skin Quality – The Company’s Titan technology allows the Company’s customers to use deep dermal heating to tighten lax skin. The practitioner delivers a
spectrum of light to the skin through the Company’s Titan hand piece. This hand piece includes the Company’s proprietary light source and wavelength
filter which tailors the delivered spectrum of light to provide heating at the desired depth in the skin.

In treating compromised skin, the hand piece is placed directly on the skin and then the light pulse is triggered. A sustained pulse causes significant heating
in the dermis. This heating can cause immediate collagen contraction while also stimulating

12

Table of Contents

long-term collagen regrowth. Several treatments may be required to obtain the desired degree of tightening of the skin. The treatment of a full face can take
over an hour and there are typically four weeks between treatments.

The Company’s CE Mark allows the Company to market the Titan in the EU, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for the treatment of
wrinkles through skin tightening. However, in the U.S. the Company has a 510(k) clearance only for deep dermal heating.

Sales and Marketing

The  Company  markets,  sells,  and  services  the  Company’s  products  through  direct  sales  and  service  employees  in  North  America  (including  Canada),
Australia, Austria, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, the Netherlands, Spain, Switzerland and the United Kingdom. International sales and
services outside of these direct markets are made through a network of distributors in over 42 countries, as well as a direct international sales force. The
Company internally manages its U.S. and Canadian sales organization as one North American sales region.

The  Company  also  sells  certain  items  like  hand  piece  refills,  cycle  refills,  consumable  tips,  and  marketing  brochures  through  the  Company’s  web  site
www.mycutera.com.

Customers generally demand quality, performance, ease of use and high productivity in relation to the cost of ownership. The Company responds to these
customer demands by introducing new products focused on these requirements in the markets it serves. Specifically, the Company believes it introduces
new  products  and  applications  that  are  innovative,  address  the  specific  aesthetic  procedures  in  demand,  and  are  upgradeable  on  its  customers’  existing
systems. In addition, the Company provides attractive upgrade pricing to new product families. To increase market penetration, the Company also markets
to non-core practitioners in addition to the Company’s core specialties of plastic surgeons and dermatologists.

The Company seeks to establish strong ongoing relationships with its customers through the upgradeability of the Company’s products, sales of extended
service  contracts,  hand  piece  refills  and  replacement  disposable  tips,  ongoing  training  and  support,  and  by  distributing  skincare  products  in  Japan.  The
Company primarily targets its marketing efforts to practitioners through office visits, workshops, trade shows, webinars and trade journals. The Company
also markets to potential patients through brochures, workshops and its website. In addition, the Company offers clinical forums with recognized expert
panelists to promote advanced treatment techniques using the Company’s products to further enhance customer loyalty and uncover new sales opportunities.

Competition

The industry in which the Company operates is subject to intense competition. The Company’s products compete against conventional non-energy-based
treatments, such as electrolysis, Botox and collagen injections, chemical peels, microdermabrasion and sclerotherapy. The products also compete against
laser  and  other  energy-based  products  offered  by  other  public  companies,  such  as  Abbvie  (acquired  Allergan  and  its  division  Zeltiq),  Bausch  Health
(formerly  Valeant  Pharmaceuticals),  Vieve,  Soliton,  InMode  and  Lutronic,  as  well  as  private  companies,  including  Sisram,  Candela  (formerly  Syneron
Candela,  acquired  in  2017  by  an  affiliate  of  private  equity  funds  advised  by  Apax  Partners),  Sciton,  BTL  Industries  and  several  others.  In  late  2019,
Clayton, Dubilier & Rice entered into an agreement under which its managed funds acquired Cynosure, LLC, a leader in medical aesthetics systems and
technologies, from Hologic, Inc. Cynosure develops, manufactures, and markets medical aesthetic treatment systems for dermatologists, plastic surgeons,
medical spas and other healthcare practitioners, with sales and distribution worldwide. In early 2020, the affiliated private equity funds of Baring Private
Equity  Asia  completed  the  acquisition  of  Lumenis,  a  provider  of  specialty  energy-based  medical  devices  across  the  fields  of  aesthetics,  urology,
ophthalmology, ENT and gynecology, with an international presence.

Competition  among  providers  of  laser  and  other  energy-based  devices  for  the  aesthetic  market  is  characterized  by  extensive  research  and  development
efforts, and innovative technology. While the Company attempts to protect its products through patents and other intellectual property rights, there are few
barriers to entry that would prevent new entrants or existing competitors from developing products that would compete directly with the Company. There
are  many  companies,  both  public  and  private,  that  are  developing  devices  that  use  both  energy-based  and  alternative  technologies.  Some  of  these
competitors  have  greater  resources  than  the  Company  does  or  product  applications  for  certain  sub-markets  in  which  the  Company  does  not  participate.
Additional competitors may enter the market, and the Company is likely to compete with new companies in the future. To compete effectively, the Company
has to demonstrate that the Company’s products are attractive alternatives to other devices and treatments by differentiating the Company’s products on the
basis of performance, brand name, service and price. The Company has encountered, and expects to continue to encounter, potential customers who, due to
existing relationships with the Company’s competitors, are committed to, or prefer, the products offered by these competitors. Competitive pressures may
result in price reductions and reduced margins for the Company’s products.

13

Table of Contents

The Company also sells skincare products in Japan under the exclusive distribution agreement with ZO which granted the Company the exclusive right to
promote, market, sell, and distribute the products produced by ZO in Japan. ZO’s skincare products compete against other Physician-dispensed skincare
brands developed and marketed by other companies, such as Environ, Navision and Revision Skincare, among others.

Research and Development

The  Company  focuses  its  research  and  development  efforts  on  innovation  and  improvement  for  products  and  services  that  align  with  its  mission.  The
Company  consistently  strives  to  understand  its  customers’  expectations  for  total  excellence.  The  Company  accomplishes  this  by  its  commitment  to
continuous improvement in design, manufacturing, and service, which the Company believes provides for superior products and services to ensure on going
customer satisfaction, trust and loyalty. The Company seeks to comply with all applicable domestic and international regulations to maintain the highest
quality.

The Company’s research and development activities are conducted by employees with a broad base of experience in lasers, optoelectronics, software, and
other  related  disciplines.  The  Company  develops  working  relationships  with  outside  contract  engineering  and  design  consultants,  giving  the  Company’s
team additional technical and creative breadth. The Company works closely with thought leaders and customers, to understand unmet needs and emerging
applications in aesthetic medicine.

Acquisitions, Investments, and Distribution Agreements

The Company’s strategy of providing a broad range of therapeutic capabilities requires a wide variety of technologies, products, and capabilities. The rapid
pace  of  technological  development  in  the  aesthetic  device  industry  and  the  specialized  expertise  required  in  different  areas  make  it  challenging  for  the
Company to develop a broad portfolio of technological solutions. In addition to internally generated growth through research and development efforts, the
Company has considered, and expects to continue to consider, acquisitions, investments, and distribution agreements to provide access to new products and
technologies in both new and existing markets.

The Company expects to further the Company’s strategic objectives and strengthen its existing businesses by making future acquisitions and investments, or
by  entering  into  new  distribution  agreements  in  areas  that  the  Company  believes  it  can  acquire  or  stimulate  the  development  of  new  technologies  and
products.  Mergers  and  acquisitions  of  medical  technology  companies,  as  well  as  distribution  relationships,  are  inherently  risky  and  no  assurance  can  be
given that any acquisition will be successful or will not materially adversely affect the Company’s consolidated operations, financial condition and cash
flows.

Manufacturing

The  Company  manufactures  its  products  with  components  and  subassemblies  supplied  by  vendors  and  assembles  and  tests  each  of  its  products  at  the
Brisbane, California facility, and at third party contract manufacturers’ facilities. Quality control, cost reduction and inventory management are top priorities
of the manufacturing operations.

The  Company  purchases  certain  components,  subassemblies,  and  assembled  systems  from  a  limited  number  of  suppliers.  All  Secret  RF  systems  are
manufactured by Ilooda Co. Ltd, who also manages all related regulatory activities. The Company has flexibility with its suppliers to adjust the number of
components  and  subassemblies  as  well  as  the  delivery  schedules.  The  forecasts  are  based  on  historical  demands  and  sales  projections.  Lead  times  for
components  and  subassemblies  may  vary  significantly  depending  on  the  size  of  the  order,  time  required  to  fabricate  and  test  the  components  or
subassemblies, specific supplier requirements and current market demand for the components and subassemblies. The potential for disruption of supply is
reduced by maintaining sufficient inventories and identifying additional suppliers. The time required to qualify new suppliers for some components, or to
redesign them, could cause delays in the Company’s manufacturing. To date, the Company has not experienced significant delays in obtaining any of its
components or subassemblies.

Patents and Proprietary Technology

The Company relies on a combination of patent, copyright, trademark and trade secret laws, and non-disclosure, confidentiality, and invention assignment
agreements to protect the Company’s intellectual property rights. As of January 19, 2022, the Company had 28 issued and unexpired U.S. patents, eight
pending U.S. patent applications, and four pending international applications under the Patent Cooperation Treaty (PCT). The Company intends to file for
additional  patents  and  trademarks  to  continue  to  strengthen  the  Company’s  intellectual  property  rights.  Patents  typically  have  a  20-year  term  from  the
application filing date. There can be no assurance that pending patent applications will result in the issuance of patents, that patents issued to or licensed by
the  Company  will  not  be  challenged  or  circumvented  by  competitors,  or  that  these  patents  will  be  found  to  be  valid  or  sufficiently  broad  to  protect  the
Company’s technology or to provide the Company with a competitive advantage.

14

Table of Contents

The  Company  has  also  obtained  certain  trademarks  and  trade  names  for  the  Company’s  products  and  maintain  certain  details  about  the  Company’s
processes, products, and strategies as trade secrets. In the U.S. and several foreign countries, the Company registers its Company name and certain of its
product names as trademarks, including Cutera, AcuTip, CoolGlide, CoolGlide excel, enlighten, excel V+, LimeLight, myQ, Pearl, PICO Genesis, ProWave
770, truSculpt, truSculpt iD, truSculpt flex, Secret PRO, SecretRF, and xeo. The Company may have common law rights in other product names, including
excel V, Solera, Titan and excel HR. The Company intends to file for additional trademarks to continue to strengthen the Company’s intellectual property
rights.

The Company relies on non-disclosure and non-competition agreements with employees, technical consultants, and other parties to protect, in part, trade
secrets  and  other  proprietary  technology.  The  Company  also  requires  them  to  agree  to  disclose  and  assign  to  the  Company  all  inventions  conceived  in
connection with the relationship. There can be no assurance that these agreements will not be breached, that the Company will have adequate remedies for
any  breach,  that  others  will  not  independently  develop  equivalent  proprietary  information  or  that  third  parties  will  not  otherwise  gain  access  to  the
Company’s trade secrets and proprietary knowledge.

For additional information, please refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, under the section entitled “Risk Factors - Intellectual
property  rights  may  not  provide  adequate  protection  for  some  or  all  of  the  Company’s  products,  which  may  permit  third  parties  to  compete  against  the
Company more effectively, and the Company may be involved in future costly intellectual property litigation, which could impact the Company’s future
business and financial performance.”

Government Regulation

United States

The Company’s products are medical devices subject to regulation by numerous government agencies, including the FDA and counterpart agencies outside
the U.S. To varying degrees, each of these agencies require the Company to comply with laws and regulations governing the research, development, testing,
manufacturing,  labeling,  pre-market  clearance  or  approval,  marketing,  distribution,  advertising,  promotion,  record  keeping,  reporting,  tracking,  and
importing and exporting of medical devices. In the U.S., FDA regulations govern the following activities that the Company performs and will continue to
perform to ensure that medical products distributed domestically or exported internationally are safe and effective for their intended uses:

• product design and development;
• product testing;
• product manufacturing;
• product safety;
• product labeling;
• product storage;
• record keeping;
• pre-market clearance or approval;
• advertising and promotion;
• production;
• product sales and distribution; and
• complaint handling.

FDA’s Pre-market Clearance Requirements

Unless an exemption applies, each medical device the Company wishes to commercially distribute in the U.S. will require either prior 510(k) clearance, or
de novo approval from the FDA. The FDA classifies medical devices into one of three classes. Devices deemed to pose lower risks are placed in either
Class I or II. For Class II, the manufacturer must submit to the FDA a pre-market notification requesting permission to commercially distribute the device.
This process is known as 510(k) clearance. Some low risk devices are exempted from this requirement. Devices deemed by the FDA to pose the greatest
risk, such as life-sustaining, life-supporting or implantable devices, or devices deemed not substantially equivalent to a previously cleared 510(k) device, are
placed in Class III, requiring more rigorous pre-market approval. All of the Company’s current products are Class II devices.

510(k) Clearance Pathway

When 510(k) clearance is required, the Company must submit a pre-market notification demonstrating that the Company’s proposed device is substantially
equivalent to a previously cleared 510(k) device or a device that was in commercial distribution before May 28, 1976 for which the FDA has not yet called
for the submission of Pre-Market Approval, or "PMA", applications.

15

Table of Contents

By regulation, the FDA is required to clear or deny 510(k), pre-market notification within 90 days of submission of the application. As a practical matter,
clearance may take significantly longer, as FDA may require additional information. Laser devices used for aesthetic procedures, such as hair removal, have
generally qualified for clearance under 510(k) procedures.

16

Table of Contents

The following table details the indications for which the Company received a 510(k) clearance for the Company’s products and when these clearances were
received.
FDA Marketing Clearances:
Laser-based products:
- treatment of vascular lesions
- hair removal
- permanent hair reduction
- treatment of benign pigmented lesions and pseudo folliculitis barbae, commonly referred to as razor bumps, and for the
reduction of red pigmentation in scars
- treatment of wrinkles

March 2000
January 2001
June 2002

Date Received:

October 2002

June 1999

- treatment to increase clear nail in patients with onychomycosis
- expanded spot size to 5 mm for clear nail in patients with onychomycosis
- addition of Alexandrite 755 nm laser wavelength for hair removal, permanent hair reduction, treatment of vascular, benign
pigmented lesions and treatment of wrinkles

- addition of treatment of mild to moderate inflammatory acne vulgaris

- enlighten picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for the treatment of benign pigmented lesions
- enlighten picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for multi-colored tattoo removal
- enlighten III picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for multi-colored tattoo removal and treatment of benign pigmented
lesion and picosecond 670 nm for benign pigmented lesions
- enlighten III higher performance specifications for 532/1064 nm; addition of nanosecond mode for 670nm
- enlighten III addition of tattoo removal for lighter colored inks (green and blue) for 670 nm

- enlighten Micro Lens Array (MLA) for treatment of acne scars

Pulsed-light technologies:

- treatment of pigmented lesions
 - hair removal and vascular treatments

Infrared Titan technology for deep dermal heating for the temporary relief of minor muscle and joint pain and for the temporary

increase in local circulation where applied

Solera tabletop console:

- for use with the Titan hand piece
- for use with the Company’s pulsed-light hand pieces

Pearl product for the treatment of wrinkles

Pearl Fractional product for skin resurfacing and coagulation

truSculpt radio frequency product:

- for topical heating to elevate tissue temperature for the treatment of selected medical conditions such as relief of pain and
muscle spasms and increase in local circulation; massage device for temporary reduction in the appearance of cellulite
- Temporary reduction in circumference of the abdomen
- Reduction in circumference of the abdomen
- truSculpt 3D and iD: For non-invasive lipolysis of the abdomen and for reduction in circumference of the abdomen
- truSculpt flex: for improvement of abdominal tone, strengthening of abdominal muscles, and development of firmer
abdomen; and strengthening, toning, and firming of buttocks and thighs

17

April 2011
May 2013
December 2013

March 2016
August 2014

November 2014
October 2016

April 2016
October 2017

December 2018

March 2003

March 2005

February 2004

October 2004

January 2005

March 2007

August 2008

April 2008

December 2016
August 2017

June 2018
June 2019

 
Table of Contents

Product Modifications

Pursuant to FDA regulations, after a device receives 510(k) clearance, any modification that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness, or that
would constitute a major change in its intended use, labeling and biocompatibility, requires a new clearance. The FDA requires manufacturers to make this
determination  initially,  but  the  FDA  can  review  any  such  decision  and  may  disagree  with  a  manufacturer’s  determination.  To  date,  the  Company  has
modified  aspects  of  the  Company’s  products  after  receiving  regulatory  clearance  and  determined  that  new  510(k)  clearances  are  not  required  for  these
modifications. If the FDA disagrees with the Company’s determination not to seek a new 510(k) clearance, the FDA may retroactively require the Company
to seek 510(k) clearance.

Clinical Trials

When FDA approval of a Class II device requires human clinical trials, only approval from the Institutional Review Board (“IRB”) is required to proceed
with the planned and IRB approved clinical trial/study.

The Company is required to manufacture the Company’s products in compliance with the FDA’s Quality System Regulation (“QSR”) and the international
quality management standard for medical systems ISO 13485:2016. The QSR and ISO 13485 cover the methods and documentation of the design, testing,
control,  manufacturing,  labeling,  quality  assurance,  packaging,  storage  and  shipping  of  the  Company’s  products.  Since  2017,  the  Company  has  been
enrolled  in  the  Medical  Device  Single  Audit  Program  (“MDSAP”).  The  MDSAP  allows  a  single  audit  of  a  medical  device  manufacturer’s  Quality
Management System (“QMS”), which satisfies the requirements of five regulatory jurisdictions (FDA - US, Health Canada - Canada, Therapeutic Goods
Administration  (“TGA”)  -  Australia,  Pharmaceuticals  and  Medical  Devices  Agency  (“PMDA”)  -  Japan,  and  Agência  Nacional  de  Vigilancia  Sanitária
(“ANVISA”)  -  Brazil);  and  for  the  EU  under  Europäische  Norm  (“EN”)  International  Standards  Organization  (“ISO”)  13485:2016  and  Medical  Device
Directive (MDD)/EU Medical Device Regulation MDR”).

MDSAP re-certification occurs every three years with a surveillance audit taking place annually. Major findings during these audits or an increase in field
reportable  events  could  trigger  regulatory  enforcement  action  including  by  the  FDA.  The  Company’s  manufacturing  facility  is  ISO  13485  certified.  The
Company  had  a  successful  MDSAP  re-certification  audit  in  January  2021.  There  were  no  significant  findings  or  observations  as  a  result  of  this  audit.
However,  the  Company’s  failure  to  maintain  compliance  with  the  QSR  requirements  could  result  in  the  shutdown  of  the  Company’s  manufacturing
operations and the recall of the Company’s products, which would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business. In the event that one of the
Company’s  suppliers  fails  to  maintain  compliance  with  specified  quality  requirements,  the  Company  may  have  to  qualify  a  new  supplier  and  could
experience  manufacturing  delays  as  a  result.  The  Company  has  opted  to  maintain  quality  assurance  and  quality  management  certifications  to  enable  the
Company  to  market  the  Company’s  products  in  the  U.S.,  the  member  states  of  the  EU,  the  European  Free  Trade  Association  and  countries  which  have
entered into Mutual Recognition Agreements with the EU.

Pervasive and Continuing Regulation

After a device is placed on the market, numerous regulatory requirements apply. These include:

• Quality system regulations, which require manufacturers, including third-party manufacturers, to follow stringent design, testing, control, documentation

and other quality assurance procedures during all aspects of the manufacturing process;

• Labeling regulations and FDA prohibitions against the promotion of products for un-cleared, unapproved or “off-label” uses;
• Medical device reporting regulations, which require that manufacturers report to the FDA if their device may have caused or contributed to a death or

serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that would likely cause or contribute to a death or serious injury if the malfunction were to recur; and

• Post-market surveillance regulations, which apply when necessary to protect the public health or to provide additional safety and effectiveness data for the

device.

The FDA has broad post-market and regulatory enforcement powers. The Company is subject to unannounced inspections by the FDA and the Food and
Drug Branch of the California Department of Health Services (or “CDHS”), to determine the Company’s compliance with the QSR and other applicable
regulations, which may include the manufacturing facilities of the Company’s subcontractors. In the past, the Company’s current manufacturing facility has
been inspected by the FDA and the CDHS. The FDA and the CDHS noted observations, but there were no findings that involved a material violation of
regulatory requirements. The Company’s responses to those observations have been accepted by the FDA and CDHS.

The Company is also regulated under the Radiation Control for Health and Safety Act, which requires laser products to comply with performance standards,
including design and operation requirements, and manufacturers to certify in product labeling and in reports to the FDA that their products comply with all
such standards. The regulations also require laser manufacturers to file

18

Table of Contents

new product and annual reports, maintain manufacturing, testing and sales records, and report product defects. Various warning labels must be affixed and
certain protective devices installed, depending on the class of the product.

Failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in enforcement action by the FDA, which may include any of the following sanctions:

• Warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
• Repair, replacement, recall or seizure of the Company’s products;
• Operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
• Refusing the Company’s requests for 510(k) clearance of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;
• Withdrawing 510(k) clearance that have already been granted; and
• Criminal prosecution and penalties.

The FDA also has the authority to require the Company to repair, replace or refund the cost of any medical device that it has manufactured or distributed. If
any of these events were to occur, they could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business.

The Company is also subject to a wide range of federal, state and local laws and regulations, including those related to the environment, health and safety,
land  use  and  quality  assurance.  The  Company  believes  that  compliance  with  these  laws  and  regulations  as  currently  in  effect  will  not  have  a  material
adverse effect on the Company’s capital expenditures, earnings and competitive and financial position.

International

International sales of medical devices are subject to foreign governmental regulations, which vary substantially from country to country. The time required
to obtain clearance or approval by a foreign country may be different than that required for FDA clearance. And the clearance or approval requirements may
be different from those in the U.S.

In  Japan,  the  Company  is  actively  seeking  approvals  for  products  to  supplement  the  Company’s  existing  approvals  for  enlighten,  excel  V,  excel  HR  ,
LimeLight, ProWave, Solera, Titan, truSculpt iD and xeo.

In  the  European  Economic  Area  (“EEA”),  which  is  composed  of  the  27  Member  States  of  the  EU  plus  Norway,  Liechtenstein  and  Iceland,  a  single
regulatory approval process exists, and conformity with the legal requirements is represented by the CE mark. From January 1, 2021 the UK Conformity
Assessed (UKCA) mark replaced the CE mark as the new product comfomity marking requirement in England, Wales, and Scotland. Medical devices will
have until July 1, 2023 to comply. The CE mark continues to be required for goods sold in Northern Ireland. Other countries, such as Switzerland, have
entered  into  Mutual  Recognition  Agreements  and  allow  the  marketing  of  medical  devices  that  meet  EU  requirements.  The  EU  has  adopted  numerous
directives and European Standardization Committees have promulgated voluntary standards regulating the design, manufacture, clinical trials, labeling and
adverse  event  reporting  for  medical  devices.  Devices  that  comply  with  the  requirements  of  a  relevant  directive  will  be  entitled  to  bear  CE  conformity
marking, indicating that the device conforms to the essential requirements of the applicable directives and, accordingly, can be commercially distributed
throughout the EEA and countries which have entered into a Mutual Recognition Agreement. The method of assessing conformity varies depending on the
type and class of the product, but normally involves a combination of self-assessment by the manufacturer and a third-party assessment by a Notified Body,
an independent and neutral institution appointed by a country to conduct the conformity assessment. This third-party assessment may consist of an audit of
the manufacturer’s quality system and specific testing of the manufacturer’s device. An assessment by a Notified Body in one member state of the EEA, or
one  country  which  has  entered  into  a  Mutual  Recognition  Agreement  is  required  in  order  for  a  manufacturer  to  commercially  distribute  the  product
throughout  these  countries.  ISO  9001  and  ISO  13845  certification  are  voluntary  harmonized  standards.  Compliance  establishes  the  presumption  of
conformity  with  the  essential  requirements  for  a  CE  Marking.  In  February  2000,  the  Company’s  facility  was  awarded  the  ISO  9001  and  EN  46001
certification.

In  January  2018,  the  Company  conducted  the  Company’s  recertification  audit  to  the  requirements  of  ISO  13485:2003  under  the  MDSAP  for  the  five
regulatory jurisdictions signatory to MDSAP (FDA - US, Health Canada - Canada, TGA - Australia, PMDA - Japan, and ANVISA - Brazil); and for the EU
under  EN  ISO  13485:2016  and  MDD  93/42/EEC.  In  January  2021,  the  Company  passed  the  recertification  audit  re-confirming  compliance  with
ISO13485:2016  and  MDSAP.  The  MDSAP  and  EU  certification  can  be  used  to  demonstrate  compliance  with  GMP/QSR/QMS  requirements  for  all  five
regulatory jurisdictions, replacing routine audits from each regulatory jurisdiction. For cause audits can still occur.

19

Table of Contents

Applicability of Anti-Corruption Laws and Regulations

The Company’s worldwide business is subject to the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977 (the “FCPA”), the United Kingdom Bribery Act of 2010
(the “UK Bribery Act”) and other anti-corruption laws and regulations applicable in the jurisdictions where the Company operates. The FCPA can be used
to prosecute companies in the U.S. for arrangements with physicians, or other parties outside the U.S., if the physician or party is a government official of
another  country  and  the  arrangement  violates  the  law  of  that  country.  The  UK  Bribery  Act  prohibits  both  domestic  and  international  bribery,  as  well  as
bribery across both public and private sectors. There are similar laws and regulations applicable to the Company outside the U.S., all of which are subject to
evolving interpretations. For additional information, please refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, under the sections entitled
“Risk  Factors  –  the  Company’s  failure  to  comply  with  rules  relating  to  bribery,  foreign  corrupt  practices  and  privacy  and  security  laws  may  subject  the
Company to penalties and adversely impact the Company’s reputation and business operations.”

Patient Privacy and Security Laws

Various laws worldwide protect the confidentiality of certain patient health and other consumer information, including patient medical records, and restrict
the  use  and  disclosure  of  patient  health  information  by  healthcare  providers.  Privacy  standards  in  Europe  and  Asia  are  becoming  increasingly  strict,
enforcement action and financial penalties related to privacy in the EU are growing, and new laws and restrictions are being passed. The management of
cross-border  transfers  of  information  among  and  outside  of  EU  member  countries  is  becoming  more  complex,  which  may  complicate  the  Company’s
clinical research and commercial activities, as well as product offerings that involve transmission or use of data. The Company will continue its efforts to
comply with those requirements and to adapt the Company’s business processes to those standards.

In the U.S., the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 (“HIPAA”), as amended by the Health Information Technology and Clinical
Health Act (“HITECH”) and their respective implementing regulations, including the final omnibus rule published on January 25, 2013, imposes specified
requirements  relating  to  the  privacy,  security  and  transmission  of  individually  identifiable  health  information.  Among  other  things,  HITECH  makes
HIPAA’s privacy and security standards directly applicable to “business associates,” defined as independent contractors or agents of covered entities that
create, receive, maintain or transmit protected health information in connection with providing a service for or on behalf of a covered entity. HITECH also
increased  the  civil  and  criminal  penalties  that  may  be  imposed  against  covered  entities,  business  associates  and  possibly  other  persons,  and  gave  state
attorneys new general authority to file civil actions for damages or injunctions in federal court to enforce the federal HIPAA laws and seek attorney’s fees
and  costs  associated  with  pursuing  federal  civil  actions.  In  addition,  state  laws  govern  the  privacy  and  security  of  health  information  in  certain
circumstances,  many  of  which  differ  from  each  other  in  significant  ways,  thus  complicating  compliance  efforts.  The  Company  potentially  operates  as  a
business associate to covered entities in a limited number of instances. In those cases, the patient data that the Company receives may include protected
health information, as defined under HIPAA. Enforcement actions can be costly and interrupt regular operations of its business. While the Company has not
been named in any such actions, if a substantial breach or loss of data from the Company’s records were to occur, the Company could become a target of
such litigation.

In the EU, Regulation 2016/679 on the protection of natural persons with regard to the processing of personal data and on the free movement of such data
(“General  Data  Protection  Regulation”  or  “GDPR”)  came  into  effect  on  May  25,  2018.  The  GDPR  replaces  Directive  95/46/EC  (“Data  Protection
Directive”). While many of the principles of the GDPR reflect those of the Data Protection Directive, for example in relation to the requirements relating to
the privacy, security and transmission of individually identifiable health information, there are a number of changes. In particular: (1) pro-active compliance
measures are introduced, such as the requirement to carry out a Privacy Impact Assessment and to appoint a Data Protection Officer where health data is
processed on a “large scale;” and (2) the administrative fines that can be levied are significantly increased, the maximum being the higher of €20 million, or
4%, of the total worldwide annual turnover of the group in the previous financial year. The Company will continue its efforts to comply with the GDPR
requirements and to adapt the Company’s business processes to those requirements.

Environmental Health and Safety Laws

The  Company  is  also  subject  to  various  environmental  health  and  safety  laws  and  regulations  worldwide.  Like  other  medical  device  companies,  the
Company’s  manufacturing  and  other  operations  involve  the  use  and  transportation  of  substances  regulated  under  environmental  health  and  safety  laws
including those related to the transportation of hazardous materials. To the best of the Company’s knowledge at this time, the Company does not expect that
compliance with environmental protection laws will have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated results of operations, financial position or cash
flows.

20

Table of Contents

Employees and Human Capital

As of December 31, 2021, the Company had 461 employees, compared to 323 employees as of December 31, 2020. The Company believes that its future
success  will  depend  in  part  on  the  Company’s  continued  ability  to  attract,  hire  and  retain  qualified  personnel.  None  of  the  Company’s  employees  are
represented by a labor union, and the Company believes its employee relations are good. The Company is committed to fostering a diverse and inclusive
workplace that attracts and retains exceptional talent. Through ongoing employee development, comprehensive compensation and benefits, and a focus on
health, safety and employee wellbeing, the Company strives to help its employees in all aspects of their lives so they can do their best work.

Diversity, Equity and Inclusion

The  Company  is  committed  to  create  and  maintain  a  diverse  and  safe  work  environment  to  capture  the  ideas  and  perspectives  that  fuel  innovation  and
enable  its  workforce,  customers,  and  communities  to  succeed  in  creating  the  future  of  medical  aesthetics.  The  Company  strives  to  create  an  inclusive
workplace  where  people  can  design,  manufacture,  and  market  a  comprehensive  portfolio  of  aesthetic  laser  and  energy-based  products  that  enable  its
customers (the practitioner) to provide safe and effective treatments. Its commitment to diversity and inclusion starts at the highest levels of the Company. 

Employee Engagement

The Company regularly collects feedback to better understand and improve the employee experience and identify opportunities to continually strengthen its
culture.  The  Company  wants  to  know  what  is  working  well,  what  the  Company  can  do  better  and  how  well  its  employees  understand  and  practice  the
Company's cultural values. In 2021, nearly 93% of its employees participated in its annual employee survey.

Leadership development and training

At Cutera, the Company believes that the best leaders are the ones who come from within. These leaders learn with Cutera, grow with Cutera and reach
their potential through challenging job experiences. The Company provides learning opportunities by offering valuable training resources for employees in
order  to  ensure  its  people  have  everything  they  need  to  succeed  both  personally  and  professionally.  The  Company’s  employees  are  encouraged  to  take
responsibility for their own development and create learning plans that best fit their needs and development goals.

Health, Safety and Wellness

The physical health, financial well-being, life balance and mental health of its employees is vital to its success. The Company sponsors wellness initiatives
designed to enhance physical, financial, and mental well-being for all employees. The Company has successfully implemented a number of safety and social
distancing measures within its premises to protect the health and safety of associates who are required to be on-premise to support its business.

Available Information

The Company makes its periodic and current reports, including the Company's Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current
Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to those reports, filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
well  as  its  charters  for  the  Company's  Audit,  Compensation,  Nominating  and  Corporate  Governance,  and  Enterprise  Risk  Committees  and  its  Code  of
Ethics,  Corporate  Governance  Guidelines,  By-Laws,  and  Certificate  of  Incorporation,  available  free  of  charge,  on  the  Company’s  website  as  soon  as
practicable  after  such  material  is  electronically  filed  or  furnished  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  (the  “SEC”).  The  Company’s  website
address is www.cutera.com and the reports are filed under “SEC Filings,” under “Financials” on the Investor Relations portion of the Company’s website.
These reports and other information concerning the Company may be accessed through the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

21

Table of Contents

ITEM 1A.    RISK FACTORS

The Company operates in a rapidly changing economic and technological environment that presents numerous risks, many of which are driven by factors
that the Company cannot control or predict. The Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be impacted by a number of factors.
In addition to the factors discussed elsewhere in this report, the following risks and uncertainties could materially harm the Company’s business, financial
condition  or  results  of  operations,  including  causing  the  Company’s  actual  results  to  differ  materially  from  those  projected  in  any  forward-looking
statements.  The  following  list  of  significant  risk  factors  is  not  all-inclusive  or  necessarily  in  order  of  importance.  Additional  risks  and  uncertainties  not
presently known to the Company, or that the Company currently deems immaterial, also may materially adversely affect the Company in future periods. You
should carefully consider these risks and uncertainties before investing in the Company’s securities.

Summary of Risk Factors

The Company’s business, financial condition, operating results and cash flows are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties that are summarized below.
The below summary of risk factors should be read together with the more detailed discussion of risks set forth following this section under the heading
“Risk Factors,” as well as elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Risks Related to the Company’s Business and its Industry

▪ Global Supply Chain Disruption and Inflation may have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and

▪

▪

▪
▪
▪

▪

results of operations.
The Company’s business, financial condition, liquidity, capital, and results of operations have been, and may continue to be, adversely
affected by the COVID-19 pandemic.
The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporarily caused by the change in its customer’s spending habits due to the
COVID-19 pandemic.
The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporary and sales of Skincare products may decline in the future.
The trading price of the Company’s notes and common stock may fluctuate substantially.
The Company’s ability to report timely and accurate information could be negatively impacted by its plan to implement a new accounting
and enterprise resource planning (“ERP”) system
Reliance on contract manufacturers increases the risk that we will not have sufficient supply or that such supply will not be available to us
at an acceptable cost

▪ Any defects in the design, material or workmanship of its products, defective design, material or workmanship or misuse of its products

▪

▪

▪

▪

▪

▪

▪

▪

▪

▪

will cause additional costs, including product recalls and product liability suits, and harm the Company’s reputation.
Failure in hiring, training and retaining sales professionals and skilled and experienced personnel, or changes to management will cause
adversely affects the Company’s operation and operation results.
Inability to obtain regulatory clearance for our new energy-based solution for the treatment of Acne or that the device will be widely
adopted by customers or their patients.
The aesthetic equipment market is characterized by rapid innovation and high competition, which may adversely affect the Company if it
does not continue to innovate and develop new products and applications.
The Company competes against companies that offer alternative solutions to its products, have greater resources, or have a larger
customer base and broader product offerings than the Company’s offerings.
The Company’s business is subject to regulatory requirements, laser performance standards, federal regulatory reforms, FDA and other
government agencies’ regulation and oversight which may negatively affect its business, financial condition and results of operations if
the Company fails to comply with them.
The Company's products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that would be subject
to sanctions that could harm its reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations.
The Company may be unable to obtain or maintain international regulatory qualifications or approvals for its current or future products
and indications, which could harm its business.
Failure in International expansion and economic and other risks associated with international sales and operations could adversely affect
the Company’s business.
Some of the Company’s manufacturing operations are dependent upon third-party suppliers, making its vulnerable to supply shortages and
price fluctuations, which could harm its business.
Reduction or interruption in supply and an inability to develop alternative sources for supply may adversely affect the Company’s
manufacturing operations and related product sales.

22

Table of Contents

▪

▪

▪

▪

If customers are not trained and/or the Company’s products are used by non-licensed practitioners, it could result in product misuse and
adverse treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s reputation, result in product liability litigation, distract management and
result in additional costs, all of which could harm the Company’s business.
The Company’s products are subject to clinical trial process which is lengthy and expensive with uncertain outcomes. Delays or failures in
the Company's clinical trials will prevent it from commercializing any modified or new products.
Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all the Company’s products, or the Company may be involved
in future costly intellectual property litigation.
The expense and potential unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers could adversely affect its ability to sell its
products, and therefore adversely affect its financial condition.

▪ Any acquisitions that the Company makes could result in operating difficulties, dilution, and other consequences that may adversely

▪

▪

impact the Company’s business and results of operations.
Inability to access credit on favorable terms for the funding of the Company’s operations and capital projects may be limited due to
changes in credit markets.
Security breaches, cyber-security incidents and other disruptions could compromise the Company’s information and impact the
Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations.

▪ Macroeconomic political and market conditions, and catastrophic events may adversely affect the Company’s business, results of

▪

operations, financial condition and the trading price of the notes and the stock.
The Company has a relatively limited number of shares of common stock outstanding, which could result in the increase in volatility of its
stock price and the trading price of the notes.

▪ Disaster or other similar event could cause damage to its facilities and equipment, which might require the Company to cease or curtail

▪

sales of these sole sourced platforms.
Income tax audits or similar proceedings or changes in accounting standards may have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results
of operations and financial position.

Risks Related to the Notes

▪ Although the notes are referred to as convertible senior notes, they are effectively subordinated to any of the Company's secured debt and

any liabilities of its subsidiaries.
Regulatory actions and other events may adversely affect the trading price and liquidity of the notes.

▪
▪ Volatility in the market price and trading volume of the Company's common stock could adversely impact the trading price of the notes.
▪
▪

The Company may still incur substantially more debt or take other actions which would intensify the risks discussed above.
The Company may not have the ability to raise the funds necessary to settle conversions of the notes in cash or to repurchase the notes
upon a fundamental change, and its future debt may contain limitations on its ability to pay cash upon conversion or repurchase of the
notes.
The conditional conversion feature of the notes, if triggered, may adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.

▪
▪ Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock, but they will be subject to all changes

made with respect to the Company's common stock to the extent the Company satisfies its conversion obligation, in whole or in part, with
shares of its common stock.
The conditional conversion feature of the notes could result in holders receiving less than the value of the Company's common stock into
which the notes would otherwise be convertible.

▪

▪ Upon conversion of the notes, holders may receive less valuable consideration than expected because the value of the Company's common

▪
▪

▪
▪
▪
▪
▪

stock may decline after holders exercise their conversion right but before the Company satisfies it conversion obligation.
The notes are not protected by restrictive covenants.
The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption
period may not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption.
The conversion rate of the notes may not be adjusted for all dilutive events.
Provisions in the indenture governing the notes may deter or prevent a business combination that may be favorable to the holders.
The capped call transactions may affect the value of the notes and the Company's common stock.
The Company is subject to counterparty risk with respect to the capped call transactions.
Some significant restructuring transactions may not constitute a fundamental change, in which case the Company would not be obligated
to offer to repurchase the notes.

23

Table of Contents

▪

The Company has not registered the notes or the common stock issuable upon conversion, if any, which will limit the ability of holders to
resell them.
The Company cannot assure the holders of the notes that an active trading market will develop for the notes.

▪
▪ Any adverse rating of the notes may cause their trading price to fall.
▪

The holders of the notes may be subject to tax if the Company makes or fails to make certain adjustments to the conversion rate of the
notes even though the holders do not receive a corresponding cash distribution.
The Company may redeem the notes at its option, which may adversely affect the holders' return.
The notes will initially be held in book-entry form and, therefore, holders must rely on the procedures and the relevant clearing systems to
exercise their rights and remedies.

▪
▪

Risks Related to Ownership of the Company's Common Stock

▪ Anti-takeover provisions contained in the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws,

▪
▪

▪
▪

as well as provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.
The Company's business could be negatively affected by activist shareholders.
If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research or reports about the Company, its business, its market or its
competitors, or if they adversely change their recommendations regarding the Company's common stock, the market price and trading
volume of its notes and common stock could decline.
The Company does not expect to declare any dividends on its common stock in the foreseeable future.
If the Company raises additional capital through the sale of shares of the Company’s common stock, convertible securities or debt in the
future, its stockholders’ ownership in the Company could be diluted and restrictions could be imposed on the Company’s business.

Risks Related to the Company’s Business and its Industry

Global  Supply  Chain  Disruption  and  Inflation  may  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the  Company's  business,  financial  condition  and  results  of
operations.

The disruptions to the global economy in 2020 and 2021 impeded global supply chains and resulted in longer lead times and increased component costs and
freight expenses. In some instances, the Company depends on a sole source supplier arrangement, and alternative suppliers may not be readily available.
The supply of these components is critical to the Company's manufacturing needs. Despite the actions the Company has undertaken to minimize the impacts
from disruptions to the global economy, there can be no assurances that unforeseen future events in the global supply chain, and inflationary pressures, will
not have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition, and results of operations.

The effects of the COVID-19 pandemic have affected how the Company and its customers are operating its businesses, and the duration and extent to
which this will impact its future results of operations and overall financial performance remains uncertain.

The COVID-19 pandemic and related public health measures have affected how the Company and its customers are operating their businesses and have
materially and adversely affected the Company’s business and the Company’s financial results. To date, the impact includes: a) the deferral of procedures
using its products, b) disruptions or restrictions on the ability of many of the Company’s employees and of third parties on which the Company relies, to
work  effectively,  including  “stay-at-home”  orders  and  similar  government  actions;  and  c)  temporary  closures  of  its  facilities  and  of  the  facilities  of  the
Company’s customers and suppliers. If the pandemic has a substantial impact on its employees’ or customers’ businesses and productivity, the Company’s
results of operations and overall financial performance may be materially and adversely affected. The global macroeconomic effects of the pandemic may
persist for an indefinite period.

As jurisdictions throughout the world continue to respond to the pandemic, the degree of the foregoing impacts may increase in scope or magnitude or the
Company  may  experience  additional  adverse  effects  in  one  or  more  regions.  Any  other  outbreaks  of  contagious  diseases  or  other  adverse  public  health
developments in countries where the Company operates or where its customers or suppliers are located could also have a material and adverse effect on its
business, financial condition and results of operations.

Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, customers and their patients have been, and in certain regions continue to be, required, or are choosing, to defer elective
procedures in which the Company's products otherwise could be used, and many facilities that specialize in the procedures in which the Company's products
otherwise could be used have temporarily closed and in some cases continue to be temporarily closed or operating at reduced hours. In addition, even after
the pandemic subsides or governmental orders no longer prohibit or recommend against performing such procedures, patients may continue to defer such
procedures due to personal concerns. Further, facilities at which its products typically are used may not reopen or, even if they reopen, patients may elect to
have procedures performed at facilities that are, or are perceived to be, lower-risk, such as private surgery centers,

24

Table of Contents

and the Company's products may not be approved at such facilities, and the Company may be unable to have the Company's products approved for use at
such facilities on a timely basis, or at all. The effect of the pandemic on the broader economy could also negatively affect demand for elective procedures
using  its  products,  both  in  the  near-  and  long-term.  Workforce  limitations  and  travel  restrictions  resulting  from  government  actions  taken  to  contain  the
spread of COVID-19 have and will continue to adversely affect almost every aspect of its business. If a significant percentage of the Company's workforce,
or  of  the  workforce  of  third  parties  on  which  the  Company  relies,  cannot  work,  including  because  of  illness  or  travel  or  government  restrictions,  its
operations  will  be  negatively  affected.  Due  to  government  restrictions  and  social  distancing  guidelines  in  many  countries  around  the  world,  there  is  an
increased reliance on working from home for the Company's workforce and on the workforce of third parties on which the Company rely. For example,
most of the Company's sales personnel and third-party agents currently are working largely using virtual and online engagement tools and tactics, which
may be less effective than its typical in-person sales and marketing programs. In addition, the Company reduced access to its hands-on customer trainings,
which, in turn, adversely impacted the Company's ability to educate and train customers on the proper use of the Company's products, which may make
surgeons  less  comfortable  using,  and  therefore  less  likely  to  use,  the  Company's  products.  The  Company  believes  that  interruptions  resulting  from  the
COVID-19 pandemic may limit its ability to develop, and therefore launch, the products the Company believes will drive the Company’s future revenue
growth on the timelines the Company anticipated previously, or at all, and could also delay the planned launch of products in 2022 and beyond. It may also
cause the Company not to submit required filings on its previous timelines, including with the FDA, or other regulatory bodies, both in the U.S. and outside
the  U.S.  The  COVID-19  pandemic  has  adversely  impacted  the  Company's  clinical  trial  operations  in  the  United  States.  In  addition,  changes  impacting
workforce function at the FDA and other regulatory bodies, as well as changes impacting workforce function at the facilities at which the Company seeks to
have new products approved for use, could adversely impact the timing of when the Company's new products are cleared for marketing and approved for
use,  either  of  which  would  adversely  impact  the  timing  of  its  ability  to  sell  these  new  products  and  would  have  a  material  and  adverse  effect  on  the
Company's revenue growth.

As a result of the COVID-19 outbreak, some of the Company’s customers are being required to shelter-in-place and are not working. In cases where the
Company’s  customers  are  working,  they  are  performing  fewer  procedures.  When  they  are  performing  procedures,  customers  are  mostly  focused  on
medically  necessary  procedures  that  should  not  be  delayed.  Non-urgent,  non-essential  procedures  are  getting  cancelled  or  delayed.  As  a  result  of  fewer
aesthetic procedures being performed and anxiety about the economic future, the Company’s customers may cancel orders for laser systems or will use less
consumables. Some of the Company’s customers will feel less confident about making investments in their practices and focus on retaining their cash. As a
result  of  cash  conservation  efforts  by  the  Company’s  customers,  the  Company  may  also  encounter  problems  collecting  on  its  receivables,  which  will
impact the Company’s cash position and could result in negative cash flows.

Further, disruptions in the manufacture and distribution of the Company's products or in its supply chain may occur as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic,
including for the reasons above, or other events that result in staffing shortages, production slowdowns, stoppages, or disruptions in delivery systems, any of
which  could  materially  and  adversely  affect  the  Company's  ability  to  manufacture  or  distribute  its  products,  or  to  obtain  the  raw  materials  and  supplies
necessary to manufacture and distribute the Company’s products, in a timely manner, or at all.

The Company may also experience other unknown adverse impacts from COVID-19 that cannot be predicted. For example, customers and other facilities at
which the Company sells its products may renegotiate their purchase prices, including as a result of, or the perception that they may be suffering, financial
difficulty as a result of the pandemic. Similarly, facilities at which the Company seeks to sell its products in the future may require price reductions relative
to  the  price  at  which  the  Company  previously  expected  to  sell  its  products.  Reduction  in  the  prices  at  which  the  Company  sells  products  to  existing
customers may have a material and adverse effect on its future financial results and reductions in the prices at which the Company expected to sell products
would have a material and adverse effect on its expectations for revenue growth.

Further,  the  global  capital  markets  experienced,  and  the  Company  expects  will  continue  to  experience,  disruption  and  volatility  due  to  the  COVID-19
pandemic, adversely impacting access to capital for the Company's customers and suppliers who need access to capital. Their inability to access capital in a
timely manner, or at all, could adversely impact demand for its products and/or adversely impact its ability to manufacture or supply its products, any of
which could have a material and adverse effect on the Company's business.

The extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic will impact the Company’s business going forward will depend on numerous evolving factors that cannot
be reliably predicted, including the duration and scope of the pandemic; governmental, business, and individuals’ actions in response to the pandemic;
and the impact on economic activity including the possibility of recession or financial market instability.

The Company expects the customers will return and the amount of revenue to increase in 2022 compared to 2021 as the economic environment outlook due
to the COVID-19 pandemic improves. However, the COVID-19 outbreak continues to be fluid and the

25

Table of Contents

aftermath of the business and economic disruptions due to the COVID-19 pandemic is still uncertain, making it difficult to forecast the final impact it could
have on the Company’s future operations. The spread of the coronavirus, which caused a broad impact in 2020 and 2021 globally, including restrictions on
travel, shifting work force to work remotely and quarantine policies put into place by businesses and governments, had a material economic effect on the
Company’s business. Notably, healthcare facilities in many countries effectively banned elective procedures. Many of the Company’s products are used in
aesthetic  elective  procedures  and  as  such,  the  bans  on  elective  procedures  substantially  reduced  the  Company’s  sales  and  marketing  efforts  in  the  early
months of the pandemic. The Company cannot presently predict the scope and severity of any impacts in future periods from the business shutdowns or
disruptions due to the COVID-19 pandemic, but the impact on economic activity such as the possibility of recession or financial market instability could
have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, revenue, operating results, cash flows and financial condition.

The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporary and sales of Skincare products may decline in the future.

During 2020 and 2021, the Company experienced a significant increase in sales of skincare products under the exclusive distribution agreement with ZO
which allows the Company to sell ZO’s skincare products in Japan. The reason for the increase in skincare products sales might have been the result of
changes  in  customers’  spending  habits  to  purchase  more  aesthetic  treatments  which  could  be  applied  at  home  due  to  limitations  on  in-person  aesthetic
procedures, social distancing and mask wearing requirements due to the COVID-19 pandemic. Future growth in sales of skincare products depends on the
customers’ spending habits, which may change back to original spending habits after the COVID-19 pandemic. Such changes may have a material adverse
effect on the Company’s revenue, operating results and cash flows.

The trading price of the Company’s  notes  and  common  stock  may  fluctuate  substantially  due  to  several  factors,  some  of  which  are  discussed  below.
Further, the Company has a relatively limited number of shares of common stock outstanding, a large portion of which is held by a small number of
investors, which could result in the increase in volatility of its stock price and the trading price of the notes.

There has been recent volatility in the price of the Company’s common stock. The Company believes this is due in part to the overall impact of COVID-
19  on  the  aesthetic  industry  and  its  partial  recovery,  the  remaining  open  territories  associated  with  the  Company’s  North  America  salesforce,  and  other
factors. As a result of the Company’s relatively limited public float, its common stock may be less liquid than the stock of companies with broader public
ownership. Among other things, trading of a relatively small volume of the Company’s common stock may have a greater impact on the trading price for the
Company’s notes and shares than would be the case if the Company’s public float were larger. The public market price of the Company’s common stock has
in the past fluctuated substantially and, due to the current concentration of stockholders, the trading price of the notes and the common stock may continue
to  do  so  in  the  future.  The  market  price  for  the  Company’s  notes  and  common  stock  could  also  be  affected  by  a  number  of  other  factors,  including  the
general market conditions unrelated to the Company’s operating performance, including market volatility as a result of the COVID-19 outbreak.

The market price for the Company’s notes and common stock could also be affected by a number of other factors, including:

• the general market conditions unrelated to the Company’s operating performance;
• sales of large blocks of the Company’s common stock, including sales by the Company’s executive officers, directors and large institutional investors;
• quarterly variations in the Company’s, or the Company’s competitors’, results of operations;
• actual or anticipated changes or fluctuations in the Company’s results of operations;
• actual or anticipated changes in analysts’ estimates, investors’ perceptions, recommendations by securities analysts or the Company’s failure to achieve

analysts ‘estimates;

• the announcement of new products, service enhancements, distributor relationships or acquisitions by the Company or the Company’s competitors;
• the announcement of the departure of a key employee or executive officer by the Company or the Company’s competitors;
• regulatory developments or delays concerning the Company’s, or the Company’s competitors’ products; and
• the initiation of any litigation by the Company or against the Company, including the lawsuit initiated by the Company on January 31, 2020 in Federal

District Court in California against Lutronic Aesthetics, Inc. as previously disclosed on February 3, 2020, or against the Company.

Actual or perceived instability and / or volatility in the Company’s stock price could reduce demand from potential buyers of the Company’s stock, thereby
causing the trading price of the Company’s notes and stock to either remain depressed or to decline further. In addition, if the market for medical-device
company stocks or the stock market in general experiences a loss of investor confidence, the trading price of the Company’s notes and stock could decline
for reasons unrelated to the Company’s business, results of operations or financial condition. The trading price of the Company’s notes and common stock
might also decline in

26

Table of Contents

reaction  to  events  that  affect  other  companies  in  the  Company’s  industry  even  if  these  events  do  not  directly  affect  us.  In  the  past,  following  periods  of
volatility in the market price of a company’s securities, securities class action litigation has often been brought against that company. Any future securities
litigation could result in substantial costs and divert the Company’s management’s attention and resources from the Company’s business. This could have a
material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

The Company’s ability to report timely and accurate information could be negatively impacted by its plan to implement a new accounting and enterprise
resource planning (“ERP”) system.

The  Company  is  currently  completing  the  implementation  of  a  new  accounting  and  ERP  system.  If  aspects  of  the  implementation  are  not  executed
successfully, then its ability to report timely and accurate information could be negatively impacted. Failure to report required information in a timely and
accurate  fashion  could  result  in  financial  penalties,  fines  and  other  administrative  actions.  Such  events  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the
Company’s total enterprise value and stock price.

We currently rely on third-party contract manufacturers (“CMs”) to produce certain systems. This reliance on CMs increases the risk that we will not
have sufficient supply or that such supply will not be available to us at an acceptable cost, which may have a material adverse effect on our business

We have entered into arrangements with third-party contract manufacturers to produce and deliver fully assembled systems ready for direct shipment to our
customers.  We  may  experience  supply  shortfalls  or  delays  in  shipping  products  to  our  customers  if  our  contract  manufacturers  experience  delays,
disruptions, quality control problems in their manufacturing operations, or if we have to change or add manufacturers or contract manufacturing locations.
Even  if  products  are  available,  we  may  be  unable  to  obtain  sufficient  quantities  at  an  acceptable  cost  or  quality.  Although  we  have  contracts  with  our
manufacturers that include terms to protect us in the event of early termination, we may not have adequate time to transition all of our manufacturing needs
to an alternative manufacturer under comparable commercial terms. As well, a significant portion of our manufacturing is performed in foreign countries
and  is  therefore  subject  to  risks  associated  with  doing  business  outside  of  the  U.S.,  including  import  restrictions,  export  restrictions,  disruptions  to  our
supply chain, cyberattacks, pandemics, regional climate-related events, or regional conflicts. The failure by us or our CMs to produce sufficient quantities at
acceptable cost and quality may have a material adverse effect on our business.

The Company’s annual and quarterly operating results may fluctuate in the future, which may cause the Company’s trading price for the notes and
shares to decline.

The  Company’s  net  sales,  expenses  and  operating  results  may  vary  significantly  from  year  to  year  and  quarter  to  quarter  for  several  reasons,  including,
without limitation:

• the ability of the Company’s sales force to effectively market and promote the Company’s products, and the extent to which those products gain market

acceptance;

• the inability to meet the Company’s debt repayment obligations under its senior credit facility due to insufficient cash;
• the  possibility  that  cybersecurity  breaches,  data  breaches,  and  other  disruptions  could  compromise  the  Company’s  information  or  result  in  the

unauthorized disclosure of confidential information;

• the existence and timing of any product approvals or changes;
• the rate and size of expenditures incurred on the Company’s clinical, manufacturing, sales, marketing, and product development efforts;
• the Company’s ability to attract and retain personnel;
• the availability of key components, materials and contract services, which depends on the Company’s ability to forecast sales, among other things;
• investigations of the Company’s business and business-related activities by regulatory or other governmental authorities;
• variations in timing and quantity of product orders;
• temporary manufacturing interruptions or disruptions;
• the timing and success of new product and new market introductions, as well as delays in obtaining domestic or foreign regulatory approvals for such

introductions;

• increased competition, patent expirations or new technologies or treatments;
• product recalls or safety alerts;
• litigation, including product liability, patent, employment, securities class action, stockholder derivative, general commercial and other lawsuits;
• volatility in the global market and worldwide economic conditions;
• changes in tax laws, including changes domestically and internationally, or exposure to additional income tax liabilities;
• the impact of the EU privacy regulations (GDPR) on the Company’s resources;

27

Table of Contents

• the financial health of the Company’s customers and their ability to purchase the Company’s products in the current economic environment;
• other unusual or non-operating expenses, such as expenses related to mergers or acquisitions, may cause operating results to vary; and
• an epidemic or pandemic, such as the current COVID-19 pandemic.

As a result of any of these factors, the Company’s consolidated results of operations may fluctuate significantly, which may in turn cause the trading price of
the notes and the shares to fluctuate.

If defects are discovered in the Company’s products, the Company may incur additional unforeseen costs, customers may not purchase the Company’s
product and the Company’s reputation may suffer.

The  Company’s  success  depends  on  the  quality  and  reliability  of  its  products.  While  the  Company’s  subject  components  are  sources  and  products
manufactured to stringent quality specifications and processes, the Company’s products incorporate different components including optical components, and
other medical device software, any of which may contain errors or exhibit failures, especially when products are first introduced. In addition, new products
or enhancements may contain undetected errors or performance problems that, despite testing, are discovered only after commercial shipment. Because the
Company’s products are designed to be used to perform complex surgical procedures, due to the serious and costly consequences of product failure, the
Company and its customers have an increased sensitivity to such defects. In the past, the Company has voluntarily recalled certain products. Although the
Company’s  products  are  subject  to  stringent  quality  processes  and  controls,  the  Company  cannot  provide  assurance  that  its  products  will  not  experience
component aging, errors, or performance problems. If the Company experiences product flaws or performance problems, any or all of the following could
occur:

• delays in product shipments;
• loss of revenue;
• delay in market acceptance;
• diversion of the Company’s resources;
• damage to the Company’s reputation;
• product recalls;
• regulatory actions;
• increased service or warranty costs; or
• product liability claims.

Costs associated with product flaws or performance problems could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, results of
operations or cash flows.

The success and continuing development of the Company’s products depends, in part, upon maintaining strong relationships with physicians and other
healthcare professionals.

If  the  Company  fails  to  maintain  the  Company’s  working  relationships  with  physicians  and  other  ancillary  healthcare  and  aesthetic  professionals,  the
Company’s products may not be developed and marketed in line with the needs and expectations of the professionals who use and support the Company’s
products. Physicians assist the Company as researchers, marketing consultants, product consultants, and public speakers, and the Company relies on these
professionals to provide the Company with considerable knowledge and experience. If the Company is unable to maintain these strong relationships, the
development and marketing of the Company’s products could suffer, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial
condition and results of operations.

The  Company  relies  heavily  on  its  sales  professionals  to  market  and  sell  its  products  worldwide.  If  the  Company  is  unable  to  hire,  effectively  train,
manage, improve the productivity of, and retain the Company’s sales professionals, the Company’s  business  will  be  harmed,  which  would  impair  its
future revenue and profitability.

The  Company’s  success  largely  depends  on  the  Company’s  ability  to  hire,  train,  manage,  and  improve  the  productivity  levels  of  the  Company’s  sales
professionals worldwide. Because of the Company’s focus on non-core practitioners in the past, several of its sales professionals do not have established
relationships with the core market, consisting of dermatologists and plastic surgeons, or where those relationships exist, they are not appropriately strong.

Competition  for  sales  professionals  who  are  familiar  with,  and  trained  to  sell  in,  the  aesthetic  equipment  market  continues  to  be  robust.  As  a  result,  the
Company  occasionally  loses  its  sales  people  to  competitors.  The  Company’s  industry  is  characterized  by  a  few  established  companies  that  compete
vigorously for talented sales professionals. Some of its sales professionals leave the Company for jobs that they perceive to be better opportunities, both
within and outside of the aesthetic industry. For instance, in

28

Table of Contents

2020, the Company experienced significant turnover of the Company’s sales professionals, including several people in key sales leadership positions. Most
of these sales professionals went to work for a competitor and the loss of these sales professionals negatively impacted the Company’s sales performance
until the Company was able to hire and train replacement personnel. The Company believes it has adequate measures in place to protect the Company’s
proprietary  and  confidential  information  when  employees  leave  the  Company,  however  the  ability  to  enforce  these  measures  varies  from  jurisdiction  to
jurisdiction  and  the  Company  must  make  a  case-by-case  decision  regarding  legal  enforcement  action.  For  instance,  covenants  not-to-compete  are  not
allowed in many states, and if allowed, are difficult to enforce in many jurisdictions. Furthermore, such legal enforcement actions are expensive and the
Company cannot give any assurance that these enforcement actions will be successful.

However, the Company also continues to hire and train new sales people, including several from the Company’s competitors. Several of the Company’s
sales employees and sales management are recently hired or transferred into different roles, and it will take time for them to be fully trained to improve their
productivity.  In  addition,  due  to  the  competition  for  sales  professionals  in  the  Company’s  industry,  the  Company  also  recruits  sales  professionals  from
outside the industry. Sales professionals from outside the industry typically take longer to train and become familiar with the Company’s products and the
procedures in which they are used. As a result of a lack of industry knowledge, these sales professionals may take longer to become productive members of
the Company’s sales force.

The Company trains its existing and recently recruited sales professionals to better understand the Company’s existing and new product technologies and
how they can be positioned against the Company’s competitors’ products. These initiatives are intended to improve the productivity of the Company’s sales
professionals and the Company’s revenue and profitability. It takes time for the sales professionals to become productive following their training and there
can be no assurance that the newly recruited sales professionals will be adequately trained in a timely manner, or that the Company direct sales productivity
will improve, or that the Company will not experience significant levels of attrition in the future.

Measures the Company implements in an effort to recruit, retain, train and manage the Company’s sales professionals, strengthen their relationships with
core  market  physicians,  and  improve  their  productivity  may  not  be  successful  and  may  instead  contribute  to  instability  in  its  operations,  additional
departures from the Company’s sales organization, or further reduce the Company’s revenue and harm the Company’s business. If the Company is not able
to  improve  the  productivity  and  retention  of  the  Company’s  North  American  and  international  sales  professionals,  then  the  Company’s  total  revenue,
profitability and stock price may be adversely impacted.

The Company is planning to launch an energy-based solution for the treatment of Acne and can provide no assurance that the Company will obtain
regulatory clearance for this Acne device or that the device will be widely adopted by customers or their patients.

The Company has recently announced plans to bring an energy-based device for Acne to market. The Company has spent several years working on this
program,  fine-tuning  the  product,  and  designing  and  developing  the  procedure  to  deliver  a  safe,  comfortable  and  effective  solution  for  Acne  patients.
Despite these efforts, the Company may not be successful in obtaining final approval from the FDA. Additionally, the Company may be unable to establish
and manage a sufficient or effective sales force in a timely or cost-effective manner, and any sales force the Company does establish may not be capable of
generating  demand  for  this  device,  therefore  hindering  the  Company’s  ability  to  generate  revenues  and  achieve  or  sustain  profitability  from  this  Acne
device.

The aesthetic equipment market is characterized by rapid innovation. To compete effectively, the Company must develop and/or acquire new products,
seek regulatory clearance, market them successfully, and identify new markets for the Company’s technology.

The aesthetic light and energy-based treatment system industry is subject to continuous technological development and product innovation. If the Company
does not continue to innovate and develop new products and applications, the Company’s competitive position will likely deteriorate as other companies
successfully design and commercialize new products and applications or enhancements to the Company’s current products. The Company created products
to apply the Company’s technology to body contouring, hair removal, treatment of veins, tattoo removal and skin revitalization, including the treatment of
diffuse  redness,  fine  lines  and  wrinkles  via  hemostasis  and  coagulation,  skin  texture,  pore  size  and  benign  pigmented  lesions,  etc.  For  example,  the
Company introduced Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in
July  2018,  excel  V+  in  February  2019,  truSculpt  flex  in  June  2019,  and  the  Secret  Pro,  a  device  combining  the  benefits  of  RF  microneedling  with  the
capabilities of a fractional, ablative CO  laser in September of 2020. In 2021, the Company introduced truSculpt flex+, a treatment mode that decreased the
treatment  time  from  approximately  45  minutes  to  15  minutes.  To  grow  in  the  future,  the  Company  must  continue  to  develop  and/or  acquire  new  and
innovative aesthetic products and applications, identify new markets, and successfully launch the newly acquired or developed product offerings.

2

To successfully expand the Company’s product offerings, the Company must, among other things:

29

Table of Contents

• develop or otherwise acquire new products that either add to or significantly improve the Company’s current product offerings;
• obtain regulatory clearance for these new products;
• convince the Company’s existing and prospective customers that the Company’s product offerings are an attractive revenue-generating addition to their

practice;

• sell the Company’s product offerings to a broad customer base;
• identify new markets and alternative applications for the Company’s technology;
• protect the Company’s existing and future products with defensible intellectual property; and
• satisfy and maintain all regulatory requirements for commercialization.

Historically, product introductions have been a significant component of the Company’s financial performance. To be successful in the aesthetics industry,
the Company believes it needs to continue to innovate. The Company’s business strategy is based, in part, on its expectation that the Company will continue
to increase or enhance its product offerings. The Company needs to continue to devote substantial research and development resources to make new product
introductions, which can be costly and time consuming to its organization.

The Company also believes that, to increase revenue from sales of new products, the Company needs to continue to develop its clinical support, further
expand and nurture relationships with industry thought leaders, and increase market awareness of the benefits of its new products. However, even with a
significant  investment  in  research  and  development,  the  Company  may  be  unable  to  continue  to  develop,  acquire  or  effectively  launch  and  market  new
products  and  technologies  regularly,  or  at  all.  If  the  Company  fails  to  successfully  commercialize  new  products  or  enhancements,  its  business  may  be
harmed.

While the Company attempts to protect its products through patents and other intellectual property, there are few barriers to entry that would prevent new
entrants or existing competitors from developing products that compete directly with the Company’s. The Company expects that any competitive advantage
the Company may enjoy from current and future innovations may diminish over time as companies successfully respond to the Company’s, or create their
own, innovations. Consequently, the Company believes that it will have to continuously innovate and improve the Company’s products and technology to
compete successfully. If the Company is unable to innovate successfully, its products could become obsolete and its revenue could decline as its customers
and prospective customers purchase its competitors’ products.

Demand for the Company’s products in any of the Company’s markets could be weakened by several factors, including:

• inability to develop and market the Company’s products to the core market specialties of dermatologists and plastic surgeons;
• poor financial performance of market segments that attempt to introduce aesthetic procedures to their businesses;
• the inability to differentiate the Company’s products from those of the Company’s competitors;
• competitive threat from new innovations and product introductions;
• reduced patient demand for elective aesthetic procedures;
• failure to build and maintain relationships with opinion leaders within the various market segments; and
• the lack of credit financing, or an increase in the cost of borrowing, for some of the Company’s potential customers.

If the Company does not achieve anticipated demand for the Company’s products, there could be a material adverse effect on its total revenue, profitability,
employee retention and stock price.

The Company depends on skilled and experienced personnel to operate its global business effectively. Changes to management or the inability to recruit,
hire,  train  and  retain  qualified  personnel,  could  harm  the  Company’s  ability  to  successfully  manage,  develop  and  expand  its  business,  which  would
impair the Company’s future revenue and profitability.

The Company’s success largely depends on the skills, experience and efforts of the Company’s officers and other key employees. The loss of any of the
Company’s  executive  officers  could  weaken  its  management  expertise  and  harm  the  Company’s  business,  and  it  may  not  be  able  to  find  adequate
replacements  on  a  timely  basis,  or  at  all.  Except  for  Change  of  Control  and  Severance  Agreements  for  the  Company’s  executive  officers  and  a  few  key
employees, the Company does not have employment contracts with any of its officers or other key employees. Any of the Company’s officers and other key
employees  may  terminate  their  employment  at  any  time  and  their  knowledge  of  the  Company’s  business  and  industry  may  be  difficult  to  replace.  The
Company does not have a succession plan in place for each of its officers and key employees. In addition, the Company does not maintain “key person” life
insurance policies covering any of the Company’s employees.

In  addition  to  dependence  on  the  Company’s  officers  and  key  employees,  the  Company  is  highly  dependent  on  other  sales  and  scientific  personnel.  For
example, in the first quarter of 2020 the Company experienced turnover of its sales professionals, including several people in key sales leadership positions.
Most of these sales professionals went to work for a competitor. Additionally, the Company’s product development plans depend, in part, on the Company’s
ability  to  attract  and  retain  engineers  with  experience  in  medical  devices.  Attracting  and  retaining  qualified  personnel  will  be  critical  to  the  Company’s
success, and

30

Table of Contents

competition for qualified personnel is intense. The Company may not be able to attract and retain personnel on acceptable terms given the competition for
such personnel among technology and healthcare companies and universities. The loss of any of these persons or the Company’s inability to attract, train
and retain qualified personnel could harm the Company’s business and the Company’s ability to compete and become profitable.

Security breaches, cyber-security incidents and other disruptions could compromise the Company’s information and impact the Company’s business,
financial condition or results of operations.

The Company relies on networks, information management software and other technology, or information systems, including the Internet and third-party
hosted services, to support a variety of business processes and activities, including procurement and supply chain, manufacturing, distribution, invoicing,
order processing and collection of payments. The Company uses information systems to process financial information and results of operations for internal
reporting purposes and to comply with regulatory financial reporting, legal and tax requirements. In addition, the Company depends on information systems
for digital marketing activities and electronic communications among the Company’s locations around the world and between company personnel as well as
customers and suppliers. Because information systems are critical to many of the Company’s operating activities, the Company’s business processes may be
impacted by system shutdowns or service disruptions. These disruptions may be caused by failures during routine operations such as system upgrades or
user errors, as well as network or hardware failures, malicious or disruptive software, computer hackers, geopolitical events, natural disasters, failures or
impairments  of  telecommunications  networks,  or  other  catastrophic  events.  These  events  could  result  in  unauthorized  disclosure  of  material  confidential
information.  If  the  Company’s  information  systems  suffer  severe  damage,  disruption  or  shutdown  and  the  Company  business  continuity  plans  do  not
effectively resolve the issues in a timely manner, the Company could experience delays in reporting the Company’s financial results and the Company may
lose  revenue  and  profits  as  a  result  of  the  Company’s  inability  to  timely  manufacture,  distribute,  invoice  and  collect  payments.  Misuse,  leakage  or
falsification of information could result in a violation of data privacy laws and regulations and damage the Company’s reputation and credibility, and could
expose the Company to liability. The Company may also be required to spend significant financial and other resources to remedy the damage caused by a
security breach or to repair or replace networks and information systems. Like most major corporations, the Company’s information systems are a target of
attacks.

A  cyber  security  attack  or  other  incident  that  bypasses  the  Company’s  information  systems  security  could  cause  a  security  breach  which  may  lead  to  a
material  disruption  to  the  Company’s  information  systems  infrastructure  or  business  and  may  involve  a  significant  loss  of  business  or  patient  health
information. If a cyber security attack or other unauthorized attempt to access the Company’s systems or facilities were successful, it could result in the
theft, destruction, loss, misappropriation or release of confidential information or intellectual property, and could cause operational or business delays that
may materially impact the Company’s ability to provide various healthcare services. Any successful cyber security attack or other unauthorized attempt to
access  the  Company’s  systems  or  facilities  also  could  result  in  negative  publicity  which  could  damage  the  Company’s  reputation  or  brand  with  the
Company’s patients, referral sources, payors or other third parties and could subject the Company to a number of adverse consequences, the vast majority of
which  are  not  insurable,  including  but  not  limited  to  disruptions  in  the  Company’s  operations,  regulatory  and  other  civil  and  criminal  penalties,  fines,
investigations and enforcement actions (including, but not limited to, those arising from the SEC, Federal Trade Commission, Office of Civil Rights, the
Office  of  Inspector  General  or  state  attorneys  general),  fines,  private  litigation  with  those  affected  by  the  data  breach,  loss  of  customers,  disputes  with
payors  and  increased  operating  expense,  which  either  individually  or  in  the  aggregate  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the  Company’s  business,
financial position, results of operations and liquidity.

The Company has not had any disruptions to its information systems that have materially affected its business, financial condition or results of operations.
However, there can be no assurance that such disruptions may occur and have a material adverse effect on the Company in the future.

Changes in accounting standards and estimates could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial position.

Generally accepted accounting principles and the related authoritative guidance for many aspects of the Company’s business, including revenue recognition,
inventories,  warranties,  leases,  income  taxes,  expected  credit  losses,  fair-value  measurements,  and  stock-based  compensation,  are  complex  and  involve
subjective judgments. Changes in these rules or changes in the underlying estimates, assumptions or judgments by the Company’s management could have a
material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and may retroactively affect previously reported results.

The Company’s ability to access credit on favorable terms, if necessary, for the funding of the Company’s operations and capital projects may be limited
due to changes in credit markets.

31

Table of Contents

On July 9, 2020, the Company terminated its Wells Fargo Revolving Line of Credit and subsequently entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with
Silicon Valley Bank (the “SVB Revolving Line of Credit”). The agreement provides for a four-year secured revolving loan facility in an aggregate principal
amount of up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024. As of December 31, 2021, the Company had not drawn on this
credit facility.

A violation of any of the covenants could result in a default under the SVB Revolving Line of Credit that would permit Silicon Valley Bank to restrict the
Company’s ability to further access the revolving line of credit for loans and letters of credit and require the immediate repayment of any outstanding loans
under the agreement. In addition, these covenants are subject to renegotiation at the beginning of each fiscal year, which further reduces the Company’s
ability to anticipate whether this source of capital will continue to be available in the near term.

Additionally, in the past, the credit markets and the financial services industry have experienced disruption characterized by the bankruptcy, failure, collapse
or sale of various financial institutions, increased volatility in securities prices, diminished liquidity and credit availability and intervention from the U.S.
and other governments. Continued concerns about the systemic impact of potential long-term or widespread downturn, energy costs, geopolitical issues, the
availability and cost of credit, the global commercial and residential real estate markets and related mortgage markets and reduced consumer confidence
have contributed to increased market volatility. The cost and availability of credit has been and may continue to be adversely affected by these conditions.
The Company cannot be certain that funding for the Company’s capital needs will be available from the Company’s existing financial institutions and the
credit markets if needed, and if available, to the extent required and on acceptable terms. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit terminates on July 9, 2024 and
if  the  Company  cannot  renew  or  refinance  this  facility  or  obtain  funding  when  needed,  in  each  case  on  acceptable  terms,  such  conditions  may  have  an
adverse effect on the Company’s revenues and results of operations.

Covenants  in  the  Loan  and  Security  Agreement  governing  the  Company's  revolving  credit  facility  may  restrict  its  operations,  and  if  the  Company
does not effectively manage its business to comply with these covenants, its financial condition could be adversely impacted.

The Company entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank in July 2020, which provides for a four-year secured revolving loan
facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $30.0 million (the “senior credit facility”). The senior credit facility contains various restrictive covenants,
including, among other things, minimum liquidity and revenue requirements, restrictions on the Company's ability to dispose of assets, make acquisitions or
investments, incur debt or liens, make distributions to its stockholders, or enter into certain types of related party transactions. These restrictions may restrict
the  Company's  current  and  future  operations,  particularly  the  Company's  ability  to  respond  to  certain  changes  in  its  business  or  industry,  or  take  future
actions. Pursuant to the senior credit facility, the Company granted the parties thereto a security interest in substantially all of its assets. See Note 12 of the
notes to the Company's consolidated financial statements and the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results
of Operations - Liquidity and Capital Resources Loan and Security Agreement” in Part II, Item 8 of the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the
fiscal year ended December 31, 2021. The Company’s ability to meet these restrictive covenants can be impacted by events beyond the Company’s control
and the Company may be unable to do so. The Company’s senior credit facility provides that its breaches or failure to satisfy certain covenants constitutes
an  event  of  default.  Upon  the  occurrence  of  an  event  of  default,  the  Company’s  lenders  could  elect  to  declare  all  amounts  outstanding  under  its  debt
agreements to be immediately due and payable. In addition, the Company's lenders would have the right to proceed against the assets the Company provided
as collateral pursuant to the senior credit facility. If the debt under its senior credit facility was to be accelerated, the Company may not have sufficient cash
on hand or be able to sell sufficient collateral to repay it, which would have an immediate adverse effect on the Company's business and operating results.

Macroeconomic political and market conditions, and catastrophic events may adversely affect the Company’s business, results of operations, financial
condition and the trading price of the notes and the stock.

The Company’s business is influenced by a range of factors that are beyond the Company’s control, including:

• general macro-economic and business conditions in the Company’s key markets of North America, Japan, Asia Pacific, the Middle East, Europe and

Australia;

• the lack of credit financing, or an increase in the cost of borrowing, for some of the Company’s potential customers due to increasing interest rates and

lending requirements;

• the overall demand for the Company’s products by the core market specialties of dermatologists and plastic surgeons;
• the timing and success of new product introductions by the Company or the Company’s competitors or any other change in the competitive landscape of

the market for non-surgical aesthetic procedures, including consolidation among the Company’s competitors;

• the level of awareness of aesthetic procedures and the market adoption of the Company’s products;
• changes in the Company’s pricing policies or those of the Company’s competitors;

32

Table of Contents

• governmental budgetary constraints or shifts in government spending priorities;
• general political developments, both domestic and in the Company’s foreign markets, including economic and political uncertainty caused by elections;
• natural disasters;
• tax law changes;
• currency exchange rate fluctuations; and
• any trade restrictions or higher import taxes that may be imposed by foreign countries against products sold internationally by U.S. companies.

Macroeconomic  developments,  like  global  recessions  and  financial  crises  could  negatively  affect  the  Company’s  business,  operating  results,  or  financial
condition  which,  in  turn,  could  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  stock  price.  A  general  weakening  of,  and  related  declining  corporate  confidence  in,  the
global economy or the curtailment in government or corporate spending could cause current or potential customers to reduce their budgets or be unable to
fund product or upgrade application purchases, which could cause customers to delay, decrease or cancel purchases of the Company’s products and services
or cause customers not to pay the Company or to delay paying the Company for previously purchased products and services.

In addition, political unrest in regions like the Middle East, terrorist attacks around the globe and the potential for other hostilities in various parts of the
world, potential public health crises and natural disasters continue to contribute to a climate of economic and political uncertainty that could adversely affect
the Company’s results of operations and financial condition, including the Company’s revenue growth and profitability.

Macroeconomic declines, negative political developments, including volatile market conditions due to investor concerns regarding inflation and potential
hostilities  between  Russian  and  Ukraine,  adverse  market  conditions  and  catastrophic  events  may  cause  a  decline  in  the  Company’s  revenue,  negatively
affect the Company’s operating results, adversely affect the Company’s cash flow and could result in a decline in the Company’s stock price.

To  successfully  market  and  sell  the  Company’s  products  internationally,  the  Company  must  address  many  issues  that  are  unique  to  the  Company’s
international  business.  Furthermore,  international  expansion  is  a  key  component  of  the  Company’s  growth  strategy,  although  the  Company’s
international operations and foreign transactions expose the Company to additional operational challenges that the Company might not otherwise face.

The Company is focused on international expansion as a key component of its growth strategy and has identified specific areas of opportunity in various
international markets. Revenue from customers outside of North America is a material component of the Company’s business strategy and represented 52%
of  its  total  revenue  in  2021  compared  to  53%  of  the  Company’s  total  revenue  in  2020.  The  Company  employs  a  direct  sales  force  in  the  major
markets  throughout  Europe  as  well  as  Canada,  Japan  and  Australia/New  Zealand  while  using  third-party  distributors  to  sell  its  products  in  several  other
country in the Middle East, Asia, and South America in particular. The Company may be unable to increase or maintain its level of international revenue
due to supply chain disruptions or loss of distributor relationship.

The Company experienced significant turnover of the Company’s North America sales team during the first quarter of 2020. Though these departures did
not have an adverse effect on the Company’s international sales, they added additional pressure on the global sales team. While the Company continues to
have a direct sales and service organization in Australia, New Zealand, Japan, France, Belgium, Spain, Germany, Switzerland and the United Kingdom, a
significant portion of its international revenue is generated through its network of distributors. Though the Company continues to evaluate and replace non-
performing  distributors  and  has  recently  brought  greater  focus  to  collaboration  with  its  distribution  partners,  there  can  be  no  assurance  given  that  these
initiatives will result in improved international revenue or profitability in the future.

To grow the Company’s business, it is essential to improve productivity in current sales territories and expand into new territories. However, direct sales
productivity may not improve and distributors may not accept the Company’s business or commit the necessary resources to market and sell the Company’s
products  at  the  Company’s  expectations.  If  the  Company  is  not  able  to  increase  or  maintain  international  revenue  growth,  the  Company’s  total  revenue,
profitability and stock price may be adversely impacted.

If the Company fails to renew any of its distribution agreements as they expire under the terms of the particular agreement, its revenues and cash flow
may be adversely affected.

The  Company's  business  may  suffer  if  any  of  its  distribution  partners  terminates  or  otherwise  fails  to  renew  its  distribution  agreement  with  the
Company and the Company is otherwise unable to replace such agreement with a distribution agreement containing similar terms.

33

Table of Contents

Economic and other risks associated with international sales and operations could adversely affect the Company’s business.

In 2021, 52% of the Company’s total revenue was from customers outside of North America. The Company expects its sales from international operations
and export sales to continue to be a significant portion of the Company’s revenue. The Company has placed a particular emphasis on increasing its growth
and presence in international markets. The Company’s international operations and sales are subject, in varying degrees, to risks inherent in doing business
outside the U.S. These risks include:

• changes in trade protection measures, including embargoes, tariffs and other trade barriers, and import and export regulations and licensing requirements;
• instability and uncertainties arising from the global geopolitical environment, such as economic nationalism, populism, protectionism and anti-global

sentiment;

• changes in tax laws and potential negative consequences from the interpretation, application and enforcement by governmental tax authorities of tax laws

and policies;

• unanticipated changes in other laws and regulations or in how such provisions are interpreted or administered;
• reduced protection for intellectual property rights in some countries and practical difficulties of enforcing intellectual property and contract rights abroad;
• possibility of unfavorable circumstances arising from host country laws or regulations, including those related to infrastructure and data transmission,

security and privacy;

• currency exchange rate fluctuations and restrictions on currency repatriation;
• difficulties and expenses related to implementing internal control over financial reporting and disclosure controls and procedures;
• disruption of sales from labor and political disturbances;
• regional safety and security considerations;
• increased costs and risks in developing, staffing and simultaneously managing global sales operations as a result of distance as well as language and

cultural differences;

• increased management, travel, infrastructure and legal compliance costs associated with having multiple international operations;
• lengthy payment cycles and difficulty in collecting accounts receivable;
• preference for locally-produced products, as well as protectionist laws and business practices that favor local companies;
• outbreak or escalation of insurrection, armed conflict, terrorism or war; and
• supply chain disruption or the loss of distributor relationships.

Changes  in  the  geopolitical  or  economic  environments  in  the  countries  in  which  the  Company  operates  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  the
Company’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows. For example, changes in U.S. policy regarding international trade, including import and
export  regulation  and  international  trade  agreements,  could  also  negatively  impact  the  Company’s  business.  In  2018,  the  U.S.  imposed  tariffs  on  certain
goods imported from China and certain other countries, which has resulted in retaliatory tariffs by China and other countries. Additional tariffs imposed by
the  U.S.  on  a  broader  range  of  imports,  or  further  retaliatory  trade  measures  taken  by  China  or  other  countries  in  response,  could  adversely  impact  the
Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

The  Company’s  global  operations  are  required  to  comply  with  the  U.S.  Foreign  Corrupt  Practices  Act  of  1977,  as  amended  (“FCPA”),  Chinese  anti-
corruption laws, U.K. Bribery Law, and similar anti-bribery laws in other jurisdictions, and with U.S. and foreign export control, trade embargo and customs
laws. If the Company fails to comply with any of these laws, the Company could suffer civil and criminal sanctions.

Since January 1, 2021, the Medicines and Healthcare Products Regulatory Agency (“MHRA”) has been responsible for the UK medical device market. New
regulations  require  medical  devices  to  be  registered  with  the  MHRA.  Manufacturers  based  outside  the  UK  need  to  appoint  a  UK  Responsible  Person  to
register devices with the MHRA. By July 1, 2023, in the United Kingdom, all medical devices will require a UKCA (UK Conformity Assessed) mark, but
CE marks issued by EU notified bodies will remain valid until this time. However, UKCA marking alone will not be recognized in the EU.

In  addition  to  the  general  risks  that  the  Company  faces  outside  the  U.S.,  the  Company’s  operations  in  emerging  markets  could  involve  additional
uncertainties for us, including risks that governments may impose withholding or other taxes on remittances and other payments to us, or the amount of any
such taxes may increase; governments may seek to nationalize the Company’s assets; or governments may impose or increase investment barriers or other
restrictions  affecting  the  Company’s  business.  In  addition,  emerging  markets  pose  other  uncertainties,  including  the  difficulty  of  enforcing  agreements,
challenges collecting receivables, protection of the Company’s intellectual property and other assets, pressure on the pricing of the Company’s products and
services, higher business conduct risks, ability to hire and retain qualified talent and risks of political instability. The Company cannot predict the impact
such events might have on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

34

Table of Contents

In addition, compliance with laws and regulations applicable to the Company’s international operations increases the Company’s cost of doing business in
foreign jurisdictions. The Company may be unable to keep current with changes in foreign government requirements and laws as they change from time to
time. Failure to comply with these regulations could have adverse effects on the Company’s business. In many foreign countries it is common for others to
engage in business practices that are prohibited by the Company’s internal policies and procedures or U.S. regulations applicable to us. In addition, although
the Company has implemented policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance with these laws and policies, there can be no assurance that all of the
Company’s  employees,  contractors,  distributors  and  agents  will  comply  with  these  laws  and  policies.  Violations  of  laws  or  key  control  policies  by  the
Company’s employees, contractors, distributors or agents could result in delays in revenue recognition, financial reporting misstatements, fines, penalties, or
the prohibition of the importation or exportation of the Company’s offerings and could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business operations
and financial results.

To successfully market and sell third party products internationally, the Company must address many issues that are unique to the related distribution
arrangements which could reduce the Company’s available cash reserves and negatively impact the Company’s profitability.

The  Company  has  entered  into  distribution  arrangements  pursuant  to  which  the  Company  utilizes  its  sales  force  and  distributors  to  sell  products
manufactured by other companies. In Japan, the Company has a non-exclusive right to distribute a Q-switched laser product manufactured by a third party
OEM. The Company also has an exclusive agreement with ZO to distribute certain of their proprietary skincare products in Japan. Each of these agreements
requires the Company to purchase annual minimum dollar amounts of their products. Additionally, the Company has entered into distribution arrangements
with other companies to promote and sell the Secret RF products.

Each of these distribution agreements presents its own unique risks and challenges. For example, to sell skincare products the Company needs to invest in
creating a sales structure that is experienced in the sale of such products and not in capital equipment. The Company needs to commit resources to train the
Company’s sales force, obtain regulatory licenses, and develop new marketing materials to promote the sale of these products. In addition, the minimum
commitments and other costs of distributing products manufactured by these companies may exceed the incremental revenue that the Company derives from
the sale of their products, thereby negatively impacting the Company’s profitability and reducing the Company’s available cash reserves.

If  the  Company  does  not  make  the  minimum  purchases  required  in  the  distribution  contracts,  or  if  the  third  party  manufacturer  revokes  the  Company’s
distribution rights, the Company could lose the distribution rights of the products, which would adversely affect the Company’s future revenue, results of
operations, cash flows and its stock price.

The Company offers credit terms to some qualified customers and also to leasing companies to finance the purchase of its products. In the event that
any of these customers default on the amounts payable to the Company, its earnings may be adversely affected.

The  Company  generally  offers  credit  terms  of  30  to  90  days  to  qualified  customers.  In  addition,  from  time  to  time,  it  offers  certain  key  international
distributors, with whom the Company has had an extended period of relationship and payment history, payment terms that are significantly longer than the
regular  30  to  90  day  terms.  This  allows  such  international  distribution  partners  to  have  its  products  in  stock  and  provide  its  products  to  customers  on  a
timely basis.

While the Company believes it has an adequate basis to ensure that it collects its accounts receivable, the Company cannot provide any assurance that the
financial position of customers to whom it has provided payment terms will not change adversely before the Company receives payment. In the event that
there  is  a  default  by  any  of  the  customers  to  whom  the  Company  has  provided  credit  terms,  the  Company  may  recognize  a  credit  loss  provision  write-
off charge in the Company’s general and administrative expenses. If this write-off charge is material, it could negatively affect the Company’s future results
of operations, cash flows and its stock price.

Additionally, in the event of deterioration of general business conditions or the availability of credit, the financial strength and stability of the Company’s
customers  and  potential  customers  may  deteriorate  over  time,  which  may  cause  them  to  cancel  or  delay  their  purchase  of  its  products.  In  addition,  the
Company may be subject to increased risk of non-payment of its accounts receivables. The Company may also be adversely affected by bankruptcies or
other business failures of the Company’s customers and potential customers. A significant delay in the collection of funds or a reduction of funds collected
may impact the Company’s liquidity or result in credit losses.

35

Table of Contents

The Company’s ability to effectively compete and generate additional revenue from new and existing products depends upon the Company’s ability to
distinguish the Company and its products from the competitors and their products, and to develop and effectively market new and existing products. The
Company’s success is dependent on many factors, including the following:

• speed of new and innovative product development;
• effective strategy and execution of new product launches;
• identification and development of clinical support for new indications of the Company’s existing products;
• product performance;
• product pricing;
• quality of customer support;
• development of successful distribution channels, both domestically and internationally; and
• intellectual property protection.

To compete effectively, the Company has to demonstrate that its new and existing products are attractive alternatives to other devices and treatments, by
differentiating  the  Company’s  products  on  the  basis  of  such  factors  as  innovation,  performance,  brand  name,  service,  and  price.  This  is  difficult  to  do,
especially in a crowded aesthetic market. Some of the Company’s competitors have newer or different products and more established customer relationships
than the Company does, which could inhibit the Company’s market penetration efforts. For example, the Company has encountered, and expects to continue
to  encounter,  situations  where,  due  to  pre-existing  relationships,  potential  customers  decide  to  purchase  additional  products  from  the  Company’s
competitors. Potential customers also may need to recoup the cost of products that they have already purchased from the Company’s competitors and may
decide  not  to  purchase  the  Company’s  products,  or  to  delay  such  purchases.  If  the  Company  is  unable  to  increase  the  Company’s  market  penetration  or
compete effectively, its revenue and profitability will be adversely impacted.

The  Company  competes  against  companies  that  offer  alternative  solutions  to  its  products,  have  greater  resources,  or  have  a  larger  installed  base  of
customers and broader product offerings than the Company’s. In addition, increased consolidation in the Company’s industry may lead to increased
competition. If the Company is not able to effectively compete with these companies, it may harm its business.

The  medical  technology  and  aesthetic  product  markets  are  highly  competitive  and  dynamic  and  are  characterized  by  rapid  and  substantial  technology
development and product innovations. The Company’s products compete against conventional non-energy-based treatments, such as electrolysis, Botox and
collagen  injections,  chemical  peels,  microdermabrasion  and  sclerotherapy.  The  Company’s  products  also  compete  against  laser  and  other  energy-  based
products offered by other companies. Further, other companies could introduce new products that are in direct competition with the Company’s products.
The  Company  may  also  face  competition  from  manufacturers  of  pharmaceutical  and  other  products  that  have  not  yet  been  developed.  Competition  with
these companies could result in reduced selling prices, reduced profit margins and loss of market share, any of which would harm the Company’s business,
financial condition and results of operations.

There  has  been  consolidation  in  the  aesthetic  industry  leading  to  companies  combining  their  resources,  which  increases  competition  and  could  result  in
increased  downward  pressure  on  the  Company’s  product  prices.  Consolidations  have  created  newly-combined  entities  with  greater  financial  resources,
deeper sales channels and greater pricing flexibility than the Company. Rumored or actual consolidation of the Company’s partners and competitors could
cause uncertainty and disruption to the Company’s business and can cause the Company’s stock price to fluctuate.

If there is not sufficient consumer demand for the procedures performed with the Company’s products, practitioner demand for its products could be
inhibited, resulting in unfavorable operating results and reduced growth potential.

Continued  expansion  of  the  global  market  for  laser  and  other-energy-based  aesthetic  procedures  is  a  material  assumption  of  the  Company’s  business
strategy.  Most  procedures  performed  using  the  Company’s  products  are  elective  procedures  not  reimbursable  through  government  or  private  health
insurance,  with  the  costs  borne  by  the  patient.  The  decision  to  utilize  the  Company’s  products  may  therefore  be  influenced  by  a  number  of  factors,
including:

• consumer disposable income and access to consumer credit, which as a result of an unstable economy, may be significantly impacted;
• the cost, safety and effectiveness of alternative treatments, including treatments which are not based upon laser or other energy-based technologies and

treatments which use pharmaceutical products;

• the success of the Company’s sales and marketing efforts; and
• the education of the Company’s customers and patients on the benefits and uses of the Company’s products, compared to competitors’ products and

technologies.

36

Table of Contents

If,  as  a  result  of  these  factors,  there  is  not  sufficient  demand  for  the  procedures  performed  with  the  Company’s  products,  practitioner  demand  for  the
Company’s products could be reduced, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, revenue and result of
operations.

The Company's products and its operations are subject to extensive government regulation and oversight in the United States. If the Company fails to
obtain or maintain necessary regulatory clearances or approvals for its products, or if approvals or clearances for future products are delayed or not
issued, it will negatively affect its business, financial condition and results of operations.

The Company's laser products are medical devices subject to extensive regulation in the United States and elsewhere, including by the FDA and its foreign
counterparts. Government regulations specific to medical devices are wide ranging and govern, among other things:

• product design, development, manufacture, and release;
• laboratory and clinical testing, labeling, packaging, storage and distribution;
• product safety and efficacy;
• pre-marketing clearance or approval;
• service operations;
• record keeping;
• product marketing, promotion and advertising, sales and distribution;
• post-marketing surveillance, including reporting of deaths or serious injuries and recalls and correction and removals;
• post-market approval studies; and
• product import and export.

The FDA classifies medical devices into one of three classes on the basis of the intended use of the device, the risk associated with the use of the device for
that indication, as determined by the FDA, and on the controls deemed by the FDA to be necessary to reasonably ensure their safety and effectiveness.

Class  I  includes  devices  with  the  lowest  risk  to  the  patient  and  are  those  for  which  safety  and  effectiveness  can  be  assured  by  adherence  to  the  FDA’s
General Controls for medical devices, which include compliance with the applicable portions of the QSR facility registration and product listing, reporting
of  adverse  medical  events,  and  truthful  and  non-misleading  labeling,  advertising,  and  promotional  materials.  Class  II  devices  are  subject  to  the  FDA’s
General Controls, and special controls as deemed necessary by the FDA to ensure the safety and effectiveness of the device. These special controls can
include performance standards, post-market surveillance, patient registries and FDA guidance documents.

While most Class I devices are exempt from the premarket notification requirement, manufacturers of most Class II devices are required to submit to the
FDA a premarket notification under Section 510(k) of the FDCA requesting permission to commercially distribute the device. The FDA’s permission to
commercially distribute a device subject to a 510(k) premarket notification is generally known as 510(k) clearance. Devices deemed by the FDA to pose the
greatest risks, such as life sustaining, life supporting or some implantable devices, or devices that have a new intended use, or use advanced technology that
is  not  substantially  equivalent  to  that  of  a  legally  marketed  device,  are  placed  in  Class  III,  requiring  approval  of  a  PMA  application.  Some  pre-
amendment  devices  are  unclassified,  but  are  subject  to  FDA’s  premarket  notification  and  clearance  process  in  order  to  be  commercially  distributed.  The
Company's currently marketed products are Class II devices subject to 510(k) clearance, which the Company has obtained from the FDA.

Before a new medical device, or a new intended use of, claim for, or significant modification to an existing device, can be marketed in the United States, a
company must first submit an application for and receive either 510(k) clearance pursuant to a premarket notification submitted under Section 510(k) of the
FDCA, or PMA approval from the FDA, unless an exemption applies. The 510(k), or PMA processes can be expensive, lengthy and unpredictable. The
FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to 12 months, but can last longer. The process of obtaining a PMA approval is much more costly
and uncertain than the 510(k) clearance process and generally takes from one to three years, or even longer, from the time the application is filed with the
FDA. In addition, a PMA approval generally requires the performance of one or more clinical trials. Despite the time, effort and cost, a device may not be
approved or cleared by the FDA. Any delay or failure to obtain necessary regulatory clearances or approvals could harm its business. Furthermore, even if
the Company is granted regulatory clearances or approvals, they may include significant limitations on the indicated uses for the device, which may limit
the market for the device.

The Company has obtained 510(k) clearances to market its products. The FDA or other regulators could delay, limit, or deny clearance or approval of a
device for many reasons, including:

37

Table of Contents

• The Company's inability to demonstrate to the satisfaction of the FDA or the applicable regulatory entity or notified body that the Company's currently
marketed devices, or any other future device, and any accessories are substantially equivalent to a legally marketed predicate device or safe or effective
for their proposed intended uses;

• the disagreement of the FDA with the design or implementation of any clinical trials or the interpretation of data from preclinical studies or clinical trials;
• serious and unexpected adverse device effects experienced by participants in its clinical trials;
• the insufficiency of the data from preclinical studies or clinical trials to support clearance or approval, where required;
• our inability to demonstrate that the clinical and other benefits of the device outweigh the risks;
• the failure of its manufacturing process or facilities to meet applicable requirements; and
• the potential for approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory bodies to change significantly in a manner rendering its

clinical data or regulatory filings insufficient for clearance or approval.

The  regulations  to  which  the  Company  is  subject  are  complex  and  have  tended  to  become  more  stringent  over  time.  Regulatory  changes  could  result  in
restrictions on the Company's ability to carry on or expand its operations, higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales. The FDA enforces
these  regulatory  requirements  through,  among  other  means,  periodic  unannounced  inspections.  The  Company  does  not  know  whether  it  will  be  found
compliant  in  connection  with  any  future  regulatory  inspections.  Moreover,  the  FDA  and  state  authorities  have  broad  enforcement  powers.  Its  failure  to
comply  with  applicable  regulatory  requirements  could  result  in  enforcement  action  by  any  such  agency.  If  any  of  these  events  were  to  occur,  it  would
negatively affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.

If  the  Company  fails  to  comply  with  applicable  regulatory  requirements,  it  could  result  in  enforcement  action  by  the  U.S.  FDA,  federal  and  state
agencies or international regulatory bodies and the Company’s commercial operations would be harmed.

The Company’s products are medical devices that are subject to extensive regulation in the U.S. by the FDA for manufacturing, labeling, sale, promotion,
distribution and shipping. The FDA, state authorities and international regulatory bodies have broad enforcement powers. If the Company fails to comply
with any U.S. law or any of the applicable regulatory requirements of the FDA, or federal or state agencies, or one of the international regulatory bodies, it
could result in enforcement action by the agencies, which may include any of the following sanctions:

• warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
• repair, replacement, recall or seizure of the Company’s products;
• operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
• refusing the Company’s requests for 510(k) clearance of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;
• withdrawing 510(k) clearance or pre-market approvals that have already been granted; and
• criminal prosecution.

Federal regulatory reforms and changes occurring at the FDA could adversely affect the Company’s ability to sell its products profitably and financial
condition.

From  time  to  time,  legislation  is  drafted  and  introduced  in  Congress  that  could  significantly  change  the  statutory  provisions  governing  the  clearance  or
approval, manufacture and marketing of a device. It is impossible to predict whether legislative changes will be enacted or FDA regulations, guidance or
interpretations changed, and what the impact of such changes, if any, may be.

In addition, FDA regulations and guidance are often revised or reinterpreted by the agency in ways that may significantly affect the Company’s business and
the Company’s products. Changes in FDA regulations may lengthen the regulatory approval process for medical devices and require additional clinical data
to support regulatory clearance for the sale and marketing of the Company’s new products. In addition, it may require additional safety monitoring, labeling
changes, restrictions on product distribution or use, or other measures after the introduction of the Company’s products to market. Either of these changes
lengthen  the  duration  to  market,  increase  the  Company’s  costs  of  doing  business,  adversely  affect  the  future  permitted  uses  of  approved  products,  or
otherwise adversely affect the market for its products.

The Company supports any action that helps ensure patient safety going forward. The Company has a robust, multi-functional process that reviews its
promotional claims and materials to ensure they are truthful, not misleading, fair and balanced, and supported by sound scientific evidence.

Changes  in  funding  or  disruptions  at  the  FDA  and  other  government  agencies  caused  by  funding  shortages  or  global  health  concerns  could  hinder
their ability to hire and retain key leadership and other personnel, or otherwise prevent new or modified products from being developed, approved or
commercialized in a timely manner or at all, or otherwise prevent those agencies

38

Table of Contents

from performing normal business functions on which the operation of the Company's business may rely, which could negatively impact its business.

The ability of the FDA to review and approve new products can be affected by a variety of factors, including government budget and funding levels, ability
to hire and retain key personnel and accept the payment of user fees, and statutory, regulatory, and policy changes, and other events that may otherwise
affect the FDA’s ability to perform routine functions. Average review times at the agency have fluctuated in recent years as a result. In addition, government
funding of other government agencies on which the Company's operations may rely, including those that fund research and development activities is subject
to the political process, which is inherently fluid and unpredictable.

Disruptions at the FDA and other agencies may also slow the time necessary for new product applications to be reviewed and/or approved by necessary
government agencies, which would adversely affect its business. For example, in response to the COVID-19 pandemic, the FDA has indicated that it will
consider  alternative  methods  for  inspections  and  could  exercise  discretion  on  a  case-by-case  basis  to  approve  products  based  on  a  desk  review,  if  a
prolonged  government  shutdown  occurs,  or  if  global  health  concerns  continue  to  prevent  the  FDA  or  other  regulatory  authorities  from  conducting  their
regular inspections, reviews, or other regulatory activities, it could significantly impact the ability of the FDA to timely review and process its regulatory
submissions, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business.

If the Company fails to comply with the FDA’s Quality System Regulation and laser performance standards, the Company’s manufacturing operations
could be halted, and its business would suffer.

The Company is currently required to demonstrate and maintain compliance with the FDA’s Quality System Regulation (the “QSR”). The QSR is a complex
regulatory scheme that covers the methods and documentation of the design, testing, control, manufacturing, labeling, quality assurance, packaging, storage
and  shipping  of  the  Company’s  products.  Because  the  Company’s  products  involve  the  use  of  lasers,  the  Company’s  products  also  are  covered  by  a
performance standard for lasers set forth in FDA regulations. The laser performance standard imposes specific record-keeping, reporting, product testing
and product labeling requirements. These requirements include affixing warning labels to laser products, as well as incorporating certain safety features in
the design of laser products.

The  FDA  enforces  the  QSR  and  laser  performance  standards  through  periodic  unannounced  inspections.  The  Company  has  had  multiple  quality  system
inspections by the FDA, as well as audits the Company’s Notified Body, and other foreign regulatory agencies, with the most recent inspection by the FDA
occurring  under  the  Medical  Device  Single  Audit  Program  in  January  2021.  There  were  no  significant  findings  or  observations  as  a  result  of  this  audit.
Failure to take satisfactory corrective action in response to an adverse QSR inspection or its failure to comply with applicable laser performance standards
could result in enforcement actions, including a public warning letter, a shutdown of the Company’s manufacturing operations, a recall of its products, civil
or criminal penalties, or other sanctions, such as those described in the preceding paragraph, which would cause its sales and business to suffer.

The Company is subject to the FDA's Bioresearch Monitoring (BIMO) program. As such, the BIMO audits the Company and the Company is also subject
to FDA regulations relating to the design and conduct of clinical trials. The Company is subject to unannounced BIMO audits, with the most recent
inspection by FDA completed over five years ago in August 2016. There were no significant findings and only two observations as a result of this audit. The
Company’s responses to these observations were accepted by the FDA. Failure to take satisfactory corrective action in response to an adverse BIMO
inspection or the Company’s failure to comply with Good Clinical Practices could result in the Company no longer being able to sponsor Biomedical
Research, the reversal of 510(k) clearances previously granted based on the results of clinical trials conducted to gain clinical data to support those 510(k)
clearances, or enforcement actions, including a public warning letter, civil or criminal penalties, or other sanctions, such as those described in the preceding
paragraph, which would cause the Company’s sales and business to suffer.

If the Company modifies one of its FDA-cleared devices, it may need to seek a new clearance, which, if not granted, would prevent the Company from
selling its modified products or cause it to redesign its products.

Any modifications to an FDA-cleared device that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness or that would constitute a major change in its intended
use  would  require  a  new  510(k)  clearance  or  possibly  a  pre-market  approval.  The  Company  may  not  be  able  to  obtain  additional  510(k)  clearance  or
premarket  approvals  for  new  products  or  for  modifications  to,  or  additional  indications  for,  its  existing  products  in  a  timely  fashion,  or  at  all.  Delays  in
obtaining  future  clearance  would  adversely  affect  its  ability  to  introduce  new  or  enhanced  products  in  a  timely  manner,  which  in  turn  would  harm  its
revenue and future profitability.

The  Company  has  made  modifications  to  its  devices  in  the  past  and  may  make  additional  modifications  in  the  future  that  it  believes  do  not  or  will  not
require additional clearance or approvals. If the FDA disagrees, and requires new clearances or

39

Table of Contents

approvals  for  the  modifications,  the  Company  may  be  required  to  recall  and  to  stop  marketing  the  modified  devices,  which  could  harm  the  Company’s
operating results and require it to redesign its products.

The  Company  may  be  unable  to  obtain  or  maintain  international  regulatory  qualifications  or  approvals  for  its  current  or  future  products  and
indications, which could harm its business.

Sales  of  the  Company’s  products  outside  the  U.S.  are  subject  to  foreign  regulatory  requirements  that  vary  widely  from  country  to  country.  In  addition,
exports of medical devices from the U.S. are regulated by the FDA. Complying with international regulatory requirements can be an expensive and time-
consuming process and approval is not certain. The time required for obtaining clearance or approvals, if required by other countries, may be longer than
that  required  for  FDA  clearance  or  approvals,  and  requirements  for  such  clearances  or  approvals  may  significantly  differ  from  FDA  requirements.  The
Company may be unable to obtain or maintain regulatory qualifications, clearances or approvals in other countries. The Company may also incur significant
costs in attempting to obtain and in maintaining foreign regulatory approvals or qualifications. If the Company experience delays in receiving necessary
qualifications,  clearances  or  approvals  to  market  its  products  outside  the  U.S.,  or  if  the  Company  fails  to  receive  those  qualifications,  clearances  or
approvals, the Company may be unable to market its products or enhancements in international markets effectively, or at all, which could have a material
adverse effect on the Company’s business and growth strategy.

Any  defects  in  the  design,  material  or  workmanship  of  its  products  may  not  be  discovered  prior  to  shipment  to  customers,  which  could  materially
increase its expenses, adversely impact profitability and harm its business.

The  design  of  the  Company’s  products  is  complex.  To  manufacture  them  successfully,  the  Company  must  procure  quality  components  and  employ
individuals  with  a  significant  degree  of  technical  expertise.  If  the  Company’s  designs  are  defective,  or  the  material  components  used  in  its  products  are
subject to wearing out, or if suppliers fail to deliver components to specification, or if its employees fail to properly assemble, test and package its products,
the reliability and performance of its products could be adversely impacted.

If the Company’s products contain defects that cannot be repaired easily, inexpensively, or on a timely basis, the Company may experience:

• damage to the Company’s brand reputation;
• loss of customer orders and delay in order fulfillment;
• increased costs due to product repair or replacement;
• inability to attract new customers;
• diversion of resources from the Company’s manufacturing and research and development departments into the Company’s service department;
• changes in share-based compensation; and
• legal action.

The occurrence of any one or more of the foregoing could materially increase expenses, adversely impact profitability and harm the Company’s business.

The Company's products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that the Company is required to
report to the FDA, and if the Company fails to do so, the Company would be subject to sanctions that could harm its reputation, business, financial
condition and results of operations. The discovery of serious safety issues with its products, or a recall of the Company's products either voluntarily or at
the direction of the FDA or another governmental authority, could have a negative impact on the Company.

The Company is subject to the FDA’s medical device reporting regulations and similar foreign regulations, which require the Company to report to the FDA
when the Company receives or becomes aware of information that reasonably suggests that one or more of its products may have caused or contributed to a
death or serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that, if the malfunction were to recur, it could cause or contribute to a death or serious injury. The timing
of its obligation to report is triggered by the date the Company becomes aware of the adverse event as well as the nature of the event. The Company may
fail to report adverse events of which it becomes aware within the prescribed timeframe. The Company may also fail to recognize that it has become aware
of a reportable adverse event, especially if it is not reported to the Company as an adverse event or if it is an adverse event that is unexpected or removed in
time  from  the  use  of  the  product.  If  the  Company  fails  to  comply  with  its  reporting  obligations,  the  FDA  could  take  action,  including  warning  letters,
untitled letters, administrative actions, criminal prosecution, imposition of civil monetary penalties, revocation of its device clearance or approval, seizure of
its products or delay in clearance or approval of future products.

40

Table of Contents

The FDA and foreign regulatory bodies have the authority to require the recall of commercialized products in the event of material deficiencies or defects in
design or manufacture of a product or in the event that a product poses an unacceptable risk to health. The FDA’s authority to require a recall must be based
on a finding that there is reasonable probability that the device could cause serious injury or death. The Company may also choose to voluntarily recall a
product if any material deficiency is found. A government-mandated or voluntary recall by the Company could occur as a result of an unacceptable risk to
health,  component  failures,  malfunctions,  manufacturing  defects,  labeling  or  design  deficiencies,  packaging  defects  or  other  deficiencies  or  failures  to
comply with applicable regulations. Product defects or other errors may occur in the future.

Depending on the corrective action the Company takes to redress a product’s deficiencies or defects, the FDA may require, or the Company may decide,
that  it  will  need  to  obtain  new  clearances  or  approvals  for  the  device  before  the  Company  may  market  or  distribute  the  corrected  device.  Seeking  such
clearances  or  approvals  may  delay  its  ability  to  replace  the  recalled  devices  in  a  timely  manner.  Moreover,  if  the  Company  does  not  adequately  address
problems  associated  with  its  devices,  the  Company  may  face  additional  regulatory  enforcement  action,  including  FDA  warning  letters,  product  seizure,
injunctions, administrative penalties or civil or criminal fines.

Companies  are  required  to  maintain  certain  records  of  recalls  and  corrections,  even  if  they  are  not  reportable  to  the  FDA.  The  Company  may  initiate
voluntary withdrawals or corrections for its products in the future that the Company determines do not require notification of the FDA. If the FDA disagrees
with its determinations, it could require the Company to report those actions as recalls and the Company may be subject to enforcement action. A future
recall  announcement  could  harm  its  reputation  with  customers,  potentially  lead  to  product  liability  claims  against  the  Company  and  negatively  affect
its sales. Any corrective action, whether voluntary or involuntary, as well as defending itself in a lawsuit, will require the dedication of its time and capital,
will distract management from operating its business and may harm its reputation and financial results.

Our products may in the future be subject to product recalls that could harm its reputation, business and financial results.

Medical devices can experience performance problems in the field that require review and possible corrective action. The occurrence of component failures,
manufacturing errors, software errors, design defects or labeling inadequacies affecting a medical device could lead to a government-mandated or voluntary
recall  by  the  device  manufacturer,  in  particular  when  such  deficiencies  may  endanger  health.  The  FDA  requires  that  certain  classifications  of  recalls  be
reported to the FDA within 10 working days after the recall is initiated. Companies are required to maintain certain records of recalls, even if they are not
reportable  to  the  FDA.  The  Company  may  initiate  voluntary  recalls  involving  its  products  in  the  future  that  the  Company  determines  do  not  require
notification of the FDA. If the FDA disagrees with its determinations, they could require the Company to report those actions as recalls. Product recalls may
divert  management  attention  and  financial  resources,  expose  the  Company  to  product  liability  or  other  claims,  harm  its  reputation  with  customers  and
adversely impact its business, financial condition and results of operations.

Clinical trials may be necessary to support future product submissions to the FDA. The clinical trial process is lengthy and expensive with uncertain
outcomes,  and  often  requires  the  enrollment  of  large  numbers  of  patients,  and  suitable  patients  may  be  difficult  to  identify  and  recruit.  Delays  or
failures  in  the  Company's  clinical  trials  will  prevent  it  from  commercializing  any  modified  or  new  products  and  will  adversely  affect  its  business,
operating results and prospects.

The Company has conducted clinical trials in the past and will likely conduct clinical trials in the future. Initiating and completing clinical trials necessary to
support any future product candidates, will be time-consuming and expensive and the outcome, uncertain. Moreover, the results of early clinical trials are
not necessarily predictive of future results, and any product the Company advances into clinical trials may not have favorable results in later clinical trials.
The results of preclinical studies and clinical trials of its products conducted to date and ongoing or future studies and trials of its current, planned or future
products  may  not  be  predictive  of  the  results  of  later  clinical  trials,  and  interim  results  of  a  clinical  trial  do  not  necessarily  predict  final  results.  The
Company's interpretation of data and results from its clinical trials do not ensure that the Company will achieve similar results in future clinical trials. In
addition, preclinical and clinical data are often susceptible to various interpretations and analyses, and many companies that have believed their products
performed satisfactorily in preclinical studies and earlier clinical trials have nonetheless failed to replicate results in later clinical trials. Products in later
stages  of  clinical  trials  may  fail  to  show  the  desired  safety  and  efficacy  despite  having  progressed  through  nonclinical  studies  and  earlier  clinical  trials.
Failure  can  occur  at  any  stage  of  clinical  testing.  The  Company's  clinical  studies  may  produce  negative  or  inconclusive  results,  and  it  may  decide,  or
regulators may require us, to conduct additional clinical and non-clinical testing in addition to those the Company has planned.

• the Company may be required to submit an IDE application to the FDA, which must become effective prior to commencing certain human clinical trials

of medical devices, and the FDA may reject the Company's IDE application and notify the Company that it may not begin clinical trials;

• regulators and other comparable foreign regulatory authorities may disagree as to the design or implementation of its clinical trials;

41

Table of Contents

• regulators and/or an IRB, or other reviewing bodies may not authorize the Company or its investigators to commence a clinical trial, or to conduct or

continue a clinical trial at a prospective or specific trial site;

• the Company may not reach agreement on acceptable terms with prospective contract research organizations, or CROs, and clinical trial sites, the terms of

which can be subject to extensive negotiation and may vary significantly among different CROs and trial sites;

• clinical trials may produce negative or inconclusive results, and the Company may decide, or regulators may require the Company to conduct additional

clinical trials or abandon product development programs;

• the number of subjects or patients required for clinical trials may be larger than the Company anticipates, enrollment in these clinical trials may be

insufficient or slower than the Company anticipates, and the number of clinical trials being conducted at any given time may be high and result in fewer
available patients for any given clinical trial, or patients may drop out of these clinical trials at a higher rate than the Company anticipates;

• the Company's third-party contractors, including those manufacturing products or conducting clinical trials on the Company's behalf, may fail to comply

with regulatory requirements or meet their contractual obligations to the Company in a timely manner, or at all;

• the Company might have to suspend or terminate clinical trials for various reasons, including a finding that the subjects are being exposed to unacceptable

health risks;

• the Company may have to amend clinical trial protocols or conduct additional studies to reflect changes in regulatory requirements or guidance, which it

may be required to submit to an IRB and/or regulatory authorities for re-examination;

• regulators, IRBs, or other parties may require or recommend that the Company or its investigators suspend or terminate clinical research for various

reasons, including safety signals or noncompliance with regulatory requirements;

• the cost of clinical trials may be greater than the Company anticipates;
• clinical sites may not adhere to the clinical protocol or may drop out of a clinical trial;
• the Company may be unable to recruit a sufficient number of clinical trial sites;
• regulators, IRBs, or other reviewing bodies may fail to approve or subsequently find fault with its manufacturing processes or facilities of third-party

manufacturers with which the Company enters into agreement for clinical and commercial supplies, the supply of devices or other materials necessary to
conduct clinical trials may be insufficient, inadequate or not available at an acceptable cost, or the Company may experience interruptions in supply;
• approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory agencies may change in a manner rendering the Company's clinical data

insufficient for approval;

• the Company's current or future products may have undesirable side effects or other unexpected characteristics; and
• impacts of regional or global public health crises including the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic could adversely affect any clinical trials the Company is
conducting or plan to conduct, including delays or difficulties in enrolling or onboarding patients, initiating clinical sites, or obtaining the requisite
regulatory approvals, interruption of key clinical trial activities, or supply chain disruptions that delay or make it more difficult or costly to obtain the
supplies and materials the Company needs for clinical trials.

Any of these occurrences may significantly harm the Company's business, financial condition and prospects. In addition, many of the factors that cause, or
lead to, a delay in the commencement or completion of clinical trials may also ultimately lead to the denial of regulatory approval of its product candidates.

Clinical trials must be conducted in accordance with the laws and regulations of the FDA and other applicable regulatory authorities’ legal requirements,
regulations  or  guidelines,  and  are  subject  to  oversight  by  these  governmental  agencies  and  IRBs  at  the  medical  institutions  where  the  clinical  trials  are
conducted. Conducting successful clinical studies will require the enrollment of large numbers of patients, and suitable patients may be difficult to identify
and recruit. Patient enrollment in clinical trials and completion of patient participation and follow-up depends on many factors, including the size of the
patient population, the nature of the trial protocol, the attractiveness of, or the discomforts and risks associated with, the treatments received by enrolled
subjects,  the  availability  of  appropriate  clinical  trial  investigators,  support  staff,  and  proximity  of  patients  to  clinical  sites  and  able  to  comply  with  the
eligibility and exclusion criteria for participation in the clinical trial and patient compliance. For example, patients may be discouraged from enrolling in
its  clinical  trials  if  the  trial  protocol  requires  them  to  undergo  extensive  post-treatment  procedures  or  follow-up  to  assess  the  safety  and  effectiveness  of
its products or if they determine that the treatments received under the trial protocols are not attractive or involve unacceptable risks or discomforts.

The  Company  depends  on  its  collaborators  and  on  medical  institutions  and  CROs  to  conduct  its  clinical  trials  in  compliance  with  good  clinical  practice
("GCP") requirements. To the extent its collaborators or the CROs fail to enroll participants for its clinical trials, fail to conduct the study to GCP standards
or  are  delayed  for  a  significant  time  in  the  execution  of  trials,  including  achieving  full  enrollment,  the  Company  may  be  affected  by  increased  costs,
program delays or both. In addition, clinical trials that are conducted in countries outside the United States may subject the Company to further delays and
expenses as a result of increased shipment costs, additional regulatory requirements and the engagement of non-U.S. CROs, as well as expose the

42

Table of Contents

Company to risks associated with clinical investigators who are unknown to the FDA, and different standards of diagnosis, screening and medical care.

Development of sufficient and appropriate clinical protocols to demonstrate safety and efficacy are required and the Company may not adequately develop
such  protocols  to  support  clearance  and  approval.  Further,  the  FDA  may  require  the  Company  to  submit  data  on  a  greater  number  of  patients  than  the
Company  originally  anticipated  and/or  for  a  longer  follow-up  period  or  change  the  data  collection  requirements  or  data  analysis  applicable  to  the
Company's clinical trials. Delays in patient enrollment or failure of patients to continue to participate in a clinical trial may cause an increase in costs and
delays in the approval and attempted commercialization of its products or result in the failure of the clinical trial. In addition, despite considerable time and
expense invested in its clinical trials, the FDA may not consider the Company's data adequate to demonstrate safety and efficacy. Such increased costs and
delays or failures could adversely affect its business, operating results and prospects.

The results of the Company's clinical trials may not support its product candidate claims or may result in the discovery of adverse side effects.

The  Company  cannot  be  certain  that  the  results  of  its  future  clinical  trials  will  support  its  future  product  claims  or  that  the  FDA  will  agree  with
its conclusions regarding them. Success in pre-clinical studies and early clinical trials does not ensure that later clinical trials will be successful, and the
Company cannot be sure that the later trials will replicate the results of prior trials and pre-clinical studies. The clinical trial process may fail to demonstrate
that its product candidates are safe and effective for the proposed indicated uses, which could cause the Company to abandon a product candidate and may
delay  development  of  others.  Any  delay  or  termination  of  the  Company's  clinical  trials  will  delay  the  filing  of  its  product  submissions  and,  ultimately,
its ability to commercialize its product candidates and generate revenues. It is also possible that patients enrolled in clinical trials will experience adverse
side effects that are not currently part of the future product’s profile.

Product liability suits could be brought against the Company due to a defective design, material or workmanship or misuse of its products and could
result in expensive and time-consuming litigation, payment of substantial damages and an increase in its insurance rates.

If  the  Company’s  products  are  defectively  designed,  manufactured  or  labeled,  contain  defective  components  or  are  misused,  the  Company  may  become
subject to substantial and costly litigation by the Company’s customers or their patients. Misusing the Company’s products or failing to adhere to operating
guidelines could cause significant eye and skin damage, and underlying tissue damage. In addition, if its operating guidelines are found to be inadequate, the
Company may be subject to liability. The Company has been involved, and may in the future be involved, in litigation related to the use of its products.
Product liability claims could divert management’s attention from its core business, be expensive to defend and result in sizable damage awards against the
Company. The Company may not have sufficient insurance coverage for all future claims. The Company may not be able to obtain insurance in amounts or
scope sufficient to provide the Company with adequate coverage against all potential liabilities. Any product liability claims brought against the Company,
with or without merit, could increase the Company’s product liability insurance rates or prevent the Company from securing continuing coverage, could
harm its reputation in the industry and could reduce product sales. In addition, the Company historically experienced steep increases in its product liability
insurance premiums as a percentage of revenue. If its premiums continue to rise, the Company may no longer be able to afford adequate insurance coverage.

If  customers  are  not  trained  and/or  the  Company’s  products  are  used  by  non-licensed  practitioners,  it  could  result  in  product  misuse  and  adverse
treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s  reputation,  result  in  product  liability  litigation,  distract  management  and  result  in  additional
costs, all of which could harm the Company’s business.

If  the  Company's  products  are  used  by  non-licensed  or  untrained  practitioners,  it  could  result  in  product  misuse  and  adverse  treatment  outcomes,  which
could harm the Company’s reputation and the Company’s business. U.S. federal regulations allow the Company to sell the Company’s products to or on the
order of “licensed practitioners.” The definition of “licensed practitioners” varies from state to state. As a result, the Company’s products may be purchased
or  operated  by  physicians  with  varying  levels  of  training,  and  in  many  states,  by  non-physicians,  including  nurse  practitioners,  chiropractors  and
technicians. Outside the U.S., many jurisdictions do not require specific qualifications or training for purchasers or operators of its products. The Company
does  not  supervise  the  procedures  performed  with  the  Company’s  products,  nor  does  the  Company  require  that  direct  medical  supervision  occur  that  is
determined  by  state  law.  The  Company  and  its  distributors  generally  offer  but  do  not  require  product  training  to  the  purchasers  or  operators  of  the
Company’s products. In addition, the Company sometimes sells its systems to companies that rent its systems to third parties and that provide a technician
to  perform  the  procedures.  The  lack  of  training  and  the  purchase  and  use  of  its  products  by  non-physicians  may  result  in  product  misuse  and  adverse
treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s reputation and its business, and, in the event these actions result in product liability litigation, distract
management and subject the Company to liability, including legal expenses.

43

Table of Contents

The Company’s manufacturing operations are dependent upon third-party suppliers, making its vulnerable to supply shortages and price fluctuations,
which could harm its business.

Many of the components and materials that comprise the Company’s products are currently manufactured by a limited number of suppliers. In addition, all
of  the  Company’s  skincare  products  are  manufactured  by  its  sole  supplier,  ZO.  A  supply  interruption  or  an  increase  in  demand  beyond  the  Company’s
current suppliers’ capabilities could harm the Company’s ability to manufacture its products until a new source of supply is identified and qualified. The
Company’s reliance on these suppliers subjects the Company to a number of risks that could harm its business, including:

• interruption of supply resulting from modifications to or discontinuation of a supplier’s operations;
• delays in product shipments resulting from uncorrected defects, reliability issues or a supplier’s variation in a component;
• lack of long-term supply arrangements for key components with the Company’s suppliers;
• inability to obtain adequate supply in a timely manner, or on reasonable terms;
• inability to redesign one or more components in the Company’s systems in the event that a supplier discontinues manufacturing such components and the

Company’s inability to sources it from other suppliers on reasonable terms;

• difficulty locating and qualifying alternative suppliers for the Company’s components in a timely manner;
• production delays related to the evaluation and testing of products from alternative suppliers and corresponding regulatory qualifications; and delay in

supplier deliveries.

Any interruption in the supply of components or materials, or the Company’s inability to obtain substitute components or materials from alternate sources at
acceptable prices in a timely manner, could impair its ability to meet the demand of the Company’s customers, which would have an adverse effect on the
Company’s business.

Risks related to the reduction or interruption in supply and an inability to develop alternative sources for supply may adversely affect the Company’s
manufacturing operations and related product sales.

The Company maintains manufacturing operations at its facility in Brisbane, California, and purchases many of the components and raw materials used in
manufacturing these products from numerous suppliers in various countries. Any problem affecting a supplier (whether due to external or internal causes)
could have a negative impact on the Company.

In a few limited cases, specific components and raw materials are purchased from primary or main suppliers (or in some cases, a single supplier) for reasons
related to quality assurance, cost-effectiveness ratio and availability. While the Company works closely with its suppliers to ensure supply continuity, the
Company  cannot  guarantee  that  its  efforts  will  always  be  successful.  Moreover,  due  to  strict  standards  and  regulations  governing  the  manufacture  and
marketing its products, it may not be able to quickly locate new supply sources in response to a supply reduction or interruption, with negative effects on its
ability to manufacture its products effectively and in a timely fashion.

The Company manufactures its goods at the Brisbane, California site, as well as dual sourcing several product platforms at contract manufacturing
shops for redundancy. A few of the product platforms such as Enlighten and excel HR are only capable of being produced at the single site in Brisbane,
and as such the occurrence of a catastrophic disaster or other similar event could cause damage to its facilities and equipment, which might require the
Company to cease or curtail sales of these sole sourced platforms.

The Company is vulnerable to damage from various types of disasters, including fires, earthquakes, terrorist acts, floods, power losses, communications
failures,  pandemics  and  similar  events.  If  any  such  disaster  were  to  occur,  the  Company  may  not  be  able  to  operate  the  Company’s  business  at  the
Company’s  facility  in  Brisbane,  California.  Before  the  Company  could  manufacture  products  from  a  replacement  facility,  the  Company’s  manufacturing
facilities which require regulatory agency approval, could require significant delays to obtain regulatory agency’s approval. The insurance the Company
maintains may not be adequate to cover the Company’s losses resulting from disasters or other business interruptions. Therefore, any such catastrophe could
seriously harm the Company’s business and consolidated results of operations.

Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all of the Company’s products, which may permit third parties to compete
against the Company more effectively.

The  Company  relies  on  patent,  copyright,  trade  secret  and  trademark  laws  and  confidentiality  agreements  to  protect  the  Company’s  technology  and
products.  As  of  January  19,  2022,  the  Company  had  28  issued  and  unexpired  U.S.  patents,  eight  pending  U.S.  patent  applications,  and  four  pending
international  applications  under  the  Patent  Cooperation  Treaty  ("PCT").  Some  of  the  Company’s  components,  such  as  the  Company’s  laser  module,
electronic  control  system  and  high-voltage  electronics,  are  not,  and  in  the  future  may  not  be,  protected  by  patents.  Additionally,  the  Company’s  patent
applications  may  not  issue  as  patents  or,  if  issued,  may  not  issue  in  a  form  that  will  be  advantageous  to  us.  Any  patents  the  Company  obtains  may  be
challenged,

44

Table of Contents

invalidated  or  legally  circumvented  by  third  parties.  Consequently,  competitors  could  market  products  and  use  manufacturing  processes  that  are
substantially  similar  to,  or  superior  to,  the  Company’s.  The  Company  may  not  be  able  to  prevent  the  unauthorized  disclosure  or  use  of  the  Company’s
technical  knowledge  or  other  trade  secrets  by  consultants,  vendors,  former  employees  or  current  employees,  despite  the  existence  generally  of
confidentiality  agreements  and  other  contractual  restrictions.  Monitoring  unauthorized  uses  and  disclosures  of  the  Company’s  intellectual  property  is
difficult, and the Company does not know whether the steps it has taken to protect the Company’s intellectual property will be effective. Moreover, the laws
of many foreign countries will not protect the Company’s intellectual property rights to the same extent as the laws of the U.S. 

The absence of complete intellectual property protection exposes the Company to a greater risk of direct competition. Competitors could purchase one of
the Company’s products and attempt to replicate some or all of the competitive advantages the Company derives from the Company’s development efforts,
design around the Company’s protected technology, or develop their own competitive technologies that fall outside of the Company’s intellectual property
rights. If the Company’s intellectual property is not adequately protected against competitors’ products and methods, the Company’s competitive position
and its business could be adversely affected.

The Company may be involved in future costly intellectual property litigation, which could impact its future business and financial performance.

The Company’s competitors or other patent holders may assert that the Company’s present or future products and the methods the Company employs are
covered by their patents. In addition, the Company does not know whether its competitors own or will obtain patents that they may claim prevent, limit or
interfere with the Company’s ability to make, use, sell or import the Company’s products.

The Company may become involved in litigation not only as a result of alleged infringement of a third party’s intellectual property rights but also to protect
the  Company’s  own  intellectual  property.  For  example,  the  Company  has  been  involved  in  litigation  to  protect  the  trademark  rights  associated  with  its
company  name  or  the  names  of  its  products.  Infringement  and  other  intellectual  property  claims,  with  or  without  merit,  can  be  expensive  and  time-
consuming to litigate, and could divert management’s attention from its core business.

The expense and potential unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers could adversely affect its ability to sell its products, and
therefore adversely affect its financial condition.

Some of the Company’s customers and prospective customers have had difficulty procuring or maintaining liability insurance to cover their operation and
use of its products. Medical malpractice carriers are withdrawing coverage in certain states or substantially increasing premiums. If this trend continues or
worsens, the Company’s customers may discontinue using the Company’s products and potential customers may opt against purchasing laser-based products
due  to  the  cost  or  inability  to  procure  insurance  coverage.  The  unavailability  of  insurance  coverage  for  the  Company’s  customers  and  prospects  could
adversely affect its ability to sell its products, and that could harm its financial condition.

From time to time the Company may become subject to income tax audits or similar proceedings, and as a result the Company may incur additional
costs and expenses or owe additional taxes, interest and penalties that may negatively impact its operating results.

The Company is subject to income taxes in the U.S. and certain foreign jurisdictions where it operates through a subsidiary, including Australia, Belgium,
Canada, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland, Italy and the United Kingdom. The Company’s determination of its tax liability is subject
to review by applicable domestic and foreign tax authorities.

The Company has gone through sales and income tax audits in the past. Although these audits did not result in any material adjustments, the final timing
and  resolution  of  any  future  tax  examinations  are  subject  to  significant  uncertainty  and  could  result  in  the  Company’s  having  to  pay  amounts  to  the
applicable tax authority in order to resolve examination of its tax positions. An increase or decrease of tax related to tax examination resolution could result
in a change in the Company’s income tax accrual and could negatively impact its financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

The  Company  may  be  adversely  affected  by  changes  in  U.S.  tax  laws,  importation  taxes  and  other  changes  that  may  be  imposed  by  the  current
administration.

The Company is subject to taxes in the U.S. and other jurisdictions. Tax rates in these jurisdictions may be subject to significant change due to economic
and/or political conditions. A number of other factors may also impact the Company’s future effective tax rate including:

• the jurisdictions in which profits are determined to be earned and taxed;

45

Table of Contents

• the resolution of issues arising from tax audits with various tax authorities;
• changes in valuation of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities;
• increases in expenses not deductible for tax purposes, including write-offs and impairment of goodwill in connection with acquisitions;
• changes in availability of tax credits, tax holidays, and tax deductions;
• changes in share-based compensation; and
• changes in tax laws or the interpretation of such tax laws and changes in generally accepted accounting principles.

Any  acquisitions  that  the  Company  makes  could  result  in  operating  difficulties,  dilution,  and  other  consequences  that  may  adversely  impact  the
Company’s business and results of operations.

While the Company from time to time evaluates potential acquisitions of businesses, products and technologies, and anticipates continuing to make these
evaluations, the Company has no present understandings, commitments or agreements with respect to any material acquisitions or collaborative projects.
The  Company  may  not  be  able  to  identify  appropriate  acquisition  candidates  or  strategic  partners,  or  successfully  negotiate,  finance  or  integrate  any
businesses, products or technologies that the Company acquire.

The Company has limited experience as a team with acquiring companies and products. Furthermore, the integration of any acquisition and management of
any collaborative project may divert management’s time and resources from the Company’s core business and disrupt the Company’s operations and it may
incur  significant  legal,  accounting  and  banking  fees  in  connection  with  such  a  transaction.  Acquisitions  could  diminish  the  Company’s  available  cash
balances  for  other  uses,  result  in  the  incurrence  of  debt,  contingent  liabilities,  or  amortization  expenses,  and  restructuring  charges.  Also,  the  anticipated
benefits or value of its acquisitions or investments may not materialize and could result in an impairment of goodwill and/or purchased long-lived assets.

The Company’s failure to address these risks or other problems encountered in connection with the Company’s past or future acquisitions and investments
could  cause  the  Company  to  fail  to  realize  the  anticipated  benefits  of  such  acquisitions  or  investments,  incur  unanticipated  liabilities,  and  harm  the
Company’s business and the Company’s financial condition or results.

The Company’s failure to comply with rules relating to bribery, foreign corrupt practices, and privacy and security laws may subject the Company to
penalties and adversely impact its reputation and business operations.

The Company’s business is subject to regulation and oversight worldwide including:

• the FCPA, which prohibits corporations and individuals from paying, offering to pay or authorizing the payment of anything of value to any foreign

government official, government staff member, political party or political candidate in an attempt to obtain or retain business or to otherwise influence a
person working in an official capacity;

• the UK Bribery Act, which prohibits both domestic and international bribery, as well as bribery across both public and private sectors; and bribery
provisions contained in the German Criminal Code, which, pursuant to draft legislation being prepared by the German government, may make the
corruption and corruptibility of physicians in private practice and other healthcare professionals a criminal offense;

• Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, as amended by The Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical Health Act,

which governs the conduct of certain electronic healthcare transactions and protects the security and privacy of protected health information; and
• analogous state and foreign law equivalents of each of the above laws, such as state laws that require device companies to comply with the industry’s

voluntary compliance guidelines and the applicable compliance guidance promulgated by the federal government; and state laws governing the privacy
and security of health information in certain circumstances, many of which differ from each other in significant ways and may not have the same effect,
thus complicating compliance efforts.

The risk of being found in violation of these laws is increased by the fact that many of them have not been fully interpreted by the regulatory authorities or
the courts, and their provisions are open to a variety of interpretations. Because of the breadth of these laws and the narrowness of the statutory exceptions
and  safe  harbors  available  under  such  laws,  it  is  possible  that  some  of  the  Company’s  business  activities,  including  the  Company’s  relationships  with
practitioners and thought leaders worldwide, some of whom recommend, purchase and/or use the Company’s devices, as well as the Company’s sales agents
and distributors, could be subject to challenge under one or more of such laws. The Company is also exposed to the risk that the Company’s employees,
independent contractors, principal investigators, consultants, vendors, independent sales agents and distributors may engage in fraudulent or other illegal
activity.  While  the  Company  has  policies  and  procedures  in  place  prohibiting  such  activity,  misconduct  by  these  parties  could  include,  among  other
infractions  or  violations,  intentional,  reckless  and/or  negligent  conduct  or  unauthorized  activity  that  violates  FDA  regulations,  including  those  laws  that
require  the  reporting  of  true,  complete  and  accurate  information  to  the  FDA,  manufacturing  standards,  laws  that  require  the  true,  complete  and  accurate
reporting of financial information or data or other commercial or regulatory laws or requirements. It is not always possible to identify and deter

46

Table of Contents

misconduct  by  the  Company’s  employees  and  other  third  parties,  and  the  precautions  the  Company  takes  to  detect  and  prevent  this  activity  may  not  be
effective in controlling unknown or unmanaged risks or losses or in protecting the Company from governmental investigations or other actions or lawsuits
stemming from a failure to be in compliance with such laws or regulations.

There are similar laws and regulations applicable to the Company outside the U.S., all of which are subject to evolving interpretations. Global enforcement
of  anti-  corruption  laws,  including  but  not  limited  to  the  UK  Bribery  Act,  the  Brazil  Clean  Companies  Act,  and  continued  enforcement  in  the  Europe,
Middle  East  and  Asia  Pacific  has  increased  substantially  in  recent  years,  with  more  frequent  voluntary  self-disclosures  by  companies,  aggressive
investigations and enforcement proceedings by governmental agencies, and assessment of significant fines and penalties against companies and individuals.
The Company’s operations create the risk of unauthorized payments or offers of payments by one of its employees, consultants, sales agents, or distributors
because these parties are not always subject to its control. It is the Company’s policy to implement safeguards to discourage these practices; however, its
existing  safeguards  and  any  future  improvements  may  prove  to  be  less  than  effective,  and  its  employees,  consultants,  sales  agents,  or  distributors  may
engage in conduct for which the Company might be held responsible. Any alleged or actual violations of these regulations may subject the Company to
government  scrutiny,  severe  criminal  or  civil  sanctions  and  other  liabilities,  and  could  negatively  affect  its  business,  reputation,  operating  results,  and
financial condition.

On July 27, 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority announced that it intends to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit LIBOR
rates  after  2021.  These  reforms  may  cause  LIBOR  to  cease  to  exist,  new  methods  of  calculating  LIBOR  to  be  established  or  the  establishment  of  an
alternative reference rate(s). These consequences cannot be entirely predicted and could have an adverse impact on the market value for or value of LIBOR-
linked securities, loans, and other financial obligations or extensions of credit held by the Company. Changes in market interest rates may influence returns
on financial investments and could reduce its earnings and cash flows.

While the Company believes it has a strong culture of compliance and adequate systems of control, and it seeks continuously to improve its systems of
internal controls and to remedy any weaknesses identified, there can be no assurance that the policies and procedures will be followed at all times or will
effectively  detect  and  prevent  violations  of  the  applicable  laws  by  one  or  more  of  its  employees,  consultants,  agents  or  partners  and,  as  a  result,  the
Company may be subject to penalties and material adverse consequences on its business, financial condition or results of operations.

The Company has identified a material weakness in its internal control over financial reporting at its Japan subsidiary, which could, if not remediated,
result in material misstatements in the Company's financial statements.

The  Company  is  responsible  for  establishing  and  maintaining  adequate  internal  control  over  financial  reporting,  as  defined  in  Rule  13a-15(f)  under  the
Securities Exchange Act. As disclosed in Item 9A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, the Company identified a material weakness in its internal control
over financial reporting relating to user access and segregation of duties conflicts at the Company's Japan subsidiary. A material weakness is defined as a
deficiency, or combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement
of  the  Company's  annual  or  interim  financial  statements  will  not  be  prevented  or  detected  on  a  timely  basis.  As  a  result  of  this  material  weakness,  the
Company  concluded  that  its  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  was  not  effective  based  on  criteria  set  forth  by  the  Committee  of  Sponsoring
Organization of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control-An Integrated Framework (2013).

To implement remedial measures as disclosed in Item 9A, the Company has begun the process of designing and implementing additional controls to detect
potential  unauthorized  entries  or  transactions  that  may  arise  as  a  result  of  the  user  access  and  segregation  of  duties  conflicts  at  the  Company's  Japan
subsidiary. If these remedial measures are insufficient to address the material weakness, or if additional material weaknesses or significant deficiencies in
the Company's internal control over financial reporting are discovered or occur in the future, the Company's consolidated financial statements may contain
material misstatements, and the Company could be required to restate its financial results. In addition, if the Company is unable to successfully remediate
the material weakness and is unable to produce accurate and timely financial statements, its stock price may be adversely affected.

47

Table of Contents

Risks Related to the Notes

Although the notes are referred to as convertible senior notes, they are effectively subordinated to any of the Company's secured debt and any liabilities
of its subsidiaries.

The notes will be the Company's senior unsecured obligations and will rank:

• senior in right of payment to all of its indebtedness that is expressly subordinated in right of payment to the notes;
• equal in right of payment to all of its unsecured indebtedness that is not so subordinated;
• effectively junior to any of its secured indebtedness to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness, including any amount outstanding

under the Company's senior credit facility; and

• structurally junior to all indebtedness and other liabilities of its current or future subsidiaries (including trade payables).

In the event of the Company's bankruptcy, liquidation reorganization or other winding up, the Company's assets that secure secured indebtedness will be
available to pay obligations on the notes only after all such secured indebtedness has been repaid in full from such assets. There may not be sufficient assets
remaining to pay amounts due on any or all of the notes then outstanding.

In addition the notes are the Company's obligations exclusively and are not guaranteed by any of its subsidiaries. A portion of the Company's operations are
conducted through, and a portion of its consolidated assets are held by its subsidiaries. Accordingly, the Company's ability to service its debt, including the
notes, depends, in part, on the results of operations of its subsidiaries and upon the ability of such subsidiaries to provide the Company with cash, whether in
the form of dividends, loans or otherwise, to pay amounts due on its obligations, including the notes. The Company's subsidiaries are separate and distinct
legal  entities  and  have  no  obligation  contingent  or  otherwise,  to  make  payments  on  the  notes  or  to  make  any  funds  available  for  that  purpose.  The
Company's right to receive any assets of any of its subsidiaries upon such subsidiary’s bankruptcy, liquidation or reorganization and, therefore, the right of
the holders of notes to participate in those assets, will be subject to prior claims of creditors of the subsidiary, including trade creditors, and such subsidiary
may  not  have  sufficient  assets  remaining  to  make  any  payments  to  the  Company  as  a  shareholder  or  otherwise.  In  addition,  dividends,  loans  or  other
distributions  to  the  Company  from  such  subsidiaries  may  be  subject  to  contractual  and  other  restrictions  and  are  subject  to  other  business  and  tax
considerations. The indenture governing the notes will not prohibit the Company from incurring additional senior debt or secured debt, nor will it prohibit
any of the Company's current or future subsidiaries from incurring additional liabilities.

Regulatory actions and other events may adversely affect the trading price and liquidity of the notes.

The Company expects that many investors in, and potential purchasers of, the notes will employ or seek to employ, a convertible arbitrage strategy with
respect to the notes. Investors would typically implement such a strategy by selling short the common stock underlying the notes and dynamically adjusting
their short position while continuing to hold the notes. Investors may also implement this type of strategy by entering into swaps on its common stock in
lieu of or in addition to short selling the common stock.

The  SEC  and  other  regulatory  and  self-regulatory  authorities  have  implemented  various  rules  and  taken  certain  actions,  and  may  in  the  future  adopt
additional rules and take other actions, that may impact those engaging in short selling activity involving equity securities (including its common stock).
Such  rules  and  actions  include  Rule  201  of  SEC  Regulation  SHO,  the  adoption  by  the  Financial  Industry  Regulatory  Authority,  Inc.  and  the  national
securities exchanges of a “Limit Up-Limit Down” program, the imposition of market-wide circuit breakers that halt trading of securities for certain periods
following specific market declines, and the implementation of certain regulatory reforms required by the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer
Protection Act of 2010. Any governmental or regulatory action that restricts the ability of investors in or potential purchasers of, the notes to effect short
sales of the Company's common stock, borrow its common stock or enter into swaps on the Company's common stock could adversely affect the trading
price and the liquidity of the notes.

Volatility in the market price and trading volume of the Company's common stock could adversely impact the trading price of the notes.

The Company expects that the trading price of the notes will be significantly affected by the market price of its common stock. The stock market in recent
years has experienced significant price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated to the operating performance of companies. The market price
of the Company's common stock could fluctuate significantly for many reasons, including in response to the risks described in this section, elsewhere in this
offering memorandum or the documents incorporated by reference in this offering memorandum or for reasons unrelated to its operations, many of which
are beyond the Company's control, such as reports by industry analysts, investor perceptions or negative announcements by its customers, competitors or
suppliers regarding their own performance, as well as industry conditions and general financial, economic and political instability. A decrease in the market
price of the Company's common stock would likely adversely impact the trading

48

Table of Contents

price of the notes. The market price of the Company's common stock could also be affected by possible sales of its common stock by investors who view the
notes as a more attractive means of equity participation in the Company and by hedging or arbitrage trading activity that the Company expects to develop
involving its common stock. This trading activity could, in turn, affect the trading price of the notes.

The Company may still incur substantially more debt or take other actions which would intensify the risks discussed above.

The  Company  and  its  subsidiaries  may  incur  substantial  additional  debt  in  the  future,  subject  to  the  restrictions  contained  in  its  existing  and  future  debt
agreements, some of which may be secured debt. The Company will not be restricted under the terms of the indenture governing the notes from incurring
additional debt, securing existing or future debt, recapitalizing its debt, repurchasing its stock, pledging its assets, making investments, paying dividends,
guaranteeing debt or taking a number of other actions that are not limited by the terms of the indenture governing the notes that could have the effect of
diminishing the Company's ability to make payments on the notes when due.

The  Company  may  not  have  the  ability  to  raise  the  funds  necessary  to  settle  conversions  of  the  notes  in  cash  or  to  repurchase  the  notes  upon  a
fundamental change, and its future debt may contain limitations on its ability to pay cash upon conversion or repurchase of the notes.

Holders of the notes will have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of their notes upon the occurrence of a fundamental change
before the maturity date at a repurchase price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be repurchased, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if
any. In addition, upon conversion of the notes, unless the Company elects to deliver solely shares of its common stock to settle such conversion (other than
paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share), the Company will be required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation in respect of the
notes being converted in cash. Moreover, the Company will be required to repay the notes in cash at their maturity unless earlier converted, redeemed or
repurchased.  However,  the  Company  may  not  have  enough  available  cash  or  be  able  to  obtain  financing  at  the  time  the  Company  is  required  to  make
repurchases of notes surrendered therefor or pay cash with respect to notes being converted or at their maturity.

In  addition,  the  Company's  ability  to  repurchase  notes  or  to  pay  cash  upon  conversions  of  notes  or  at  their  maturity  may  be  limited  by  law,  regulatory
authority  or  agreements  governing  its  future  indebtedness.  The  Company's  failure  to  repurchase  notes  at  a  time  when  the  repurchase  is  required  by  the
indenture or to pay cash upon conversions of notes or at their maturity as required by the indenture would constitute a default under the indenture. A default
under  the  indenture  or  the  fundamental  change  itself  could  also  lead  to  a  default  under  agreements  governing  the  Company's  existing  and  future
indebtedness. Moreover, the occurrence of a fundamental change under the indenture could constitute an event of default under any such agreement. If the
payment of the related indebtedness were to be accelerated after any applicable notice or grace periods, the Company may not have sufficient funds to repay
the indebtedness.

The conditional conversion features of the notes, if triggered, may adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.

During the second and third quarters of 2021, a conversion feature related to the sale price of the Company’s common stock was triggered. No conversion
requests  were  submitted  by  the  holders  of  the  notes  related  to  these  triggering  events.  In  the  event  the  conditional  conversion  features  of  the  notes  are
triggered, holders of the notes will be entitled to convert their notes at any time during specified periods at their option. If one or more holders elect to
convert  their  notes,  unless  the  Company  elects  to  satisfy  the  Company's  conversion  obligation  by  delivering  solely  shares  of  its  common  stock,  the
Company would be required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation in cash, which could adversely affect the company's liquidity. In addition,
even if holders of notes do not elect to convert their notes, the Company could be required under applicable accounting rules to reclassify all or a portion of
the outstanding principal of the notes as a current rather than long-term liability, which would result in a material reduction of its net working capital.

Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock, but they will be subject to all changes made with respect
to the Company's common stock to the extent the Company satisfies its conversion obligation, in whole or in part, with shares of its common stock.

Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock (including, without limitation, voting rights and rights to
receive any dividends or other distributions on its common stock) prior to the conversion date relating to such notes (if the Company has elected to settle the
conversion by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share)) or the last trading day of the
observation period (if the Company elects to pay and deliver, as the case may be, a combination of cash and shares of its common stock in respect of the
relevant conversion), but holders of notes will be subject to all changes affecting the Company's common stock. For example, if an amendment is

49

Table of Contents

proposed to the Company's certificate of incorporation or bylaws requiring stockholder approval and the record date for determining the stockholders of
record entitled to vote on the amendment occurs prior to the conversion date related to a holder’s conversion of its notes (if the Company has elected to
settle the relevant conversion by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share)) or the last
trading day of the observation period (if the Company elects to pay and deliver, as the case may be, a combination of cash and shares of its common stock in
respect of the relevant conversion), such holder will not be entitled to vote on the amendment, although such holder will nevertheless be subject to any
changes affecting its common stock.

The conditional conversion feature of the notes could result in holders receiving less than the value of the Company's common stock into which the
notes would otherwise be convertible.

Prior to the close of business on the business day immediately preceding December 15, 2025, holders may convert their notes only if specified conditions
are met. If the specific conditions for conversion are not met, holders will not be able to convert their notes, and holders may be unable to receive the value
of the cash, common stock or a combination of cash and common stock, as applicable, into which their notes would otherwise be convertible.

Upon conversion of the notes, holders may receive less valuable consideration than expected because the value of the Company's common stock may
decline after holders exercise their conversion right but before the Company satisfies it conversion obligation.

Under the notes, a converting holder will be exposed to fluctuations in the value of the Company's common stock during the period from the date such
holder surrenders notes for conversion until the date the Company satisfies its conversion obligation.

Upon conversion of the notes, the Company will satisfy its conversion obligation by paying or delivering, as the case may be, cash, shares of its common
stock, or a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, at the Company's option. If the Company satisfies its conversion obligation solely in cash or
through payment and delivery, as the case may be, of a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, the amount of cash and shares of common
stock, if any, due upon conversion will be based on a daily conversion value calculated on a proportionate basis for each trading day in a 40 trading day
observation period. This period would be: (i) subject to clause (ii), if the relevant conversion date occurs prior to December 15, 2025, the 40 consecutive
trading day period beginning on and including, the second trading day immediately succeeding such conversion date; (ii) if the relevant conversion date
occurs during a redemption period, the 40 consecutive trading days beginning on and including, the 41st scheduled trading day immediately preceding the
date that is specified as the redemption date in the related notice of redemption; and (iii) subject to clause (ii), if the relevant conversion date occurs on or
after December 15, 2025, the 40 consecutive trading days beginning on and including, the 41st scheduled trading day immediately preceding the maturity
date. Accordingly, if the price of the Company's common stock decreases during this period, the value of consideration holders receive will be adversely
affected. In addition, if the market price of the Company's common stock at the end of such period is below the average of the daily volume weighted-
average prices of the Company's common stock during such period, the value of any shares of the Company's common stock that holders will receive in
satisfaction of its conversion obligation will be less than the value used to determine the number of shares that holders will receive.

If the Company elects to satisfy its conversion obligation solely in shares of the Company's common stock upon conversion of the notes, the Company will
be  required  to  deliver  the  shares  of  its  common  stock,  together  with  cash  for  any  fractional  share,  on  the  second  business  day  following  the  relevant
conversion date. Accordingly, if the price of the Company's common stock decreases during this period, the value of the shares that holders receive will be
adversely affected and would be less than the conversion value of the notes on the conversion date.

The notes are not protected by restrictive covenants.

The  indenture  governing  the  notes  will  not  contain  any  financial  or  operating  covenants  or  restrictions  on  the  payments  of  dividends,  the  incurrence  of
indebtedness or the issuance or repurchase of securities by the Company or any of its subsidiaries. The indenture will not contain any covenants or other
provisions to afford protection to holders of the notes in the event of a fundamental change or other corporate transaction involving the Company subject to
certain exceptions.

The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period may not
adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption.

If  a  make-whole  fundamental  change  occurs  prior  to  the  maturity  date  or  upon  its  issuance  of  a  notice  of  redemption  the  Company  will,  under  certain
circumstances, increase the conversion rate by a number of additional shares of its common stock for notes converted in connection with such make-whole
fundamental change or during the related redemption period. The increase in

50

Table of Contents

the conversion rate will be determined based on the date on which the specified corporate transaction becomes effective or the redemption notice date, as
applicable, and the price paid (or deemed to be paid) per share of the Company's common stock in such transaction or on such redemption notice date. The
increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period may not adequately
compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption. Furthermore, if the Company calls only a portion of the
outstanding notes for redemption, only those notes called (or deemed called) for redemption will become convertible as a result of such call for redemption
and  only  the  conversion  rate  of  notes  converted  in  connection  with  such  notice  of  redemption  will  be  increased.  Accordingly,  notes  not  called  for
redemption  will  not  become  convertible  if  not  otherwise  convertible  at  such  time  and  will  remain  outstanding,  and  may  have  reduced  liquidity  and  a
resulting reduced trading price. 

Our  obligation  to  increase  the  conversion  rate  for  notes  converted  in  connection  with  a  make-whole  fundamental  change  or  during  a  redemption  period
could be considered a penalty, in which case the enforceability thereof would be subject to general principles of reasonableness and equitable remedies.

The conversion rate of the notes may not be adjusted for all dilutive events.

The  conversion  rate  of  the  notes  is  subject  to  adjustment  for  certain  events,  including,  but  not  limited  to,  the  issuance  of  certain  stock  dividends  on  the
Company's common stock, the issuance of certain rights or warrants, subdivisions, combinations, distributions of capital stock, indebtedness, or assets, cash
dividends and certain issuer tender or exchange offers. However, the conversion rate will not be adjusted for other events, such as a third-party tender or
exchange offer or an issuance of the Company's common stock for cash, that may adversely affect the trading price of the notes or its common stock. An
event that adversely affects the value of the notes may occur, and that event may not result in an adjustment to the conversion rate.

Provisions in the indenture governing the notes may deter or prevent a business combination that may be favorable to holders.

If a fundamental change occurs prior to the maturity date, holders of the notes will have the right, at their option, to require the Company to repurchase all
or a portion of their notes. In addition, if a make-whole fundamental change occurs prior the maturity date, the Company will in some cases be required to
increase the conversion rate for a holder that elects to convert its notes in connection with such make-whole fundamental change. Furthermore, the indenture
governing the notes will prohibit the Company from engaging in certain mergers or acquisitions unless, among other things, the surviving entity assumes the
Company's obligations under the notes. These and other provisions in the indenture could deter or prevent a third party from acquiring the Company even
when the acquisition may be favorable to holders.

The capped call transactions may affect the value of the notes and the Company's common stock.

In connection with the pricing of the notes, the Company entered into capped call transactions with the counterparties. The capped call transactions cover,
subject  to  customary  adjustments,  the  number  of  shares  of  the  Company's  common  stock  initially  underlying  the  notes.  The  capped  call  transactions
generally reduce the potential dilution to the Company's common stock upon any conversion of the notes. If the initial purchasers exercise their option to
purchase additional notes, the Company expects to enter into additional capped call transactions with the counterparties.

The Company believes that, in connection with establishing their initial hedge of the capped call transactions, the counterparties or their respective affiliates
may  have  entered  into  various  derivative  transactions  with  respect  to  the  Company's  common  stock  and/or  purchase  shares  of  its  common  stock
concurrently with or shortly after the pricing of the notes, including with certain investors in the notes.

The  Company  expects  that  the  counterparties  or  their  respective  affiliates  may  modify  their  hedge  positions  by  entering  into  or  unwinding  various
derivatives with respect to its common stock and/or purchasing or selling the Company's common stock or other securities in secondary market transactions
following the pricing of the notes and prior to the maturity of the notes and are likely to do so on each exercise date of the capped call transactions. This
activity could also cause or prevent an increase or a decrease in the market price of the Company's common stock or the notes, which could affect their
ability to convert the notes and, to the extent the activity occurs during any observation period related to a conversion of notes, it could affect the amount
and value of the consideration that holders will receive upon conversion of the notes.

In  addition,  if  any  such  capped  call  transactions  fail  to  become  effective,  whether  or  not  this  offering  of  notes  is  completed,  the  counterparties  (or  their
respective  affiliates)  may  unwind  their  hedge  positions  with  respect  to  the  Company's  common  stock,  which  could  adversely  affect  the  price  of  the
Company's common stock and the value of the notes.

The Company does not make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any potential effect that the transactions described above
may have on the price of the notes or the shares of the Company's common stock. In addition, the

51

Table of Contents

Company does not make any representation that the counterparties will engage in these transactions or that these transactions, once commenced, will not be
discontinued without notice.

The Company is subject to counterparty risk with respect to the capped call transactions.

The counterparties to the capped call transactions that the Company enter into are financial institutions, and the Company will be subject to the risk that one
or more of the counterparties may default or otherwise fail to perform, or may exercise certain rights to terminate, their obligations under the capped call
transactions. The Company's exposure to the credit risk of the counterparties will not be secured by any collateral.

Global  economic  conditions  have  in  the  past  resulted  in  the  actual  or  perceived  failure  or  financial  difficulties  of  many  financial  institutions.  If  a
counterparty to one or more capped call transactions becomes subject to insolvency proceedings, the Company will become an unsecured creditor in those
proceedings  with  a  claim  equal  to  its  exposure  at  the  time  under  such  transaction.  the  Company's  exposure  will  depend  on  many  factors  but,  generally,
its  exposure  will  increase  if  the  market  price  or  the  volatility  of  the  Company's  common  stock  increases.  In  addition,  upon  a  default  or  other  failure  to
perform,  or  a  termination  of  obligations,  by  a  counterparty,  the  counterparty  may  fail  to  deliver  the  consideration  required  to  be  delivered  to  the
Company under the capped call transactions and it may experience more dilution than the Company currently anticipates with respect to its common stock.
The Company can provide no assurances as to the financial stability or viability of the counterparties.

Some significant restructuring transactions may not constitute a fundamental change, in which case the Company would not be obligated to offer to
repurchase the notes.

Upon the occurrence of a fundamental change, holders have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of their notes. However, the
fundamental  change  provisions  will  not  afford  protection  to  holders  of  notes  in  the  event  of  other  transactions  that  could  adversely  affect  the  notes.  For
example,  transactions  such  as  leveraged  recapitalizations,  refinancings,  restructurings  or  acquisitions  initiated  by  the  Company  may  not  constitute  a
fundamental change requiring the Company to offer to repurchase the notes. In the event of any such transaction the holders would not have the right to
require the Company to repurchase the notes, even though each of these transactions could increase the amount of its indebtedness, or otherwise adversely
affect its capital structure or any credit ratings, thereby adversely affecting the holders of notes.

The Company has not registered the notes or the common stock issuable upon conversion, if any, which will limit their ability to resell them.

The  notes  and  the  shares  of  common  stock  issuable  upon  conversion  of  the  notes,  if  any,  have  not  been  registered  under  the  Securities  Act  or  any  state
securities  laws.  Unless  the  notes  and  any  shares  of  common  stock  issuable  upon  conversion  of  the  notes,  if  any,  have  been  registered,  they  may  not  be
transferred or resold except in a transaction exempt from or not subject to the registration requirements of the Securities Act and applicable state securities
laws.  The  Company  does  not  intend  to  file  a  registration  statement  for  the  resale  of  the  notes  and  the  common  stock,  if  any,  into  which  the  notes  are
convertible. 

The Company cannot assure holders that an active trading market will develop for the notes.

Prior to this offering, there has been no trading market for the notes, and the Company does not intend to apply to list the notes on any securities exchange
or to arrange for quotation on any automated dealer quotation system. The Company has been informed by the initial purchasers that they intend to make a
market in the notes after the offering is completed. However, the initial purchasers may cease their market-making at any time without notice. In addition,
the liquidity of the trading market in the notes, and the market price quoted for the notes, may be adversely affected by changes in the overall market for this
type of security and by changes in the Company's financial performance or prospects or in the prospects for companies in its industry generally. As a result,
the  Company  cannot  assure  holders  that  an  active  trading  market  will  develop  for  the  notes.  If  an  active  trading  market  does  not  develop  or  is  not
maintained, the market price and liquidity of the notes may be adversely affected. In that case holders may not be able to sell their notes at a particular time
or holders may not be able to sell their notes at a favorable price.

Any adverse rating of the notes may cause their trading price to fall.

The Company does not intend to seek a rating on the notes. However, if a rating service were to rate the notes and if such rating service were to lower its
rating on the notes below the rating initially assigned to the notes or otherwise announces its intention to put the notes on credit watch, the trading price of
the notes could decline.

Holders may be subject to tax if the Company makes or fails to make certain adjustments to the conversion rate of the notes even though holders do not
receive a corresponding cash distribution.

52

Table of Contents

The conversion rate of the notes is subject to adjustment in certain circumstances, including the payment of cash dividends. If the conversion rate is adjusted
as  a  result  of  a  distribution  that  is  taxable  to  the  Company's  common  stockholders,  such  as  a  cash  dividend,  holders  may  be  deemed  to  have  received  a
dividend subject to U.S. federal income tax without the receipt of any cash. In addition, a failure to adjust (or to adjust adequately) the conversion rate after
an event that increases their proportionate interest in the Company could be treated as a deemed taxable dividend to holders if the failure to adjust (or to
adjust adequately) is made in connection with a distribution of cash or other property to the Company's common stockholders. If a make-whole fundamental
change occurs prior to the maturity date or the Company issues a notice of redemption under some circumstances, the Company will increase the conversion
rate for notes converted in connection with the make-whole fundamental change or during the related redemption period. Such increase may also be treated
as a distribution subject to U.S. federal income tax as a dividend. It is unclear whether any such deemed dividend would be eligible for the preferential tax
treatment  generally  available  for  dividends  paid  by  U.S.  corporations  to  certain  U.S.  holders.  If  holders  are  a  non-U.S.  holders,  any  deemed  dividend
generally would be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a 30% rate, or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable treaty, which may be set
off against subsequent payments with respect to the notes (or common stock into which the notes convert). The Company do not currently expect to make
distributions on its common stock, although no assurance can be given in this regard.

The Company may redeem the notes at its option, which may adversely affect their return.

The Company may not redeem the notes prior to March 20, 2024. On or after March 20, 2024 it may redeem for cash all or any portion of the notes, at
its  option  if  the  last  reported  sale  price  of  its  common  stock  has  been  at  least  130%  of  the  conversion  price  then  in  effect  for  at  least  20  trading  days
(whether  or  not  consecutive)  during  any  30  consecutive  trading  day  period  (including  the  last  trading  day  of  such  period)  ending  on  and  including,  the
trading  day  immediately  preceding  the  date  on  which  the  Company  provides  notice  of  redemption  at  a  redemption  price  equal  to  100%  of  the  principal
amount of the notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. If the Company calls any note for redemption,
holders may convert their note called for redemption (or any portion thereof) at any time prior to the close of business on the second scheduled trading day
immediately preceding the applicable redemption date. Prevailing interest rates at the time the Company redeem the notes may be lower than the interest
rate on the notes. Upon such redemption or conversion, the cash comprising the redemption price, in the case of a redemption, or the applicable conversion
consideration, in the case of a conversion in connection with a redemption notice, in either case, may not fully compensate holders for any future interest
payments that holders would have otherwise received or for any other lost time value of their notes. 

The notes will initially be held in book-entry form and, therefore, holders must rely on the procedures and the relevant clearing systems to exercise their
rights and remedies.

Unless and until certificated notes are issued in exchange for book-entry interests in the notes, owners of the book-entry interests will not be considered
owners  or  holders  of  notes.  Instead,  DTC,  or  its  nominee,  will  be  the  sole  holder  of  the  notes.  Payments  of  principal,  interest  (including  any  additional
interest), cash amounts due upon conversion and other amounts owing on or in respect of the notes in global form will be made to the paying agent, which
will make the payments to DTC. Thereafter, such payments will be credited to DTC participants’ accounts that hold book-entry interests in the notes in
global form and credited by such participants to indirect participants. Unlike holders of the notes themselves, owners of book-entry interests will not have
the direct right to act upon the Company's solicitations for consents or requests for waivers or other actions from holders of the notes. Instead, if a holder
owns a book-entry interest, such holder will be permitted to act only to the extent such holder has received appropriate proxies to do so from DTC or, if
applicable, a participant. The Company cannot assure holders that the procedures implemented for the granting of such proxies will be sufficient to enable
holders to vote on any requested actions on a timely basis.

Risks Related to Ownership of the Company's Common Stock

Anti-takeover provisions contained in the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, as well as
provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.

The Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and Delaware law contain provisions which could have the
effect of rendering more difficult, delaying or preventing an acquisition deemed undesirable by the Company's board of directors. Among other things, the
Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws include provisions:

• authorizing a classified board of directors whose members serve staggered three-year terms;
• authorizing “blank check” preferred stock, which could be issued by the Company's board of directors without stockholder approval and may contain

voting, liquidation, dividend and other rights superior to its common stock;

• limiting the liability of, and providing indemnification to, its directors and officers;
• limiting the ability of its stockholders to call and bring business before special meetings;

53

Table of Contents

• requiring advance notice of stockholder proposals for business to be conducted at meetings of the Company's stockholders and for nominations of

candidates for election to its board of directors; and

• controlling the procedures for the conduct and scheduling of board of directors and stockholder meetings.

These provisions, alone or together, could delay or prevent hostile takeovers and changes in control or changes in the Company's management.

As a Delaware corporation, the Company is also subject to provisions of Delaware law, including Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law
(the “DGCL”), which prevents certain stockholders holding more than 15% of its outstanding capital stock from engaging in certain business combinations
without approval of the holders of at least two-thirds of the Company's outstanding common stock not held by such stockholder.

Any  provision  of  the  Company's  amended  and  restated  certificate  of  incorporation,  amended  and  restated  bylaws  or  Delaware  law  that  has  the  effect  of
delaying,  preventing  or  deterring  a  change  in  control  could  limit  the  opportunity  for  its  stockholders  to  receive  a  premium  for  their  shares  of  the
Company's capital stock, and could also affect the price that some investors are willing to pay for its common stock.

The Company's business could be negatively affected by activist shareholders.

Responding  to  actions  by  activist  shareholders  could  be  costly  and  time-consuming,  disrupt  the  Company's  operations  and  divert  the  attention  of
management and its employees. Additionally, perceived uncertainties as to the Company's future direction as a result of shareholder activism or changes to
the composition of its board of directors may lead to the perception of a change in the direction of its business or other instability, which may be exploited
by its competitors, cause concern to the Company's current or potential customers, and make it more difficult to attract and retain qualified personnel. If
customers  choose  to  delay,  defer  or  reduce  transactions  with  the  Company  or  do  business  with  its  competitors  instead  of  the  Company,  then  the
Company's business, financial condition and operating results would be adversely affected. In addition, the share price of its common stock and the trading
price of the notes could experience periods of increased volatility as a result of shareholder activism.

If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research or reports about the Company, its business, its market or its competitors, or
if they adversely change their recommendations regarding the Company's common stock, the market price and trading volume of its notes and common
stock could decline.

The trading market for the Company's notes and common stock will be influenced, to some extent, by the research and reports that securities or industry
analysts  publish  about  the  Company,  its  business,  its  market  or  its  competitors.  If  any  of  the  analysts  who  cover  the  Company  adversely  change  their
recommendations regarding its common stock or provide more favorable recommendations about its competitors, the market price of the Company's notes
and common stock would likely decline. If any of the analysts who cover the Company cease coverage of the company or fail to regularly publish reports on
it, the Company could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause the market price and trading volume of its notes and common stock
to decline.

The Company does not expect to declare any dividends on its common stock in the foreseeable future.

The Company does not anticipate declaring any cash dividends to holders of its common stock in the foreseeable future. Consequently, investors may need
to  rely  on  sales  of  its  common  stock  after  price  appreciation,  which  may  never  occur,  as  the  only  way  to  realize  any  future  gains  on  their  investment.
Investors seeking cash dividends should not purchase shares of its common stock.

If the Company raises additional capital through the sale of shares of the Company’s common stock, convertible securities or debt in the future, its
stockholders’ ownership in the Company could be diluted and restrictions could be imposed on the Company’s business.

The Company may issue shares of its common stock or securities convertible into its common stock to raise additional capital in the future. To the extent the
Company issues such securities, its stockholders may experience substantial dilution and the trading price of the Company’s common stock could decline. If
the  Company  obtains  funds  through  a  credit  facility  or  through  the  issuance  of  debt  or  preferred  securities,  such  debt  or  preferred  securities  could  have
rights senior to the existing stockholders’ rights as a common shareholder, which could impair the value of the Company’s common stock.

54

Table of Contents

ITEM 1B.    UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

Not applicable.

55

Table of Contents

ITEM 2.    PROPERTIES

The Company occupies 66,000 square feet for its U.S. corporate office in Brisbane, California, under a lease which extends through January 31, 2028. The
original lease expired on December 31, 2017, and the Company entered into a Second Amendment on July 6, 2017 that extended the term of the lease to
January  31,  2023  and  a  Third  Amendment  on  July  9,  2020  that  extended  the  term  of  the  lease  to  January  31,  2028.  The  amendment  provides  for  the
following: a) the extension of the lease term, with the extended term to begin on February 1, 2023 and continue until January 31, 2028; b) the abatement of
the  monthly  base  rent  for  the  four  month  period  beginning  September  1,  2020  and  ending  December  31,  2020;  c)  the  amendment  of  monthly  base  rent
during the extension term to approximately $0.2 million for January 2021 with annual increases of 3.5% thereafter; and d) the waiver by the Company of its
early termination right in the lease. Pursuant to the terms of the Third Amendment to the Lease Agreement, the Company has the option to extend the term
of the lease by an additional 60 months.

In addition, the Company has leased office facilities in certain countries as follows:

Country

Japan

France

Spain

Belgium

Square Footage

Lease termination or Expiration

Approximately 5,896

Approximately 2,239

Approximately 3,584

Approximately 151

Two  leases:  The  first  lease  expires  in  March  2024  and  the  second  lease  expires  in
December 2023.

One lease, which expires in June 2024.

One lease, which expires in January 2023.

One lease, which expires in November 2023.

ITEM 3.    LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

From time to time, the Company may be involved in legal and administrative proceedings and claims of various types. For a description of material pending
legal and regulatory proceedings and settlements as of December 31, 2021, please see Note 11 to the Company’s consolidated financial statements entitled
“Commitments and Contingencies,” Part II Item 8, included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

ITEM 4.    MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not applicable.

56

Table of Contents

ITEM 5.    MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES

PART II

OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Stock Exchange Listing

The Company’s common stock trades on The NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “CUTR.” As of February 22, 2022, the closing sale price of
its common stock was $33.45 per share.

Common Stockholders

The Company had five stockholders of record as of February 22, 2022. The Company believes the actual number of stockholders is greater than this number
of record holders and includes stockholders who are beneficial owners, but whose shares are held in “street” name by brokers and other nominees. This
number of holders of record also does not include stockholders whose shares may be held in trust by other entities.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

There were no repurchases of the Company’s common stock in 2021 under the Company’s Stock Repurchase Program.

Sales of Unregistered Securities

The  Company  issued  $138.3  million  aggregate  principal  amount  of  convertible  notes  in  a  private  placement  offering  on  March  5,  2021.  The  notes  bear
interest  at  a  rate  of  2.25%  per  year.  In  connection  with  issuance  of  the  notes,  the  Company  entered  into  capped  call  transactions  with  certain  option
counterparties. The capped call transactions are generally expected to reduce the potential dilution of the Company's common stock upon any conversion of
the notes. The capped calls were purchased for $16.1 million.

Dividends

For a discussion regarding the Company’s intentions with respect to dividends, see the section titled “Stock-based Compensation Expense” set forth in Part
II Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans

The information required by this Item regarding equity compensation plans is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in Part III Item 12 of
this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

57

Table of Contents

Performance Graph

The graph below compares Cutera, Inc.'s cumulative 5-Year total shareholder return on common stock with the cumulative total returns of the NASDAQ
Composite index and the NASDAQ Health Care index. The graph tracks the performance of a $100 investment in the Company’s common stock and in
each index (with the reinvestment of all dividends) from December 31, 2016 to December 31, 2021.

*$100 invested on December 31, 2016 in stock or index, including reinvestment of dividends.

In accordance with SEC rules, the information contained under “Performance Graph” shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material,” or to be “filed” with
the SEC or subject to the SEC’s Regulation 14A or 14C, other than as provided under Item 201(e) of Regulation S-K, or to the liabilities of Section 18 of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, except to the extent that the Company specifically request that the information be treated as soliciting
material or specifically incorporate it by reference into a document filed under the Securities Act, or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

58

Table of Contents

ITEM 6. [Reserved]

59

Table of Contents

ITEM 7.    MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The  following  discussion  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  the  Company’s  audited  financial  statements  and  notes  thereto  for  the  fiscal  year  ended
December 31, 2021. This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including the following sections, contains forward-looking statements within the  meaning  of  the
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Throughout this Report, and particularly in this Item 7, the forward-looking statements are based upon the
Company’s current expectations, estimates and projections and that reflect the Company’s beliefs and assumptions based upon information available to the
Company  at  the  date  of  this  Report.  In  some  cases,  you  can  identify  these  statements  by  words  such  as  “may,”  “might,”  “could,”  “will,”  “should,”
“expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “likely,” “believes,” “estimates,” “intends,” “forecasts,” “foresees,” “predicts,” “potential” or “continue,” and other
similar terms. These forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and are subject to risks, uncertainties, and assumptions that are
difficult to predict. The Company’s actual results, performance or achievements could differ  materially  from  those  expressed  or  implied  by  the  forward-
looking statements. The forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, statements relating to the Company’s future financial performance, the
ability to grow the Company’s business, increase the Company’s revenue, manage expenses, generate additional cash, achieve and  maintain  profitability,
develop  and  commercialize  existing  and  new  products  and  applications,  improve  the  performance  of  the  Company’s  worldwide  sales  and  distribution
network, and to the outlook regarding long term prospects. The Company cautions you not to place undue  reliance  on  these  forward-looking  statements,
which reflect management’s analysis only as of the date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The Company undertakes no obligation to update forward-
looking statements to reflect events or circumstances occurring after the date of this Form 10-K.

Some of the important factors that could cause the Company’s results to differ materially from those in the Company’s forward-looking statements, and a
discussion of other risks and uncertainties, are discussed in Item 1A—Risk Factors. The Company encourages you to read that section carefully as well as
other risks detailed from time to time in the Company’s filings with the SEC.

Introduction

The Management’s Discussion and Analysis (“MD&A”) is organized as follows:

• Executive Summary. This section provides a general description and history of the Company’s business, a brief discussion of the Company’s product lines

and the opportunities, trends, challenges and risks the Company focuses on in the operation of the Company’s business.

• Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates. This section describes the key accounting policies that are affected by critical accounting estimates.
• Recent Accounting Guidance. This section describes the issuance and effect of new accounting pronouncements that are or may be applicable to us.
• Results of Operations. This section provides the Company’s analysis and outlook for the significant line items on the Company’s Consolidated Statements

of Operations.

• Liquidity and Capital Resources. This section provides an analysis of the Company’s liquidity and cash flows, as well as a discussion of the Company’s

commitments that existed as of December 31, 2021.

We have omitted discussion of 2019 results where it would be redundant to the discussion previously included in Management's Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2020, which has been filed with the SEC.

Executive Summary

Company Description

The  Company  is  a  leading  medical  device  company  specializing  in  the  research,  development,  manufacture,  marketing  and  servicing  of  light  and  other
energy-based aesthetics systems for practitioners worldwide. In addition to internal development of products, the Company distributes third party sourced
products  under  the  Company’s  own  brand  names.  The  Company  offers  easy-to-use  products  which  enable  practitioners  to  perform  safe  and  effective
aesthetic  procedures,  including  treatment  for  body  contouring,  skin  resurfacing  and  revitalization,  tattoo  removal,  removal  of  benign  pigmented  lesions,
vascular conditions, hair removal, and toenail fungus. The Company’s platforms are designed to be easily upgraded to add additional applications and hand
pieces, which provide flexibility for the Company’s customers as they expand their practices. In addition to systems and upgrade revenue, the Company
generates revenue from the sale of post warranty service contracts, providing services for products that are out of warranty, hand piece refills and other per
procedure related revenue on select systems and distribution of third-party manufactured skincare products.

60

Table of Contents

The  Company’s  ongoing  research  and  development  activities  primarily  focus  on  developing  new  products,  as  well  as  improving  and  enhancing  the
Company’s portfolio of existing products. The Company also explores ways to expand the Company’s product offerings through alternative arrangements
with other companies, such as distribution arrangements. The Company introduced Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization,
in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019 truSculpt flex in June 2019, Secret PRO in July 2020 and
excel V+III during the fourth quarter of 2020. In 2021, the Company introduced truSculpt flex+, a treatment mode that decreased the treatment time from
approximately 45 minutes to 15 minutes.

The Company’s corporate headquarters and U.S. operations are located in Brisbane, California, where the Company conducts manufacturing, warehousing,
research and development, regulatory, sales and marketing, service, and administrative activities. The Company markets sells and services the Company’s
products  through  direct  sales  and  service  employees  in  North  America  (including  Canada),  Australia,  Austria,  Belgium,  France,  Germany,  Hong  Kong,
Japan,  the  Netherlands,  Spain,  Switzerland  and  the  United  Kingdom.  Sales  and  Services  outside  of  these  direct  markets  are  made  through  a  worldwide
distributor network in over 42 countries.

Products and Services

The Company derives revenue from the sale of products and services. Product revenue includes revenue from the sale of systems, hand pieces and upgrade
of  systems  (collectively  “Systems”  revenue),  replacement  hand  pieces,  truSculpt  iD  cycle  refills,  and  truSculpt  flex  cycle  refills,  as  well  as  single  use
disposable  tips  applicable  to  Secret RF  (“Consumables”  revenue),  the  sale  of  third  party  manufactured  skincare  products  (“Skincare”  revenue);  and  the
leasing of equipment through a membership program. A system consists of a console that incorporates a universal graphic user interface, a laser and (or) an
energy-based module, control system software and high voltage electronics, as well as one or more hand pieces. However, depending on the application, the
laser or other energy-based module is sometimes contained in the hand piece such as with the Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional applications instead of
within the console.

The  Company  offers  customers  the  ability  to  select  the  system  that  best  fits  their  practice  at  the  time  of  purchase  and  then  to  cost-effectively  add
applications to their system as their practice grows. This provides customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems whenever they choose and provides the
Company with a source of additional Systems revenue. The Company’s primary system platforms include excel, enlighten, Secret RF, truSculpt and xeo.

Skincare revenue relates to the distribution of ZO’s skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and
sold  to  medical  offices  and  licensed  physicians.  The  Company  acts  as  the  principal  in  this  arrangement,  as  the  Company  determines  the  price  to  charge
customers for the skincare products and controls the products before they are transferred to the customer.

Service includes prepaid service contracts, and labor, time and material on out-of-warranty products.

Significant Business Trends

The Company believes that the ability to grow revenue will be primarily impacted by the following:

• continuing to expand the Company’s product offerings, both through internal development and sourcing from other vendors;
• ongoing investment in the Company’s global sales and marketing infrastructure;
• use of clinical results to support new aesthetic products and applications;
• enhanced luminary development and reference selling efforts (to develop a location where Company’s products can be displayed and used to assist in

selling efforts);

• customer demand for the Company’s products;
• consumer demand for the application of the Company’s products;
• marketing to physicians in the core dermatology and plastic surgeon specialties, as well as outside those specialties; and
• generating recurring revenue from the Company’s growing installed base of customers through the sale of system upgrades, services, hand piece refills,

truSculpt cycles, skincare products and replacement tips for Secret RF products.

For a detailed discussion of the significant business trends impacting the Company’s business, please see the section titled “Results of Operations” below.

Critical accounting policies, significant judgments and use of estimates

The  preparation  of  the  Company’s  audited  consolidated  financial  statements  and  related  notes  requires  the  Company  to  make  judgments,  estimates  and
assumptions  that  affect  the  reported  amounts  of  assets,  liabilities,  revenues  and  expenses,  and  related  disclosure  of  contingent  assets  and  liabilities.  The
Company  has  based  its  estimates  on  historical  experience  and  on  various  other  assumptions  that  the  Company  believes  to  be  reasonable  under  the
circumstances. The Company periodically reviews its

61

Table of Contents

estimates and makes adjustments when facts and circumstances dictate. To the extent that there are material differences between these estimates and actual
results, its financial condition or results of operations will be affected.

An  accounting  policy  is  considered  to  be  critical  if  it  requires  an  accounting  estimate  to  be  made  based  on  assumptions  about  matters  that  are  highly
uncertain at the time the estimate is made, and if different estimates that reasonably could have been used, or changes in the accounting estimates that are
reasonably  likely  to  occur  periodically,  could  materially  impact  the  consolidated  financial  statements.  The  Company  believes  that  its  critical  accounting
policies  reflect  the  more  significant  estimates  and  assumptions  used  in  the  preparation  of  its  audited  consolidated  financial  statements.  The  critical
accounting  policies,  judgments  and  estimates  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  the  Company’s  audited  consolidated  financial  statements  and  the  notes
thereto and other disclosures included in this report.

For an analysis of the Company’s Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates please refer to Note 1 “Summary of significant accounting policies” to the
Company’s audited consolidated financial statements included in Part II, Item 8 of this report.

The Company believes the following critical accounting policies, estimates and assumptions may have a material impact on reported financial condition and
operating performance and may involve significant levels of judgment to account for highly uncertain matters or are susceptible to significant change:

Revenue Recognition

See "Part II, Item 8. Revenue Recognition, Note 1" to the consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2021, included in this Annual
Report  on  Form  10-K  for  additional  information  about  the  Company’s  revenue  recognition  policy,  significant  judgement  and  criteria  for  recognizing
revenue.

The Company enters into contracts with multiple performance obligations where customers purchase a combination of systems and services. Determining
whether  systems  and  services  are  considered  distinct  performance  obligations  that  should  be  accounted  for  separately  requires  judgment.  The  Company
determines  the  transaction  price  for  a  contract  based  on  the  consideration  it  expects  to  receive  in  exchange  for  the  transferred  goods  or  services.  To  the
extent the transaction price includes variable consideration, such as expected price adjustments for returns, the Company applies judgment when estimating
variable consideration and when estimating the extent to which the transaction price is subject to the constraint on variable consideration. The Company
evaluates constraints based on its historical and projected experience with similar customer contracts.

The Company allocates revenue to each performance obligation in proportion to the relative standalone selling prices (“SSP”) and recognizes revenue when
control of the related goods or services is transferred for each performance obligation.

The Company utilizes the observable standalone selling price when available, which represents the price charged for the performance obligation when sold
separately. When standalone selling prices for systems or services are not directly observable, the Company determines the standalone selling prices using
relevant information available and applies suitable estimation methods including, but not limited to, the cost plus a margin approach.

The  Company  determines  the  SSP  for  systems  based  on  directly  observable  sales  in  similar  circumstances  to  similar  customers.  The  SSPs  for  extended
service contracts are based on observable prices when sold on a standalone basis.

Incremental costs of obtaining a contract, including sales commissions, are allocated to the distinct goods and services to which they relate based on the
relative  stand-alone  selling  prices.  Incremental  costs  related  to  obligations  delivered  at  inception  are  recognized  at  contract  inception.  Those  related  to
obligations delivered over time are capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the expected period of benefit if the Company expects to recover
those costs. The Company uses the portfolio method to recognize the amortization expense related to these capitalized costs related to initial contracts and
such  expense  is  recognized  over  a  period  associated  with  the  revenue  of  the  related  portfolio,  which  is  generally  two  to  three  years  for  the  Company’s
product and service arrangements.

Leases

Lessee

The Company is a party to certain operating and finance leases for vehicles, office space and storages. The Company’s material operating leases consist of
office space, as well as storage facilities. The Company’s leases generally have remaining terms of one to ten years, some of which include options to renew
the leases for up to five years.

62

Table of Contents

The Company determines if a contract contains a lease at inception. Right of use assets and lease liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement date.
Operating  lease  liabilities  represent  the  present  value  of  lease  payments  not  yet  paid.  Operating  lease  right  of  use  assets  represent  the  right  to  use  an
underlying asset and are based upon the operating lease liabilities adjusted for prepayments or accrued lease payments, initial direct costs, lease incentives,
and impairment of operating lease assets. To determine the present value of lease payments not yet paid, the Company estimates the incremental secured
borrowing  rates  corresponding  to  the  maturities  of  the  leases.  The  Company  bases  the  rate  estimates  on  prevailing  financial  market  conditions,  credit
analysis and management judgment.

The Company recognizes expense for operating leases on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Additionally, tenant incentives used to fund leasehold
improvements are recognized when earned and reduce the Company’s right-of-use asset related to the lease. These are amortized through the right-of-use
asset as reductions of expense over the lease term.

Valuation of Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value, cost being determined on a standard cost basis which approximates actual cost on a first-
in, first-out basis. Net realizable value is the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of the Company’s business, less reasonably predictable costs of
completion, disposal, and transportation. Standard costs are monitored and updated quarterly or as necessary, to reflect changes in raw material costs, labor
to manufacture the product and overhead rates.

The cost basis of the Company’s inventory is reduced for any products that are considered excess or obsolete based upon assumptions about future demand
and market conditions. The Company provides for excess and obsolete inventories when conditions indicate that the inventory cost is not recoverable due to
physical  deterioration,  forecast  usage,  obsolescence,  reductions  in  estimated  future  demand  and  reductions  in  selling  prices.  Inventory  provisions  are
measured as the difference between the cost of inventory and net realizable value to establish a lower cost basis for the inventories. The Company balances
the need to maintain strategic inventory levels with the risk of obsolescence due to changing technology, timing of new product introductions and customer
demand levels. 

The Company includes demonstration units within inventories. Demonstration units are carried at cost and amortized over an estimated economic life of two
years.  Amortization  expense  related  to  demonstration  units  is  recorded  in  Products  cost  of  revenue  or  in  the  respective  operating  expense  line  based  on
which function and purpose for which the demonstration units are being used. Proceeds from the sale of demonstration units are recorded as revenue and all
costs incurred to refurbish the systems prior to sale are charged to cost of revenue.

See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

Income Taxes

The provision for income taxes is determined using the asset and liability approach of accounting for income taxes. Under this approach, deferred taxes
represent the estimated future tax effects of temporary differences between book and tax treatment of assets and liabilities and carryforwards to the extent
they are realizable.

The Company is subject to taxes on earnings in both the U.S. and various foreign jurisdictions. On a quarterly basis, the Company assesses the realizability
of  its  deferred  tax  assets.  For  those  jurisdictions  where  tax  carryforwards  are  likely  to  expire  unused  or  the  projected  operating  results  indicate  that
realization is not more likely than not, a valuation allowance is recorded to offset the deferred tax asset within that jurisdiction. In assessing the need for a
valuation allowance, the Company considers future taxable income and ongoing prudent and feasible tax planning strategies. In the event that the Company
determines that it would be able to realize its deferred tax assets in the future in excess of the net recorded amount, a reduction of the valuation allowance
would increase income in the period such determination was made. Likewise, should the Company determine that it would not be able to realize all or part
of its net deferred tax asset in the future, a reduction to the deferred tax asset would be charged to income in the period such determination was made. 

The Company’s net taxable temporary differences and tax carryforwards are recorded using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the
periods in which the deferred tax liability or asset is expected to be settled or realized. Should the expected applicable tax rates change in the future, an
adjustment to the Company’s deferred taxes would be credited or charged, as appropriate, to income in the period such determination was made.

The  Company’s  effective  tax  rates  differ  from  the  statutory  rate  primarily  due  to  changes  in  the  valuation  allowance,  foreign  operations,  research  and
development tax credits, state taxes, and certain benefits realized related to stock option activity. The

63

Table of Contents

Company’s current effective tax rate does not assume U.S. taxes on undistributed profits of foreign subsidiaries. These earnings could become subject to
incremental foreign withholding or U.S. state taxes, should they either be deemed or actually remitted to the U.S. The Company’s future effective tax rates
could  be  adversely  affected  by  earnings  being  lower  in  countries  where  the  Company  has  lower  statutory  rates  and  being  higher  in  countries  where  the
Company has higher statutory rates, or by changes in tax laws, accounting principles, interpretations thereof, net operating loss carryback, research, and
development tax credits, and due to changes in the valuation allowance applied to its U.S. deferred tax assets. In addition, the Company is subject to the
examination of the Company’s income tax returns by the Internal Revenue Service and other tax authorities. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood
of adverse outcomes resulting from these examinations to determine the adequacy of the Company’s provision for income taxes.

Undistributed earnings of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries as of December 31, 2021 are considered to be indefinitely reinvested and, accordingly, no
provision for income taxes has been provided thereon. Due to the Transition Tax and Global Intangible Low-Tax Income (“GILTI”) regimes as enacted by
the 2017 Tax Act, those foreign earnings will not be subject to federal income taxes when actually distributed in the form of a dividend or otherwise. The
Company, however, could still be subject to state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to various foreign countries. The amounts of taxes which the
Company could be subject to are not material to the accompanying financial statements.

On  March  27,  2020,  the  U.S.  federal  government  enacted  the  Coronavirus  Aid,  Relief,  and  Economic  Security  Act  (“CARES  Act”).  The  CARES  Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies to
carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. Further, in December
2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021 was signed into law. It clarified that gross income does not include any amount that would otherwise arise
from  the  forgiveness  of  a  PPP  loan.  The  CARES  Act  did  not  have  a  material  impact  on  the  Company's  income  tax  provision,  deferred  tax  assets  and
liabilities, and related taxes payable. 

The  Company  periodically  assesses  its  exposures  related  to  its  global  provision  for  income  taxes  and  believe  that  it  has  appropriately  accrued  taxes  for
contingencies.  Any  reduction  of  these  contingent  liabilities  or  additional  assessment  would  increase  or  decrease  income,  respectively,  in  the  period  such
determination was made.

The Company records a liability for uncertain tax positions that do not meet the more likely than not standard as prescribed by the authoritative guidance for
income tax accounting. The Company records tax benefits for only those positions that it believes will more likely than not be sustained. For positions that
the Company believes that it is more likely than not that it will prevail, the Company records a benefit considering the amounts and probabilities that could
be realized upon ultimate settlement. If the Company judgment as to the likely resolution of the uncertainty changes, if the uncertainty is ultimately settled
or if the statute of limitation related to the uncertainty expires, the effects of the change would be recognized in the period in which the change, resolution or
expiration occurs. The Company has provided for unrecognized tax benefits of $2.7 million and $1.9 million as of December 31, 2021 and December 31,
2020, respectively. See “Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 7. Income Taxes” in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for
more information.

Litigation

The Company has been, and may in the future become, subject to a number of legal proceedings involving securities litigation, product liability, intellectual
property,  contractual  disputes,  trademark  and  copyright,  and  other  matters.  The  Company  records  a  liability  and  related  charge  to  earnings  in  its
consolidated financial statements for legal contingencies when the loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. The Company’s
assessment  is  reevaluated  each  accounting  period  and  is  based  on  all  available  information,  including  discussion  with  any  outside  legal  counsel  that
represents us. If a reasonable estimate of a known or probable loss cannot be made, but a range of probable losses can be estimated, the low-end of the range
of  losses  is  recognized  if  no  amount  within  the  range  is  a  better  estimate  than  any  other.  If  a  loss  is  reasonably  possible,  but  not  probable  and  can  be
reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

The Company does not participate in transactions that generate relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, such as entities often
referred to as structured finance, variable interest or special purpose entities, which would have been established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance
sheet  arrangements  or  other  contractually  narrow  or  limited  purposes.  As  of  December  31,  2021,  the  Company  was  not  involved  in  any  unconsolidated
transactions.

64

Table of Contents

Recent Accounting Pronouncement

In addition to the impacts from new accounting pronouncements included above see Note 1 — “Summary of Significant Accounting Pronouncements” in
the  Notes  to  Consolidated  Financial  Statements  in  Part  II,  Item  8  of  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K.  for  a  complete  discussion  of  recent  accounting
pronouncements adopted and not adopted.

Results of Operations

The following table sets forth selected consolidated financial data expressed as a percentage of net revenue.

Net revenue

Cost of revenue

Gross margin

Operating expenses:

Sales and marketing

Research and development

General and administrative

Total operating expenses

Income/(Loss) from operations

Amortization of debt issuance costs

Interest on convertible notes

Gain on extinguishment of PPP loan

Other income (expense), net

Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax expense
Net income (loss)

Net Revenue

Year Ended December 31,

2021

2020

2019

100 %

42 %

58 %

33 %

9 %

14 %

57 %

1 %

— %

(1)%

3 %

(1)%

1 %
1 %
1 %

100 %

49 %

51 %

36 %

10 %

20 %

65 %

(15)%

— %

— %

— %

— %

(16)%
— %
(16)%

100 %

46 %

54 %

39 %

8 %

13 %

61 %

(7)%

— %

— %

— %

— %

(7)%
— %
(7)%

The following table sets forth selected consolidated revenue by major geographic area and product category with changes thereof.

65

Table of Contents

(Dollars in thousands)

Revenue mix by geography:

North America

Japan

Rest of World

Consolidated total revenue

North America as a percentage of total
revenue

Japan as a percentage of total revenue

Rest of World as a percentage of total revenue

Revenue mix by product category:

Systems - North America

Systems - Rest of World (including Japan)

Total Systems

Consumables

Skincare

Total Products

Service

Total Net revenue

Total Net Revenue

2021

% Change

2020

% Change

2019

Year Ended December 31,

$

$

$

$

111,621 

70,235 

49,414 

231,270 

48 %

31 %

21 %

86,100 

53,533 

139,633 

16,401 

49,669 

205,703 

25,567 

231,270 

61 % $
62 %

41 %
57 % $

69,455 

43,265 

34,963 

147,683 

(41)% $
79 %

(14)%
(19)% $

116,933 

24,143 

40,636 

181,712 

47 %

29 %

24 %

65 %

13 %

22 %

70 % $
34 %

54 %

77 %

98 %

64 %

13 %
57 % $

50,721 

40,045 

90,766 

9,286 

25,061 

125,113 

22,570 

147,683 

(48)% $
(8)%

(35)%

(4)%

194 %

(21)%

(2)%
(19)% $

96,718 

43,760 

140,478 

9,648 

8,512 

158,638 

23,074 

181,712 

The Company’s total revenue increased by $83.6 million, or 57%, for the year ended December 31, 2021, compared to 2020, due primarily to a significant
recovery  in  sales  in  the  North  America  market  as  the  U.S.  economic  outlook  improved  in  2021  and  increase  in  Skincare  products  sales  in  Japan.  The
increase was driven mainly by increase in volume.

Revenue by Geography

The Company’s North America revenue increased by $42.2 million, or 61%, for the year ended December 31, 2021, compared to the same period in 2020,
driven primary by a recovery in sales following an improvement in conditions related to the COVID-19 pandemic.

The  Company's  revenue  in  Japan  increased  $27.0  million,  or  62%,  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021,  compared  to  2020.  The  increase  was  due
primarily to a significant increase in sales of Skincare products.

The  Company’s  Rest  of  World  revenue  increased  $14.5  million,  or  41%,  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021,  compared  to  the  same  period  in  2020,
driven primarily by a recovery in sales following an improvement in conditions related to the COVID-19 pandemic.

Revenue by Product Type

Systems Revenue

Systems  revenue  in  North  America  increased  by  $35.4  million,  or  70%,  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021,  compared  to  the  same  period  in  2020,
mainly due to the recovery from the business disruptions caused by the COVID-19 pandemic. The Rest of the World systems revenue increased by $13.5
million, or 34%, compared to the same period in 2020. The increase in Rest of the World revenue was primarily due to increased sales in the Company’s
direct businesses in Australia and Europe, partially offset by decreased sales from distributors in the Middle East and Asian regions.

66

Table of Contents

Consumables Revenue

Consumables  revenue  increased  $7.1  million,  or  77%,  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021,  compared  to  the  same  period  in  2020.  The  increase  in
consumables revenue was primarily due to the increasing installed base of truSculpt iD, Secret RF, truSculpt 3D and truSculpt flex, each of which have a
consumable element.

Skincare Revenue

The Company’s revenue from Skincare products in Japan increased $24.6 million, or 98%, for the year ended December 31, 2021, compared to the same
period  in  2020.  This  increase  was  due  primarily  to  increased  marketing  and  promotional  efforts,  as  well  as  changes  in  customers  behavior  due  to  the
COVID-19 pandemic, as some consumers opted to purchase skincare products rather than go to a doctor's office for treatment, a trend which began in 2020.

Service Revenue

The Company’s Service revenue increased $3.0 million, or 13%, for the year ended December 31, 2021, compared to the same period in 2020. This increase
was  due  primarily  to  increased  sales  of  service  contracts,  as  well  as  support  and  maintenance  services  provided  on  a  time  and  materials  basis  to  the
Company's network of international distributors.

Gross Profit

(Dollars in thousands)
Gross profit

As a percentage of total net revenue

$

2021
133,105 

57.6 %

Change

Year Ended December 31,
2020

Change

2019

$

57,333 

$

75,772 

$

(22,391)

$

6.2 %

51.3 %

(2.7)%

98,163 

54.0 %

Gross profit as a percentage of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2021, increased from 51.3% to 57.6%, compared to the same period in 2020. The
increase in gross profit as a percentage of revenue was primarily driven by an increase in volumes as a result of the economic recovery. The increase in sales
volume improved the Company's leveraging of fixed costs, which improved the Company's gross margin.

Sales and Marketing

(Dollars in thousands)
Sales and marketing

As a percentage of total net revenue

33.2 %

(2.5)%

35.7 %

(3.4)%

2021

Change

Year Ended December 31,
2020

Change

2019

$

76,762 

$

23,996 

$

52,766 

$

(18,343)

$

71,109 

39.1 %

Sales  and  marketing  expenses  consist  primarily  of  personnel  expenses,  expenses  associated  with  customer-attended  workshops  and  trade  shows,  post-
marketing  studies,  advertising,  and  training.  Sales  and  marketing  expenses  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021  increased  $24.0  million,  or  45%,
compared to the same period in 2020. This increase reflected headcount growth and an $11.3 million increase in commission costs due to higher revenue.
Also contributing to the increase in sales and marketing expenses was a $4.0 million increase in consulting and outside professional services, a $3.5 million
increase in marketing costs related to new business, trade shows and other promotions, and a $2.4 million increase due to resumption in travel activities.

Research and Development (“R&D”)

(Dollars in thousands)
Research and development

As a percentage of total net revenue

9.3 %

(0.4)%

9.7 %

$

21,568 

$

7,246 

$

14,322 

$

(763)

$

1.4 %

15,085 

8.3 %

2021

Change

2020

Change

2019

Year Ended December 31,

R&D expenses consist primarily of personnel expenses, clinical research, regulatory and material costs. R&D expenses increased by $7.2, or 51%, for the
year ended December 31, 2021, compared to the same period in 2020. The increase in

67

Table of Contents

expense  was  due  primarily  to  a  $4.7  million  increase  in  salaries  and  benefits,  a  $1.4  million  increase  in  outside  services,  and  a  $0.7  million  increase  in
material and equipment costs used for research and development activities.

General and Administrative (“G&A”)

(Dollars in thousands)
General and administrative

As a percentage of total net revenue

14.2 %

$

32,945 

$

1,433 

$

(5.8)%

31,512 

$

20.0 %

7,479 

$

6.8 %

24,033 

13.2 %

2021

Change

Year Ended December 31,
2020

Change

2019

G&A  expenses  consist  primarily  of  personnel  expenses,  legal,  accounting,  audit  and  tax  consulting  fees,  as  well  as  other  general  and  administrative
expenses. G&A expenses increased by $1.4 million, or 5%, for the year ended December 31, 2021, compared to the same period in 2020. The increase in
expenses  was  due  primarily  to  a  $6.2  million  increase  in  labor-related  expenses  driven  by  an  increase  in  headcount,  partially  offset  by  a  $2.1  million
decrease in professional fees, consulting services and legal fees, and a $2.1 million decrease in credit loss expense.

Interest and Other Income (Expense), Net

Interest and other income (expense), net, consists of the following:

(Dollars in thousands)
Interest and other income (expense), net

2021

Change

Year Ended December 31,
2020

Change

2019

$

1,555 

$

2,134  $

(579) $

(380) $

(199)

Interest  and  other  income  (expense),  net,  increased  $2.1  million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021,  compared  to  2020,  due  to  a  $7.2  million  gain
resulting  from  the  forgiveness  of  the  PPP  loan  and  accrued  interest.  This  gain  was  partially  offset  by  interest  expense  of  $2.5  million  related  to  the
convertible notes issued in March 2021, and $1.8 million due to foreign exchange fluctuations.

Income Tax Provision

(Dollars in thousands)
Income tax provision

2021

Change

Year Ended December 31,
2020

Change

2019

$

1,323 

$

853 

$

470 

$

385 

$

85 

Income tax provision increased $0.9 million, or 181%, for the year ended December 31, 2021, compared to the same period in 2020. This increase reflects
higher net earnings from the Company's foreign subsidiaries.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Sources and Uses of Cash

The Company’s principal source of liquidity is cash generated from the issuance of convertible notes and common stock through exercise of stock options
and  the  Company’s  employee  stock  purchasing  program.  The  Company  actively  manages  its  cash  usage  and  investment  of  liquid  cash  to  ensure  the
maintenance of sufficient funds to meet its daily needs. The majority of the Company’s cash is held in U.S. banks and its foreign subsidiaries maintain a
limited amount of cash in their local banks to cover their short-term operating expenses.

As  of  December  31,  2021  and  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  had  $175.8  million  and  $51.9  million  of  working  capital,  respectively.  Cash  and  cash
equivalents  increased  by  $117.1  million  to  $164.2  million  as  of  December  31,  2021,  from  $47.0  million  as  of  December  31,  2020,  primarily  due  to  net
proceeds from the issuance of the convertible notes, partially offset by $16.1 million in premiums paid for separate capped call transactions related to the
issuance of the convertible notes.

68

Table of Contents

Cash, Cash Equivalents and Restricted Cash

The following table summarizes the Company’s cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash (in thousands):

(Dollars in thousands)

Cash and cash equivalents

Restricted cash

Cash and cash equivalents

Consolidated Cash Flow Data

In summary, the Company’s cash flows were as follows:

(Dollars in thousands)

Cash flows provided by (used in):

Operating activities

Investing activities

Financing activities

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

Cash Flows from Operating Activities

Year ended December 31,

2021

2020

Change

164,164  $

700 
164,864  $

47,047  $

— 
47,047  $

117,117 

700 
117,817 

Year ended December 31,

2021

2020

2019

1,235  $

(944)

117,526 
117,817  $

(16,934) $

6,389 

31,276 

20,731  $

(2,217)

1,067 

1,414 

264 

$

$

$

$

Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2021, was $1.2 million, which reflected net income, adjusted for non-cash items
of $14.4 million, offset by changes in assets and liabilities of $13.2 million.

Cash Flows from Investing Activities

Net cash used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2021, was $0.9 million, which was primarily due to purchases of property, equipment
and software.

Cash Flows from Financing Activities

Net cash provided by financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2021 was $117.5 million, which was primarily due to the proceeds from the
issuance of convertible notes, net of issuance costs, and cash used for the purchase of capped calls of $117.4 million

Adequacy of Cash Resources to Meet Future Needs

The Company had cash and cash equivalents of $164.2 million as of December 31, 2021. For fiscal year 2021, the Company’s principal source of liquidity
was $133.5 million of net proceeds from the issuance of the convertible notes, partially offset by $16.1 million in premiums paid concurrently for a separate
capped call transaction. The Company believes that the existing cash resources are sufficient to meet the Company’s anticipated cash needs for working
capital and capital expenditures through at least the next 12 months from the date the financial statements are issued, but there can be no assurances.

Debt

In March 2021, the Company issued $138.3 million aggregate principal amount of convertible notes due on March 15, 2026 in a private placement offering.
The convertible notes bear interest at a rate of 2.25% per year payable semiannually in arrears on March 15 and September 15 of each year. The convertible
notes are presented as long-term debt, net of debt discount. Proceeds from the offering were $133.5 million, net of issuance costs, including underwriters’
fees, which were recorded in the consolidated balance sheet.

On  July  9,  2020,  the  Company  terminated  its  undrawn  revolving  line  of  credit  with  Wells  Fargo  and  subsequently  entered  into  a  Loan  and  Security
Agreement  with  Silicon  Valley  Bank.  The  agreement  provides  for  a  four-year  secured  revolving  loan  facility  (“SVB  Revolving  Line  of  Credit”)  in  an
aggregate principal amount of up to $30.0 million. See Note 12 – Debt in the accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.

69

Table of Contents

The Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank contains customary affirmative covenants, such as financial statement reporting requirements
and  delivery  of  borrowing  base  certificates,  as  well  as  customary  covenants  that  restrict  the  Company’s  ability  to,  among  other  things,  incur  additional
indebtedness,  sell  certain  assets,  guarantee  obligations  of  third  parties,  declare  dividends,  or  make  certain  distributions,  and  undergo  a  merger  or
consolidation or certain other transactions. The Loan and Security Agreement also contains certain financial condition covenants.

On March 4, 2021, the Loan and Security Agreement dated July 9, 2020 was amended to (i) permit the Company to issue the convertible notes, and (ii)
to permit the capped call transactions.

On or about May 28, 2021, the Loan and Security Agreement was amended. The amendment removed the quarterly minimum revenue requirement but kept
the in place the other financial covenants.

As  of  December  31,  2021,  the  Company  had  not  drawn  on  the  SVB  Revolving  Line  of  Credit  and  the  Company  is  in  compliance  with  all  financial
covenants of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit.

Purchase Commitments

The Company maintains certain open inventory purchase commitments with its suppliers to ensure a smooth and continuous supply for key components.
The Company’s liability in these purchase commitments is generally restricted to an agreed-upon period. Such time periods can vary among different
suppliers. The Company believes it has adequate funds to fulfill any such commitments in the future using the sources discussed in this Item 7 –
Management’s Discussion & Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.

Other

In the normal course of business, the Company enters into agreements that contain a variety of representations, warranties, and indemnification obligations.
For example, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements with each of the Company’s directors and executive officers. The Company’s
exposure under the various indemnification obligations is unknown and not reasonably estimable as they involve future claims that may be made against us.
As such, the Company has not accrued any amounts for such obligations.

70

Table of Contents

ITEM 7A    QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

The conditional conversion feature of the convertible notes, if triggered, may adversely affect our financial condition and operating results.

Holders may convert their Notes at their option prior to the close of business on the business day immediately preceding December 15, 2025, in multiples of
$1,000 principal amount, only under the following circumstances:

• During any fiscal quarter commencing after the fiscal quarter ended on June 30, 2021 (and only during such fiscal quarter), if the last reported sale
price of the common stock for at least 20 trading days (whether or not consecutive) during a period of 30 consecutive trading days ending on and
including,  the  last  trading  day  of  the  immediately  preceding  fiscal  quarter,  is  greater  than  or  equal  to  130%  of  the  conversion  price  for  the
convertible notes on each applicable trading day;

• During  the  five-business  day  period  after  any  five  consecutive  trading  day  period  (the  “measurement  period”)  in  which  the  “trading  price”  per
$1,000 principal amount of convertible notes for each trading day of the measurement period was less than 98% of the product of the last reported
sale price of the Company's common stock and the conversion rate on each such trading day;
The  Company  calls  such  convertible  notes  for  redemption,  at  any  time  prior  to  the  close  of  business  on  the  second  scheduled  trading  day
immediately preceding the redemption date; or
• Upon the occurrence of specified corporate events.

•

On or after December 15, 2025, and until the close of business on the second scheduled trading day immediately preceding the maturity date, holders may
convert all or any portion of their Notes, in multiples of $1,000 principal amount, at the option of the holder regardless of the foregoing circumstances.

The circumstances described in the first bullet of the paragraph above were met during the second and third quarters of 2021 as the Company's stock traded
at a price in excess of the conversion price for the required number of days during each of those quarters. These circumstances were not met during the
fourth quarter of 2021. As a result, holders of the Notes had the right to convert their Notes beginning July 1, 2021 and ending on December 31, 2021. As of
December 31, 2021, the Notes are not convertible and this condition will remain until March 31, 2022. The Notes may become convertible in future periods.

If one or more holders elect to convert their convertible notes, unless the Company elects to satisfy its conversion obligation by delivering solely shares of
its common stock, the Company would be required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation through the payment of cash, which could adversely
affect the Company’s liquidity.

Interest Rate and Market Risk

As of December 31, 2021 the Company had not drawn on the SVB Revolving Line of Credit. Overall interest rate sensitivity is primarily influenced by any
amount borrowed on the line of credit and the prevailing interest rate on the line of credit facility. The effective interest rate on the line of credit facility is
based on a floating per annum rate equal to the greater of either 1.75% above the Prime Rate or 5%. The Prime Rate was 3.25% as of December 31, 2021,
and accordingly the Company may incur additional expenses if the Company has an outstanding balance on the line of credit and the Prime Rate increases
in future periods.

Inflation

Certain  production-related  costs,  including  freight  expense  and  components  costs,  were  subject  to  inflationary  pressure  in  2021.  During  the  year  ended
December  31,  2021,  we  were  generally  able  to  offset  the  inflationary  impact  by  managing  our  sales  mix  and  leveraging  our  fixed  cost  base.  If  the
Company’s  costs  were  to  become  subject  to  significant  inflationary  pressures,  the  Company  might  not  be  able  to  fully  mitigate  such  higher  costs.  The
Company’s inability or failure to do so could harm the Company’s business, financial condition, and results of operations.

Foreign Exchange Fluctuations

The Company generates revenue in Japanese Yen, Euros, Australian Dollars, Canadian Dollars, British Pounds and Swiss Francs. The Company’s skincare
revenue,  which  was  $49.7  million  in  2021,  is  denominated  in  Japanese  Yen  and  the  related  product  costs  to  the  Company  denominated  in  U.S.  dollars.
Additionally, approximately 14% of expenses, 15% of assets and 7% of liabilities are denominated in non-U.S. dollar currencies. Therefore, fluctuations in
these  currencies  against  the  U.S.  dollar  could  materially  and  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  results  of  operations  upon  translation  of  the  Company’s
revenue denominated in these currencies, as well as the re-measurement of the Company’s international subsidiaries’ financial

71

Table of Contents

statements  into  U.S.  dollars.  The  Company  has  historically  not  engaged  in  hedging  activities  relating  to  the  Company’s  foreign  currency  denominated
transactions.

72

Table of Contents

ITEM 8.    FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

CUTERA, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY COMPANIES

ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The following Consolidated Financial Statements of the Registrant and its subsidiaries are required to be included in Item 8:

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (BDO USA, LLP; San Francisco, California; PCAOB ID#243)

Consolidated Balance Sheets

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Schedule II -Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

Page

74

78

79

80

81

82

83

112

All other required schedules are omitted because of the absence of conditions under which they are required or because the required information is given in
the Consolidated Financial Statements or the Notes thereto.

73

Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Shareholders and Board of Directors
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California

Opinion on the Consolidated Financial Statements

We  have  audited  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance  sheets  of  Cutera,  Inc.  (the  “Company”)  as  of  December  31,  2021  and  2020,  the  related
consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 2021, and the related notes and schedule (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated
financial  statements  present  fairly,  in  all  material  respects,  the  financial  position  of  the  Company  at  December  31,  2021  and  2020,  and  the  results  of  its
operations  and  its  cash  flows  for  each  of  the  three  years  in  the  period  ended  December  31,  2021,  in  conformity  with  accounting  principles  generally
accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the Company's
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued
by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) and our report dated March 1, 2022 expressed an adverse opinion
thereon.

Basis for Opinion

These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s
consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with
respect  to  the  Company  in  accordance  with  the  U.S.  federal  securities  laws  and  the  applicable  rules  and  regulations  of  the  Securities  and  Exchange
Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable
assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud.

Our  audits  included  performing  procedures  to  assess  the  risks  of  material  misstatement  of  the  consolidated  financial  statements,  whether  due  to  error  or
fraud,  and  performing  procedures  that  respond  to  those  risks.  Such  procedures  included  examining,  on  a  test  basis,  evidence  regarding  the  amounts  and
disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.

Critical Audit Matter

The  critical  audit  matter  communicated  below  is  a  matter  arising  from  the  current  period  audit  of  the  consolidated  financial  statements  that  was
communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the consolidated
financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of a critical audit matter does not
alter in any way our opinion on the consolidated financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below,
providing separate opinions on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.

The  Company  recognized  total  net  revenue  of  approximately  $231.3  million  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021.  As  described  in  Note  1  to  the
consolidated financial statements, the Company recognizes revenue in a manner that best depicts the transfer of control of promised products or services to
the  customer,  in  an  amount  that  reflects  the  consideration  to  which  the  Company  expects  to  be  entitled.  The  Company’s  contracts  with  customers  may
include,  individually,  or  in  combination,  systems,  extended  service  contracts,  training,  marketing  support  and  accessories.  Certain  of  the  Company’s
contracts,  which  include  some  with  international  distributors,  can  include  non-standard  payment  and  other  sales  terms  that  can  impact  management’s
conclusions as to whether it is probable at contract inception that the Company will collect substantially all of the consideration to which it will be entitled
or  whether  control  has  transferred  to  the  customer.  Management  applies  significant  effort  and  judgment  in  evaluating  the  impact  of  these  non-standard
payment and sales terms on revenue recognition.

We  identified  the  evaluation  of  non-standard  payment  and  other  sales  terms  in  the  Company’s  contracts  with  international  distributors  as  a  critical  audit
matter. Auditing the impact of non-standard payment and other sales terms on management’s conclusions of whether the transfer of control has occurred
requires significant auditor effort and increased auditor judgment in performing procedures to evaluate management’s judgment.

74

Table of Contents

The primary procedures we performed to address this critical audit matter included:

•

•

Examining certain international distributor contracts, including any amendments or modifications, for non-standard payment terms and, where such
terms are present, evaluating management’s assessment of whether collection is probable, based on a consideration of indicators of the international
distributor’s liquidity and of the collection and credit memo history with the international distributor and with similar international distributors with
similar payment terms.
Examining  certain  international  distributor  contracts,  including  any  amendments  or  modifications,  for  non-standard  terms  governing  transfer  of
control  and,  where  such  terms  are  present,  evaluating  management’s  conclusions  regarding  the  transfer  of  control  based  on  an  assessment  of
considerations including whether the international distributor has physical possession and legal title to the product, whether the Company has a
present right to payment, and other factors relevant to the determination of whether the international distributor has the ability to direct the use of
and obtain substantially all of the remaining benefit from the product.

/s/ BDO USA, LLP
We have served as the Company's auditor since 2014.
San Francisco, California
March 1, 2022

75

Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Shareholders and Board of Directors
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California

Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited Cutera, Inc.’s (the “Company’s”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, based on criteria established in Internal
Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the “COSO criteria”). In our
opinion, the Company did not maintain, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, based on the
COSO criteria. We do not express an opinion or any other form of assurance on management’s statements referring to any corrective actions taken by the
Company after the date of management’s assessment.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the consolidated
balance  sheets  of  the  Company  as  of  December  31,  2021  and  2020,  the  related  consolidated  statements  of  operations,  comprehensive  income  (loss),
stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2021, and the related notes and schedule (collectively
referred to as the "financial statements") and our report dated March 1, 2022 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Basis for Opinion

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of
internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Item 9A, Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our
responsibility  is  to  express  an  opinion  on  the  Company’s  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  based  on  our  audit.  We  are  a  public  accounting  firm
registered  with  the  PCAOB  and  are  required  to  be  independent  with  respect  to  the  Company  in  accordance  with  U.S.  federal  securities  laws  and  the
applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan
and  perform  the  audit  to  obtain  reasonable  assurance  about  whether  effective  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  was  maintained  in  all  material
respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and
testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other
procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A material weakness is a deficiency, or a combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a reasonable possibility
that  a  material  misstatement  of  the  company’s  annual  or  interim  financial  statements  will  not  be  prevented  or  detected  on  a  timely  basis.  A  material
weakness regarding ineffective information technology general controls (“ITGCs”) in the areas of user access and segregation of duties related to certain
information technology (“IT”) systems that support the Company’s financial reporting process at its Japan subsidiary has been identified and described in
management’s assessment. This material weakness was considered in determining the nature, timing, and extent of audit tests applied in our audit of the
2021 financial statements, and this report does not affect our report dated March 1, 2022 on those financial statements.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting
and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control
over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly
reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit
preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being
made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or
timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

76

Table of Contents

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of
effectiveness  to  future  periods  are  subject  to  the  risk  that  controls  may  become  inadequate  because  of  changes  in  conditions,  or  that  the  degree  of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ BDO USA, LLP
San Francisco, California
March 1, 2022

77

Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
(in thousands, except share and per share data)

Assets
Current assets:

Cash and cash equivalents
Accounts receivable, net of allowance for credit losses of $899 and $1,598, respectively
Inventories
Other current assets and prepaid expenses

Total current assets
Property and equipment, net
Deferred tax assets
Operating lease right-of-use assets
Goodwill
Other long-term assets
Restricted cash

Total assets

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
Current liabilities:

Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
PPP loan payable
Deferred revenue

Total current liabilities

Deferred revenue, net of current portion
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion
PPP loan payable, net of current portion
Convertible notes, net of unamortized debt issuance costs of $4,007
Other long-term liabilities

Total liabilities

Commitments and contingencies (Note 11).
Stockholders’ equity:
Common stock, $0.001 par value: Authorized: 50,000,000 shares; Issued and outstanding: 17,995,344 and

17,679,232 shares at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively
Additional paid-in capital
Accumulated deficit

Total stockholders’ equity

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

December 31,

2021

2020

$

$

$

$

164,164  $
31,449 
39,503 
14,545 
249,661 
3,019 
778 
14,627 
1,339 
10,169 
700 
280,293  $

7,891  $

54,100 
2,419 
— 
9,490 
73,900 
1,335 
13,483 
— 
134,243 
763 
223,724 

18 
114,724 
(58,173)
56,569 
280,293  $

47,047 
21,962 
28,508 
8,779 
106,296 
2,299 
643 
17,076 
1,339 
5,080 
— 
132,733 

6,684 
32,295 
2,260 
3,630 
9,489 
54,358 
1,748 
15,950 
3,555 
— 
242 
75,853 

18 
117,097 
(60,235)
56,880 
132,733 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

78

Table of Contents

Net revenue:
Products
Service

Total net revenue

Cost of revenue:

Products
Service

Total cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:

Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative

Total operating expenses

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(in thousands, except per share data)

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

$

205,703  $
25,567 
231,270 

125,113  $
22,570 
147,683 

83,048 
15,117 
98,165 
133,105 

76,762 
21,568 
32,945 
131,275 
1,830 

(710)
(2,514)
7,185 
(2,406)
1,555 
3,385 
1,323 
2,062  $

58,325 
13,586 
71,911 
75,772 

52,766 
14,322 
31,512 
98,600 
(22,828)

— 
— 
— 
(579)
(579)
(23,407)
470 
(23,877) $

158,638 
23,074 
181,712 

64,693 
18,856 
83,549 
98,163 

71,109 
15,085 
24,033 
110,227 
(12,064)

— 
— 
— 
(199)
(199)
(12,263)
85 
(12,348)

0.12  $
0.11  $

(1.43) $
(1.43) $

(0.88)
(0.88)

17,891 
18,362 

16,691 
16,691 

14,096 
14,096 

Income (loss) from operations
Interest and other income (expense), net:
    Amortization of debt issuance costs
    Interest on convertible notes
    Gain on extinguishment of PPP loan
    Other expense, net
                Total interest and other income (expense), net
Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax provision

Net income (loss)

Net income (loss) per share:

Basic
Diluted

Weighted-average number of shares used in per share calculations:

Basic
Diluted

$

$
$

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

79

Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
(in thousands)

Net income (loss)
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Available-for-sale investments

Net change in unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale investments
Less: Reclassification adjustment for net losses on investments recognized during the year
Total change in unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale investments

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

Comprehensive income (loss)

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

2,062  $

(23,877) $

(12,348)

— 
— 
— 
— 
2,062  $

(3)
63 
60 
60 
(23,817) $

9 
— 
9 
9 
(12,339)

$

$

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

80

Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(in thousands, except share amounts)

Balance at December 31, 2018
Issuance of common stock for employee purchase
plan
Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in settlement of
restricted and performance stock units, net of
shares withheld for employee taxes
Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-for-
sale investments
Balance at December 31, 2019

Issuance of common stock for employee purchase
plan
Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in connection with
public offering, net of issuance costs of $2,303
Issuance of common stock in settlement of
restricted and performance stock units, net of
shares withheld for employee taxes
Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-for-
sale investments
Balance at December 31, 2020

Issuance of common stock for employee purchase
plan
Exercise of stock options
Purchase of capped call
Issuance of common stock in settlement of
restricted and performance stock units, net of
shares withheld for employee taxes
Stock-based compensation expense
Net income
Balance at December 31, 2021

Common Stock

Shares
13,968,852  $

Amount

Additional
Paid-in
Capital

Retained
Earnings
(Accumulated 
Deficit)

Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive 
Income (loss)

Total
Stockholders’ 
Equity

14  $

70,451  $

(24,010) $

(69) $

46,386 

82,810 
160,798 

103,126 
— 
— 

— 

14,315,586  $

56,751 
73,227 

2,742,750 

490,918 
— 
— 

— 

17,679,232  $

59,635 
71,798 
— 

184,679 
— 
— 

17,995,344  $

— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

1,281 
1,613 

(831)
9,832 
— 

— 
— 

— 
— 
(12,348)

— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
14  $

— 
82,346  $

— 
(36,358) $

9 
(60) $

— 

3 

1 
— 
— 

632 
947 

26,492 

(3,429)
10,109 
— 

— 
— 

— 

— 
— 
(23,877)

— 
18  $

— 
117,097  $

— 
(60,235) $

— 

— 

— 
— 
— 
18  $

1,184 
1,581 
(16,134)

— 
— 
— 

(2,176)
13,172 
— 
114,724  $

— 
— 
2,062 
(58,173) $

— 
— 

— 

— 
— 
— 

60 
—  $

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
—  $

1,281 
1,613 

(831)
9,832 
(12,348)

9 
45,942 

632 
947 

26,495 

(3,428)
10,109 
(23,877)

60 
56,880 

1,184 
1,581 
(16,134)

(2,176)
13,172 
2,062 
56,569 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

81

Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (in thousands)

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net income (loss)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

2021

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2019

$

2,062 

$

(23,877)

$

(12,348)

Stock-based compensation
Depreciation and amortization
Amortization of contract acquisition costs
Amortization of debt issuance costs
Impairment of capitalized cloud computing costs
Change in deferred tax assets
Provision for credit losses
Gain on extinguishment of PPP loan
Change in right-of-use asset
Other

Changes in assets and liabilities:

Accounts receivable
Inventories
Other current assets and prepaid expenses
Other long-term assets
Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities
Other long-term liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
Deferred revenue
Income tax liability

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

Cash flows from investing activities:

Acquisition of property and equipment
Disposal of property and equipment
Proceeds from sales of marketable investments
Proceeds from maturities of marketable investments
Purchase of marketable investments

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

Cash flows from financing activities:

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and employee stock purchase plan
Purchase of capped call
Proceeds from PPP loan
Proceeds from issuance of convertible notes
Payment of issuance costs of convertible notes
Gross proceeds from equity offering
Issuance costs on the public offering
Taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards
Payments on capital lease obligation

Net cash provided by financing activities

Net increase in cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash
Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash at beginning of year

Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash at end of year
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:

Cash paid for interest
Cash paid (refunded) for income taxes, net of (refunds) payments

Supplemental non-cash investing and financing activities:

Assets acquired under finance lease
Assets acquired under operating lease
Gain on extinguishment of PPP loan

13,172 
1,344 
1,857 
710 
182 
(135)
87 
(7,185)
2,292 
1 

(9,574)
(10,936)
(5,766)
(7,128)
1,207 
21,608 
— 
(2,151)
(412)
— 
1,235 

(1,015)
71 
— 
— 
— 
(944)

2,765 
(16,134)
— 
138,250 
(4,717)
— 
— 
(2,176)
(462)
117,526 
117,817 
47,047 
164,864 

1,663 
891 

828 
123 
7,185 

$

$
$

$
$
$

10,109 
1,394 
2,593 
— 
805 
(220)
2,144 
— 
2,522 
513 

(2,550)
5,413 
(3,164)
(2,067)
(6,034)
161 
— 
(1,598)
(2,985)
(93)
(16,934)

(1,279)
30 
5,648 
28,050 
(26,060)
6,389 

1,579 
— 
7,167 
— 
— 
28,798 
(2,303)
(3,428)
(537)
31,276 
20,731 
26,316 
47,047 

63 
(1)

43 
11,735 
— 

$

$
$

$
$
$

9,832 
1,548 
2,915 
— 
— 
34 
590 
— 
2,502 
(83)

(2,509)
(5,907)
(1,762)
(3,355)
1,406 
5,997 
(140)
(2,292)
1,656 
(301)
(2,217)

(991)
45 
— 
14,700 
(12,687)
1,067 

2,894 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
(831)
(649)
1,414 
264 
26,052 
26,316 

81 
59 

738 
— 
— 

$

$
$

$
$
$

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

82

Table of Contents

CUTERA, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1—SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Description of Operations and Principles of Consolidation

Cutera,  Inc.  (“Cutera”  or  the  “Company”)  provides  energy-based  aesthetic  systems  for  practitioners  worldwide.  The  Company  develops,  manufactures,
distributes, and markets energy-based product platforms for use by physicians and other qualified practitioners, enabling them to offer safe and effective
aesthetic treatments to their customers. The Company currently markets the following system platforms: enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Secret RF, truSculpt
and xeo. Several of the Company’s systems offer multiple hand pieces and applications, providing customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems. The
sales of (i) systems, system upgrades, and hand pieces (collectively “Systems” revenue); (ii) replacement hand pieces, Titan, truSculpt 3D,truSculpt iD and
truSculpt flex cycle refills, as well as single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, and Secret RF (“Consumables” revenue); (iii) the distribution of
third  party  manufactured  skincare  products  (“Skincare”  revenue);  and  (iv)  the  leasing  of  equipment  through  a  membership  program;  are  collectively
classified as “Products” revenue. In addition to Products revenue, the Company generates revenue from the sale of post-warranty service contracts, parts,
detachable hand piece replacements (except for Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex)  and  service  labor  for  the  repair  and  maintenance  of
products that are out of warranty, all of which are collectively classified as “Service” revenue.

The Company’s corporate headquarters and U.S. operations are located in Brisbane, California, where the Company conducts manufacturing, warehousing,
research and development, regulatory, sales and marketing, service, and administrative activities. The Company also maintains regional distribution centers
(“RDCs”)  in  selection  locations  across  the  U.S.  These  RDCs  serve  as  forward  warehousing  for  systems  and  service  parts  in  various  geographies.  The
Company markets sells and services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including Canada), Australia,
Austria, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, the Netherlands, Spain, Switzerland, and the United Kingdom. Sales and services outside of these
direct markets are made through a worldwide distributor network in over 42 countries. The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the
Company and its subsidiaries. All inter-company transactions and balances have been eliminated.

Basis of Presentation

The Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America
(“U.S. GAAP”). Certain prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform to the 2021 presentation.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires the Company’s management to make estimates and assumptions
that affect the amounts reported of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements
and the accompanying notes, and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reported periods. Actual results could differ materially from
those estimates.

On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its estimates, including those related to warranty obligations, sales commissions, allowance for credit losses,
sales  allowances,  valuation  of  inventories,  fair  value  of  goodwill,  useful  lives  of  property  and  equipment,  impairment  testing  for  long-lived-assets,
assumptions  regarding  variables  used  in  calculating  the  fair  value  of  the  Company's  equity  awards,  expected  achievement  of  performance  based  vesting
criteria, management performance bonuses, the standalone selling price of the Company's products and services, the period of benefit used to capitalize and
amortize  contract  acquisition  costs,  variable  consideration,  contingent  liabilities,  recoverability  of  deferred  tax  assets,  assumptions  used  in  operating  and
sales-type lease classification, implicit and incremental borrowing rates related to the Company’s leases, residual value of leased equipment, lease term and
effective income tax rates. Management bases estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable, the
results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities.

Risks and Uncertainties

The Company's future results of operations involve a number of risks and uncertainties. Factors that could affect the Company's future operating results and
cause actual results to vary materially from expectations include, but are not limited to, rapid technological change, continued acceptance of the Company's
products, stability of global financial markets, cybersecurity breaches and other disruptions that could compromise the Company’s information or results,
business disruptions that are

83

Table of Contents

caused by natural disasters or pandemic events, management of international activities, competition from substitute products and larger companies, ability to
obtain  and  maintain  regulatory  approvals,  government  regulations  and  oversight,  patent  and  other  types  of  litigation,  ability  to  protect  proprietary
technology from counterfeit versions of the Company's products, the successful execution of new product launches, strategic relationships and dependence
on key individuals.

In March 2020, the World Health Organization declared the COVID-19 outbreak a pandemic. The COVID-19 outbreak, and lately the Delta and Omicron
variants,  has  negatively  affected  the  United  States  and  global  economies.  The  spread  of  the  coronavirus,  which  caused  a  broad  impact  in  2020  globally,
including restrictions on travel, shifting work force to work remotely and quarantine policies put into place by businesses and governments, had a material
economic effect on the Company’s business during the year ended December 31, 2020. Notably, healthcare facilities in many countries effectively banned
elective procedures. Many of the Company’s products are used in aesthetic elective procedures and as such, the bans on elective procedures substantially
reduced the Company’s sales and marketing efforts in the early months of the pandemic and led the Company to implement cost control measures. Although
the Company’s operation and results of operations have significantly improved as the economic outlook due to the COVID-19 pandemic improved in 2021,
the COVID-19 outbreak continues to be fluid and the aftermath of the business and economic disruptions due to the COVID-19 is still uncertain, making it
difficult to forecast the final impact it could have on the Company’s future operations, including disruptions in the Company's supply chain and contract
manufacturing operations. The Company cannot presently predict the scope and severity of any impacts in future periods from the business shutdowns or
disruptions due to the COVID-19 pandemic, but the impact on economic activity including the possibility of recession or financial market instability could
have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, revenue, operating results, cash flows and financial condition.

The Company continues to assess whether any impairment of its goodwill or its long-lived assets has occurred, and has determined that no charges were
necessary  during  the  years  ended  December  31,  2021,  and  2020,  other  than  an  impairment  loss  of  $0.2  million  and  $0.8  million  on  capitalized
implementation  costs  of  cloud-based  CRM  software,  respectively.  The  Company’s  assumptions  about  future  conditions  important  to  its  assessment  of
potential impairment of its long-lived assets, and goodwill, including the impacts of the COVID-19 pandemic and other ongoing impacts to its business, are
subject to uncertainty, and the Company will continue to monitor these conditions in future periods as new information becomes available. 

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements

In  June  2016,  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  (“FASB”)  issued  Accounting  Standards  Update  (“ASU”)  No.  2016-13,  Financial  Instruments-
Credit Losses (Topic 326):"Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments", which replaces the incurred loss methodology with an expected credit
loss  methodology  that  is  referred  to  as  the  current  expected  credit  loss  (CECL)  methodology.  ASU  2016-13  is  effective  for  fiscal  years  beginning  after
December 15, 2019, with early adoption permitted. The amendments in this update are required to be applied using the modified retrospective method with
an adjustment to accumulated deficit and are effective for the Company beginning with fiscal year 2020, including interim periods. The measurement of
expected credit losses under the CECL methodology is applicable to financial assets measured at amortized cost, including loan receivables, available for
sale securities and held-to-maturity debt securities. An entity with available for sale securities and trade receivables will be required to use historical loss
information, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts to determine expected lifetime credit losses. Pooling of assets with similar risk
characteristics is also required. The Company adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2020 on a modified retrospective basis. Upon adoption, the standard did
not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

The Company identified trade receivables and available-for-sale debt securities as impacted by the new guidance. However, the Company determined that
the historical losses related to these available-for-sale debt securities are not material as the Company invests in high grade short-term securities.

The Company establishes an allowance for credit losses on trade receivables based on the credit quality of clients, current economic conditions, the age of
the accounts receivable balances, historical loss information, and current conditions and forecasted information, and write-off amounts against the allowance
when they are deemed uncollectible.

In  August  2018,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  No.  2018-13,  “Fair  Value  Measurement  (Topic  820):  Disclosure  Framework-  Changes  to  the  Disclosure
Requirements  for  Fair  Value  Measurement”,  to  improve  the  fair  value  measurement  reporting  of  financial  instruments.  The  amendments  in  this  update
require,  among  other  things,  added  disclosure  of  the  range  and  weighted  average  of  significant  unobservable  inputs  used  to  develop  Level  3  fair  value
measurements. The amendments in this update eliminate, among other things, disclosure of the reasons for and amounts of transfers between Level 1 and
Level 2 for assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis and an entity's valuation processes for Level 3 fair value measurements.
The amendments in this update became effective for the Company beginning with fiscal year 2020. Retrospective application is required for all amendments
in this update except the added disclosures, which should be applied prospectively. The adoption

84

Table of Contents

of the amendments in this update did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In  December  2019,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  No.  2019-12  “Income  Taxes  (Topic  740)-Simplifying  the  Accounting  for  Income  Taxes,”  to  remove  certain
exceptions and improve consistency of application, including, among other things, requiring that an entity reflect the effect of an enacted change in tax laws
or rates in the annual effective tax rate computation in the interim period that includes the enactment date. The Company adopted this guidance starting
January 1, 2021. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In August 2020, the FASB issued ASU No. 2020-6, Debt – Debt with Conversion and Other Options (Topic 470) and Derivatives and Hedging – Contracts
in Entity’s Own Equity (Topic 815), to simplify the accounting for convertible debt instruments by removing the beneficial conversion and cash conversion
separation models for convertible instruments. Under the amendment, the embedded conversion features are no longer separated from the host contract for
convertible  instruments  with  conversion  features  that  are  not  required  to  be  accounted  for  as  derivatives  or  that  do  not  result  in  substantial  premiums
accounted for as paid-in capital. The update also amends the accounting for certain contracts in an entity’s own equity that are currently accounted for as
derivatives because of specific settlement provisions. In addition, the new guidance modifies how particular convertible instruments and certain contracts
that may be settled in cash or shares impact the computation of diluted earnings per share. The Company early adopted the guidance on a prospective basis
effective January 1, 2021. See section Computation of Net Income (Loss) per Share.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted by the Company

The  Company  reviewed  all  recently  issued,  but  not  yet  effective,  accounting  pronouncements  and  does  not  expect  the  future  adoption  of  any  such
pronouncements will have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

Revenue recognition

Revenue  is  recognized  upon  transfer  of  control  of  promised  products  or  services  to  customers  in  an  amount  that  reflects  the  consideration  to  which  the
Company expects to be entitled in exchange for promised goods or services. The Company’s performance obligations are satisfied either over time or at a
point  in  time.  Revenue  from  performance  obligations  that  are  transferred  to  customers  over  time  accounted  for  approximately  11%,  15%  and
13%, respectively, of the Company’s total revenue for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019.

The  Company  has  certain  system  sale  arrangements  that  contain  multiple  products  and  services.  For  these  bundled  sale  arrangements,  the  Company
accounts for individual products and services as separate performance obligations if they are distinct. The Company’s products and services are distinct if a
customer can benefit from the product or service on its own or with other resources that are readily available to the customer, and if the Company’s promise
to  transfer  the  products  or  service  to  the  customer  is  separately  identifiable  from  other  promises  in  the  sale  arrangements.  The  Company’s  system  sale
arrangements can include all or a combination of the following performance obligations: the system and software license (considered as one performance
obligation), system accessories (hand pieces), training, other accessories, extended service contracts, marketing services, and time and materials services.

For the Company’s system sale arrangements that include an extended service contract, the period of service commences at the expiration of the Company’s
standard warranty offered at the time of the system sale. The Company considers the extended service contracts terms in the arrangements that are legally
enforceable  to  be  performance  obligations.  Other  than  extended  service  contracts  and  marketing  services,  which  are  satisfied  over  time,  the  Company
generally  satisfies  all  performance  obligations  at  a  point  in  time.  Systems,  system  accessories  (hand  pieces),  service  contracts,  training,  and  time  and
materials  services  are  also  sold  on  a  stand-alone  basis,  and  these  performance  obligations  are  satisfied  at  a  point  in  time.  For  contracts  with  multiple
performance obligations, the Company allocates the transaction price of the contract to each performance obligation on a relative standalone selling price
basis.

Nature of Products and Services

Systems

Systems revenue is generated from the sale of systems and from the sale of upgrades to existing systems. A system consists of a console that incorporates a
universal graphic user interface, a laser or other energy-based module, control system software and high voltage electronics, as well as one or more hand
pieces.  In  certain  applications,  the  laser  or  other  energy-based  module  is  contained  in  the  hand  piece,  such  as  with  the  Company’s  Pearl  and  Pearl
Fractional applications, rather than within the console.

85

Table of Contents

The  Company  offers  customers  the  ability  to  select  the  system  that  best  fits  their  practice  at  the  time  of  purchase  and  then  to  cost-effectively  add
applications to their system as their practice grows. This provides customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems whenever they choose and provides the
Company with a source of additional Systems revenue.

The  system  or  upgrade  and  the  right  to  use  the  embedded  software  represent  a  single  performance  obligation  as  the  software  license  is  integral  to  the
functionality of the system or upgrade.

For systems sold directly to end-customers that are credit approved, revenue is recognized when the Company transfers control to the end-customer, which
occurs  when  the  product  is  shipped  to  the  customer  or  when  the  customer  receives  the  product,  depending  on  the  nature  of  the  arrangement.  When
collectability is not established in advance of receipt of payment from the customer, revenue is recognized upon the later of the receipt of payment or the
satisfaction  of  the  performance  obligation.  For  systems  sold  through  credit  approved  distributors,  revenue  is  recognized  at  the  time  of  shipment  to  the
distributor.

The  Company  typically  receives  payment  for  its  system  consoles  and  other  accessories  within  30  days  of  shipment.  Certain  international  distributor
arrangements allow for longer payment terms.

Skincare products

The Company sells third-party manufactured skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and sold to
medical offices and licensed physicians. The Company warrants that the skincare products are free of significant defects in workmanship and materials for
90 days from shipment. The Company acts as the principal in this arrangement, as the Company determines the price to charge customers for the skincare
products and controls the products before they are transferred to the customer. The Company recognizes revenue for skincare products at a point in time
upon shipment.

Consumables and other accessories

The Company classifies its customers' purchases of replacement cycles for truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex, as well as replacement hand pieces, Titan and
truSculpt 3D hand pieces, and single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, and Secret RF, as Consumable revenue, which provides the Company
with a source of recurring revenue from existing customers. The Secret RF products’ single use disposable tips must be replaced after every treatment. Sales
of  these  consumable  tips  further  enhance  the  Company’s  recurring  revenue.  The  Company’s  systems  offer  multiple  hand  pieces  and  applications,  which
allow customers to upgrade their systems.

Equipment leasing

The  Company  leases  equipment  to  customers  through  membership  programs  and  receives  a  fixed  monthly  fee  over  the  term  of  the  arrangement.  The
Company classifies its lease income as product revenue. The Company recognizes lease income over the term of the lease if the lease is classified as an
operating lease. For agreements that grant customers the right to purchase the leased system, the Company typically classifies the lease as a sales-type lease
as the Company has determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option. On the commencement of sales-type leases, the
Company recognizes revenue upfront in product revenue and the corresponding receivables recorded in Other current assets and prepaid expenses on the
consolidated balance sheets (Notes 1 and 11). Revenue from equipment leases was not material in the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Extended service contract

The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover parts and labor for a term of one, two, or three
years.  Service  contract  revenue  is  recognized  over  time,  using  a  time-based  measure  of  progress,  as  customers  benefit  from  the  service  throughout  the
service period. The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for systems and detachable hand piece replacements. Revenue related to
services performed on a time-and-materials basis is recognized when performed.

Training

Sales of systems to customers include training on the use of the system to be provided within 180 days of purchase. The Company considers training a
separate  performance  obligation  as  customers  can  immediately  benefit  from  the  training  together  with  the  customer’s  system.  Training  is  also  sold
separately  from  systems.  The  Company  recognizes  revenue  for  training  when  the  training  is  provided.  Training  is  not  required  for  customers  to  use  the
systems.

Significant Judgments

86

Table of Contents

The determination of whether two or more contracts entered into at or near the same time with the same customer should be combined and accounted for as
one contract may require the use of significant judgment. In making this determination, the Company considers whether the contracts are negotiated as a
package with a single commercial objective, have price interdependencies, or promise goods or services that represent a single performance obligation.

While the Company’s purchase agreements do not provide customers with a contractual right of return, the Company maintains a sales allowance to account
for potential returns or refunds as a reduction in transaction price at the time of sale.

The Company determines standalone selling price ("SSP") for each performance obligation as follows:

• Systems: The SSPs for systems are based on directly observable sales in similar circumstances to similar customers.
• Extended service contracts: SSP is based on observable price when sold on a standalone basis to similar customers.

Loyalty Program

The  Company  launched  a  customer  loyalty  program  during  the  third  quarter  of  2018  for  qualified  customers  located  in  the  U.S.  and  Canada.  Under  the
loyalty  program,  customers  accumulate  points  based  on  their  purchasing  levels  which  can  be  redeemed  for  such  rewards  as  the  right  to  attend  the
Company’s advanced training event for a product, or a ticket for the Company’s annual forum. A customer’s account must be in good standing to receive the
benefits of the rewards program. Rewards are earned on a quarterly basis and must be used in the following quarter. All unused rewards are forfeited. The
fair value of the reward earned by loyalty program members is included in accrued liabilities and recorded as a reduction. of net revenue at the time the
reward is earned. As of December 31, 2021, and December 31, 2020, the accrual for the loyalty program included in accrued liabilities was $0.5 million,
and $0.3 million, respectively.

Deferred Sales Commissions

Incremental costs of obtaining a contract, which consist primarily of commissions and related payroll taxes, are capitalized, and amortized on a straight-line
basis over the expected period of benefit, except for costs that are recognized when product is sold. The Company uses the portfolio method to recognize the
amortization expense related to these capitalized costs related to initial contracts and such expense is recognized over a period associated with the revenue
of the related portfolio, which is generally two to three years.

Total capitalized costs for the year ended December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020 were $4.2 million and $3.4 million, respectively, and are included in
Other  long-term  assets  in  the  Company’s  consolidated  balance  sheet.  Amortization  expenses  for  these  assets  were  $1.9  million,  $2.6  million  and  $2.9
million,  respectively,  during  the  years  ended  December  31,  2021,  2020  and  2019  and  were  included  in  sales  and  marketing  expense  in  the  Company’s
consolidated statement of operations.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

The Company invests its cash primarily in money market funds. All highly liquid investments with stated maturities of three months or less from date of
purchase are classified as cash equivalents; all highly liquid investments with stated maturities of greater than three months are classified as marketable
investments. The majority of the Company’s cash and investments are held in U.S. banks and the Company's foreign subsidiaries maintain a limited amount
of cash in their local banks to cover short term operating expenses.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

Fair value is an exit price representing the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in the principal or most advantageous
market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The fair value hierarchy contains three levels
of inputs that may be used to measure fair value, in accordance with ASC 820, as follows:

• Level 1: inputs, which include quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;
• Level 2: inputs, which include observable inputs other than Level 1 inputs, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities, quoted prices for identical
or  similar  assets  or  liabilities  in  markets  that  are  not  active,  or  other  inputs  that  are  observable  or  can  be  corroborated  by  observable  market  data  for
substantially  the  full  term  of  the  asset  or  liability.  For  available-for-sale  securities,  the  Company  reviews  trading  activity  and  pricing  as  of  the
measurement date. When sufficient quoted pricing for identical securities is not available, the Company uses market pricing and other observable market
inputs  for  similar  securities  obtained  from  various  third-party  data  providers.  These  inputs  either  represent  quoted  prices  for  similar  assets  in  active
markets or have been derived from observable market data; and

87

Table of Contents

• Level  3:  inputs,  which  include  unobservable  inputs  that  are  supported  by  little  or  no  market  activity  and  that  are  significant  to  the  fair  value  of  the
underlying asset or liability. Level 3 assets and liabilities include those whose fair value measurements are determined using pricing models, discounted
cash flow methodologies, or similar valuation techniques, as well as significant management judgment or estimation.

In  determining  fair  value,  the  Company  utilizes  valuation  techniques  that  maximize  the  use  of  observable  inputs  and  minimize  the  use  of  unobservable
inputs to the extent possible as well as considers counterparty credit risk in its assessment of fair value.

Allowance for Sales Returns and Credit Losses

The  allowance  for  sales  returns  is  based  on  the  Company’s  estimates  of  potential  future  product  returns  and  other  allowances  related  to  current  period
product  revenue.  The  Company  analyzes  historical  returns,  current  economic  trends  and  changes  in  customer  demand  and  acceptance  of  the  Company's
products.

The allowance for credit losses on trade receivables is based on the credit quality of clients, current economic conditions, the age of the accounts receivable
balances, historical loss information, and current conditions and forecasted information. The Company writes off amounts against the allowance when they
are deemed uncollectible.

Concentration of Credit Risk and Other Risks and Uncertainties

The  Company  operates  in  markets  that  are  highly  competitive  and  rapidly  changing.  Significant  technological  changes,  shifting  customer  needs,  the
emergence of competitive products or services with new capabilities and other factors could negatively impact the Company’s operating results.

The Company is also subject to risks related to changes in the value of the Company’s significant balance of financial instruments. Financial instruments
that potentially subject the Company to concentrations of risk consist principally of cash, cash equivalents, and accounts receivable. The Company’s cash
and  cash  equivalents  are  primarily  invested  in  deposits  and  money  market  accounts  with  three  major  financial  institutions  in  the  U.S.  In  addition,  the
Company has operating cash balances in banks in each of the international locations in which it operates. Deposits in these banks may exceed the federally
insured  limits  or  any  other  insurance  provided  on  such  deposits,  if  any.  Management  believes  that  these  financial  institutions  are  financially  sound  and,
accordingly, believes that minimal credit risk exists. To date, the Company has not experienced any losses on its deposits of cash and cash equivalents.

Accounts receivable are recorded net of an allowance for credit losses and are typically unsecured and are derived from revenue earned from worldwide
customers. The Company controls credit risk through credit approvals, credit limits, and monitoring procedures. The Company performs credit evaluations
of its customers and maintains an allowance for potential credit losses. As of December 31, 2021, and 2020, no customer represented more than 10% of the
Company’s net accounts receivable. During the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020, and 2019, domestic revenue accounted for 42%, 41% and 58%,
respectively, of total revenue, while international revenue accounted for 58%, 59% and 42%, respectively, of total revenue. No single customer represented
more than 10% of total revenue for any of the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019.

Supplier concentration

The Company relies on third parties for the supply of components of its products, as well as third-party logistics providers. In instances where these parties
fail  to  perform  their  obligations,  the  Company  may  be  unable  to  find  alternative  suppliers  or  satisfactorily  deliver  its  products  to  its  customers.  The
Company relies on one supplier for its Secret and Secret PRO products and one supplier for its skincare products.

Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value, cost being determined on a standard cost basis which approximates actual cost on a first-
in, first-out basis. Net realizable value is the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of the Company’s business, less reasonably predictable costs of
completion, disposal, and transportation. The cost basis of the Company’s inventory is reduced for any products that are considered excessive or obsolete
based upon assumptions about future demand and market conditions.

The Company includes demonstration units within inventories. Demonstration units are carried at cost and amortized over an estimated economic life of two
years.  Amortization  expense  related  to  demonstration  units  is  recorded  in  products  cost  of  revenue  or  in  the  respective  operating  expense  line  based  on
which function and purpose for which the demonstration units are being used. Proceeds from the sale of demonstration units are recorded as revenue and all
costs incurred to refurbish the

88

Table of Contents

systems  prior  to  sale  are  charged  to  product  cost  of  revenue.  As  of  December  31,  2021  and  2020,  demonstration  inventories,  net  of  accumulated
depreciation, included in finished goods inventory was $3.7 million and $3.6 million, respectively.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment are stated at cost, net of accumulated depreciation. Depreciation expense recognized is on a straight-line basis over the estimated
useful lives of the assets, generally as follows:

Leasehold improvements
Equipment leasing
Office equipment and furniture
Machinery and equipment

Useful Lives
Lesser of useful life or term of lease
4.5
3
3

Upon sale or retirement of property and equipment, the costs and related accumulated depreciation and amortization are removed from the balance sheet and
the resulting gain or loss is reflected in operating expenses. Maintenance and repairs are charged to operations as incurred.

Depreciation  expense  related  to  property  and  equipment  for  2021,  2020  and  2019,  was  $1.3  million,  $1.4  million,  and  $1.5  million,  respectively.
Amortization  expense  for  vehicles  leased  under  capital  leases  is  included  in  depreciation  expense.  Amortization  expense  related  to  equipment  leasing
accounted for as sales type is included in cost of revenue and was immaterial as of December 31, 2021 and 2020.

Capitalized Cloud Computing Set-up Cost

The Company capitalizes certain set-up costs for the Company’s cloud computing arrangements. The capitalized implementation costs are then amortized
over the term of the cloud computing arrangement inclusive of expected contract renewals, which are generally three years to ten years. As of December 31,
2021, the Company had capitalized cloud computing set-up costs with a carrying amount of $0.4 million in Other current assets and prepaid expenses and
$3.5  million  in  Other  long-term  assets.  As  of  and  during  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021  there  was  no  accumulated  amortization  and  amortization
expense  recorded.  The  Company  periodically  assesses  the  capitalized  asset  for  impairment  and,  when  required,  will  record  an  associated  impairment
loss.  During  the  year  ended  December  31,  2021,  the  Company  recognized  in  general  and  administrative  expense  an  impairment  loss  of  $0.2  million  for
capitalized cloud computing costs related to a cloud-based enterprise resource planning software.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortized but are tested for impairment at least annually during the fourth quarter of the
Company’s fiscal year, or if circumstances indicate their value may no longer be recoverable. Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the
fair value of net identifiable assets and liabilities.

The Company continues to operate in one segment, which is considered to be the sole reporting unit and, therefore, goodwill was tested for impairment at
the enterprise level. As of December 31, 2021, there has been no impairment of goodwill. All acquired intangible assets have been fully amortized as of
December 31, 2021.

Warranty Obligations

The Company provides a 12-month warranty for direct sales to customers. For sales to distributors, the Company generally provides a 14-month warranty
for parts only, with labor being provided to the end customer by the distributor.

After the original warranty period, maintenance and support are offered on an extended service contract basis or on a time and materials basis.

Leases

Effective January 1, 2019, the Company adopted ASC 842, which established a right-of-use ("ROU") model requiring lessees to record a right-of-use asset
("ROU asset") and lease obligations on the balance sheet for all leases with terms longer than 12 months. The Company determines if an arrangement is a
lease  at  inception.  Where  an  arrangement  is  a  lease  the  Company  determines  if  it  is  an  operating  lease  or  a  finance  lease.  At  lease  commencement,  the
Company records a lease liability and corresponding ROU asset. Lease liabilities represent the present value of the Company’s future lease payments over
the

89

Table of Contents

expected lease term which includes options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain those options will be exercised. The present value
of the Company’s lease liability is determined using its incremental collateralized borrowing rate at lease inception. ROU assets represent its right to control
the use of the leased asset during the lease and are recognized in an amount equal to the lease liability for leases with an initial term greater than 12 months.
Over the lease term (operating leases only), the Company uses the effective interest rate method to account for the lease liability as lease payments are made
and the ROU asset is amortized to consolidated statement of operations in a manner that results in straight-line expense recognition. The Company does not
apply  lease  recognition  requirements  for  short-term  leases.  Instead,  the  Company  recognizes  payments  related  to  these  arrangements  in  the  consolidated
statement of operations as lease costs on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Accounting for Leases as a Lessor

The  Company  leases  equipment  to  customers  through  membership  programs  and  receives  a  fixed  monthly  fee  over  the  term  of  the  arrangement.  The
Company classifies its lease income as product revenue. The Company recognizes lease income over the term of the lease if the lease is classified as an
operating lease. For agreements that grant customers the right to purchase the leased system, the Company typically classifies the lease as a sales-type lease
as the Company has determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option. On the commencement of sales-type leases, the
Company recognizes revenue upfront in product revenue and the corresponding receivables is classified in Other current assets and prepaid expenses on the
condensed consolidated balance sheets.

See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for more information regarding leasing arrangements.

Cost of Revenue

Cost  of  revenue  consists  primarily  of  material,  finished  and  semi-finished  products  purchased  from  third-party  manufacturers,  labor,  stock-based
compensation  expenses,  overhead  involved  in  the  Company's  internal  manufacturing  processes,  service  contracts,  technology  license  amortization  and
royalties, costs associated with equipment leasing, costs associated with product warranties and any inventory write-downs.

The Company's system sales include a control console, universal graphic user interface, control system software, high voltage electronics and a combination
of applications (referred to as “hand pieces”). Hand pieces are programmed to have a limited number of uses to ensure the safety of the device to patients.
The Company sells refurbished hand pieces, or "refills," of its Titan and truSculpt 3D  products  and  provides  for  the  cost  of  refurbishment  of  these  hand
pieces as part of cost of revenue. When customers purchase a replacement hand piece or are provided a replacement hand piece under a warranty or service
contract,  the  Company  ships  the  customer  a  previously  refurbished  unit.  Upon  the  receipt  of  the  expended  hand  piece  from  the  customer,  the  Company
capitalizes the expended hand piece as inventory at the estimated fair value. Cost of service revenue includes the costs incurred to refurbish hand pieces.

Research and Development Expenditures

Research and development costs are expensed as incurred and include costs related to research, design, development, testing of products, salaries, benefits
and other headcount related costs, facilities, material, third party contractors, regulatory affairs, clinical and development costs.

Advertising Costs

Advertising costs are included as part of sales and marketing expense and are expensed as incurred. Advertising expenses for 2021, 2020 and 2019 were
$2.1 million, $1.2 million and $2.8 million, respectively.

Stock-based Compensation

The Company accounts for share-based employee compensation plans using the fair value recognition and measurement provisions under U.S. GAAP. The
Company’s share-based compensation cost is measured at the grant date, based on the fair value of the award, and is recognized as expense on a straight-
line basis over the requisite service period.

Expected Term: The expected term represents the weighted-average period that the stock options are expected to be outstanding prior to being exercised.
The Company determines expected term based on historical exercise patterns and its expectation of the time it will take for employees to exercise options
still outstanding.

Expected Volatility:  For  the  underlying  stock  price  volatility  of  the  Company’s  stock,  the  Company  estimates  volatility  solely  based  on  the  Company’s
historical volatility of its stock price.

90

Table of Contents

Forfeitures:  The  amount  of  stock-based  compensation  recognized  during  a  period  is  based  on  the  value  of  the  portion  of  the  awards  that  are  ultimately
expected  to  vest.  Under  ASC  718,  the  Company  has  made  an  accounting  policy  to  estimate  forfeitures  at  the  time  awards  are  granted  and  revises,  if
necessary, in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from those estimates.

Risk-Free Interest Rate: The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant for the expected term of the stock
option.

The fair value of stock options ("options") on the grant date using the closing price of the Company's common shares on the grant date is estimated using
the Black-Scholes option-pricing model using the single-option approach. The Black-Scholes option pricing model requires the use of highly subjective and
complex  assumptions,  including  the  option's  expected  term  and  the  price  volatility  of  the  underlying  stock,  to  determine  the  fair  value  of  award.  The
Company recognizes the expense associated with options using a single award approach over the requisite service period. The Company accounts for all
stock options awarded to non-employees at the fair value of the award issued on the day of the grant.

The fair value of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) granted are measured on the grant date. The quantity of the RSUs units granted is calculated by dividing a
fixed award amount determined by the Board on the grant date by the average closing price of the Company’s common stock over the 50-day period ending
on the day of the grant.

The fair value of Performance Stock Units (“PSUs”) that have operational measurement goals are measured on the grant date using the closing price of the
Company’s common shares on the grant date. The quantity of the PSUs granted is calculated by dividing a fixed award amount determined by the Board on
the grant date by the average closing price of the Company’s common stock over the 50-day period ending on the day of the grant.

See Note 6 - "Stockholders’ Equity, Stock Plans and Stock-Based Compensation Expense" for a detailed discussion of the Company’s stock plans and share-
based compensation expense.

Income Taxes

The  Company  is  subject  to  income  taxes  in  the  United  States  and  several  foreign  jurisdictions.  Significant  judgment  is  required  in  determining  the
Company’s  provision  (benefit)  for  income  taxes  and  income  tax  assets  and  liabilities,  including  evaluating  uncertainties  in  the  application  of  accounting
principles and complex tax laws.

The Company records a provision (benefit) for income taxes for the anticipated tax consequences of the reported results of operations using the asset and
liability  method.  Under  this  method,  the  Company  recognizes  deferred  income  tax  assets  and  liabilities  for  the  expected  future  tax  consequences  of
temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities, as well as for loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax
assets and liabilities are measured using the tax rates that are expected to apply to taxable income for the years in which those tax assets and liabilities are
expected  to  be  realized  or  settled.  The  Company  recognizes  the  deferred  income  tax  effects  of  a  change  in  tax  rates  in  the  period  of  enactment.  The
Company records a valuation allowance to reduce the Company’s deferred tax assets to the net amount that the Company believes is more likely than not to
be realized.

The  Company  recognizes  tax  benefits  from  uncertain  tax  positions  if  the  Company  believes  that  it  is  more  likely  than  not  that  the  tax  position  will  be
sustained  upon  examination  by  the  taxing  authorities  based  on  the  technical  merits  of  the  position.  Although  the  Company  believes  it  has  adequately
reserved for the Company’s uncertain tax positions (including net interest and penalties), the Company can provide no assurance that the final tax outcome
of these matters will not be different. The Company makes adjustments to these reserves in accordance with income tax accounting guidance when facts and
circumstances change, such as the closing of a tax audit. To the extent that the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts recorded,
such differences may impact the provision (benefit) for income taxes in the period in which such determination is made. The Company records interest and
penalties related to the Company’s uncertain tax positions in the Company’s provision (benefit) for income taxes.

The Company’s effective tax rates have differed from the statutory rate primarily due to changes in the valuation allowance, foreign operations, research and
development tax credits, state taxes, and certain benefits realized related to stock option activity. The Company’s current effective tax rate does not assume
U.S. taxes on undistributed profits of foreign subsidiaries. These earnings could become subject to incremental foreign withholding or U.S. federal and state
taxes, should they either be deemed or actually remitted to the U.S. The Company’s future effective tax rates could be adversely affected by earnings being
lower in countries where the Company has lower statutory rates and being higher in countries where the Company has higher statutory rates, or by changes
in  tax  laws,  accounting  principles,  interpretations  thereof,  net  operating  loss  carryback,  research  and  development  tax  credits,  and  due  to  changes  in  the
valuation allowance of its U.S. deferred tax assets. In addition, the

91

Table of Contents

Company  is  subject  to  the  examination  of  the  Company’s  income  tax  returns  by  the  Internal  Revenue  Service  and  other  tax  authorities.  The  Company
regularly assesses the likelihood of adverse outcomes resulting from these examinations to determine the adequacy of the Company’s provision for income
taxes.

Undistributed  earnings  of  the  Company’s  foreign  subsidiaries  at  December  31,  2021  are  considered  to  be  indefinitely  reinvested  and,  accordingly,  no
provision for state income taxes has been provided thereon. Due to the Transition Tax and Global Intangible Low-Tax Income (“GILTI”) regimes as enacted
by the 2017 Tax Act, those foreign earnings will not be subject to federal income taxes when actually distributed in the form of a dividend or otherwise. The
Company, however, could still be subject to state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to various foreign countries. The amounts of taxes which the
Company could be subject to are not material to the accompanying financial statements.

On  March  27,  2020,  the  U.S.  federal  government  enacted  the  Coronavirus  Aid,  Relief,  and  Economic  Security  Act  (“CARES  Act”).  The  CARES  Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies to
carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. The CARES Act did not
have  a  material  impact  on  the  Company's  income  tax  provision,  deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities,  and  related  taxes  payable.  The  Company  is  currently
assessing the future implications of these provisions within the CARES Act on the Company's consolidated financial statements but does not expect the
impact to be material.

Computation of Net Income (Loss) per Share

Basic net income (loss) per share is computed by dividing net income (loss) by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the
period. Diluted net income per share is computed based on the weighted average number of shares of common stock plus the effect of dilutive potential
common  shares  outstanding  during  the  period  using  the  treasury  stock  method  and  the  if-converted  method.  Dilutive  potential  common  shares  include
outstanding  stock  options,  restricted  stock  units,  performance  stock  units,  employee  stock  purchase  plan  (ESPP)  shares  and  conversion  shares  under  the
convertible notes. On January 1, 2021, the Company adopted the accounting standard update to simplify the accounting for convertible debt instruments.
The Company now uses the if-converted method for its convertible notes in calculating the diluted net income (loss) per share, and includes the effect of
potential  share  settlement  for  the  convertible  notes,  if  the  effect  is  dilutive.  The  diluted  net  income  per  share  is  computed  with  the  assumption  that  the
Company will settle the convertible debt in shares, rather than cash.

Diluted earnings per share is the same as basic earnings per share for the periods in which the Company had a net loss because the inclusion of outstanding
common stock equivalents would be anti-dilutive.

Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Comprehensive income (loss) includes all changes in stockholders’ equity except those resulting from investments or contributions by stockholders. For the
periods presented, the accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) consisted solely of the unrealized gains or losses on the Company's available-for-
sale investments, net of tax.

Foreign Currency

The financial statements of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries are translated in accordance with ASC 830, Foreign Currency Matters. The U.S. Dollar is
the  functional  currency  of  the  Company’s  subsidiaries  and  the  Company’s  reporting  currency.  Monetary  assets  and  liabilities  are  re-measured  into  U.S.
Dollars at the applicable period end exchange rate. Sales and operating expenses are re-measured at average exchange rates in effect during each period.
Gains or losses resulting from foreign currency transactions are included in net income (loss) are $1.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2021 and
were insignificant for each of the two years ended December 31, 2020. The effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents was insignificant
for each of the three years ended December 31, 2021.

Segments

The  Company  operates  in  one  segment  and  reports  segment  information  in  accordance  with  ASC  280,  Segment  Reporting.  Management  uses  one
measurement of profitability and does not segregate its business for internal reporting. As of December 31, 2021 and 2020, 99.0% and 98.0% of long-lived
assets  were  in  the  United  States,  respectively.  Revenue  is  attributed  to  a  geographic  region  based  on  the  location  of  the  end  customer.  See  Note  10  –
"Segment Information and Revenue by Geography and Products" for details relating to revenue by geography.

92

Table of Contents

NOTE 2-CASH, CASH EQUIVALENTS AND RESTRICTED CASH

The following tables summarize cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities (in thousands):

Cash and cash equivalents
Non-current restricted cash

Cash equivalents and restricted cash as reported within the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

December 31,

2021

2020

$

$

164,164  $
700 
164,864  $

47,047 
— 
47,047 

The Company had no marketable securities as of December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020. The cash is restricted to support an outstanding letter of credit
for $0.7 million provided to a supplier.

NOTE 3—BALANCE SHEET DETAIL

Inventories

Valuation adjustments for excess and obsolete inventory, reflected as a reduction of inventory at December 31, 2021 and 2020, were $4.9 million and $3.9
million, respectively. Inventories, net of these adjustments, consist of the following (in thousands):

Raw materials
Work in process
Finished goods

Total

Property and Equipment, net

Property and equipment, net, consists of the following (in thousands):

Leasehold improvements
Equipment leasing
Office equipment and furniture
Machinery and equipment

Less: Accumulated depreciation

Property and equipment, net

December 31,

2021

2020

24,035  $
2,124 
13,344 
39,503  $

14,874 
1,030 
12,604 
28,508 

December 31,

2021

2020

826  $
107 
1,527 
3,983 
6,443 
(3,424)
3,019  $

1,051 
186 
3,407 
7,683 
12,327 
(10,028)
2,299 

$

$

$

$

Included  in  machinery  and  equipment  are  financed  vehicles  used  by  the  Company’s  sales  employees.  As  of  December  31,  2021  and  2020,  the  gross
capitalized value of the leased vehicles was $2.6 million and $1.8 million, respectively, and the related accumulated depreciation was $1.5 million and $1.4
million at December 31, 2021 and 2020, respectively. Included in Property and equipment as of December 31, 2021 and 2020 is construction in progress of
$0.8 million and $0.4 million, respectively, which is yet to be depreciated.

Goodwill

Goodwill  is  related  to  the  acquisition  of  Iridex’s  aesthetic  business  unit,  and  customer  relationships  in  the  Benelux  countries  acquired  from  a  former
distributor in 2013. Goodwill was $1.3 million as of December 31, 2021 and 2020. There were no impairments or additions to goodwill during the years
ended December 31, 2021 or 2020.

93

Table of Contents

Accrued Liabilities

Accrued liabilities consist of the following (in thousands):

Bonus and payroll-related accruals
Sales and marketing accruals
Accrued inventory in transit
Product warranty
Accrued sales tax
Other accrued liabilities

Total

NOTE 4— PRODUCT WARRANTY

December 31,

2021

2020

21,649  $
4,808 
4,265 
3,947 
9,110 
10,321 
54,100  $

12,197 
2,352 
2,476 
4,124 
5,343 
5,803 
32,295 

$

$

The Company has a direct field service organization in North America (including Canada). Internationally, the Company provides direct service support in
Australia,  Austria,  Belgium,  France,  Germany,  Hong  Kong,  Japan,  the  Netherlands,  and  Switzerland,  as  well  as  through  third-party  service  providers  in
Spain and the United Kingdom. In several other countries, where the Company does not have a direct presence, the Company provides service through a
network of distributors and third-party service providers.

After  the  original  warranty  period,  maintenance  and  support  are  offered  on  an  extended  service  contract  basis  or  on  a  time  and  materials  basis.  The
Company provides the estimated cost to repair or replace products under standard warranty at the time of sale. Costs in connection with extended service
contracts are recognized at the time when costs are incurred. The following table provides the changes in the product standard warranty accrual for the years
ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 (in thousands):

Balance at beginning of year
Add: Accruals for warranties issued during the period
Less: Settlements made during the period

Balance at end of year

NOTE 5—DEFERRED REVENUE

December 31,

2021

2020

$

$

4,124  $
5,135 
(5,312)
3,947  $

6,400 
4,475 
(6,751)
4,124 

The Company records deferred revenue when revenue is to be recognized subsequent to invoicing. For extended service contracts, the Company generally
invoices customers at the beginning of the extended service contract term. The Company’s extended service contracts typically have one to three-year terms.
Deferred revenue also includes payments for training. Approximately 86% of the Company’s deferred revenue balance of $10.8 million as of December 31,
2021, will be recognized over the next 12 months.

The following table provides changes in the deferred contract revenue balance for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 (in thousands):

Balance at beginning of year
Add: Payments received
Less: Revenue recognized from current period sales
Less: Revenue recognized from beginning balance

Balance at end of year

December 31,

2021

2020

$

$

11,237  $
17,139 
(7,006)
(10,545)
10,825  $

14,222 
14,131 
(6,337)
(10,779)
11,237 

Costs for extended service contracts were $8.3 million, $8.2 million and $9.3 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019.

94

Table of Contents

NOTE 6—STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY, STOCK PLANS AND STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION EXPENSE

As of December 31, 2021, the Company had one class of issued common stock with a par value of $0.001. Authorized capital stock consists of 55,000,000
shares comprised of two classes: (i) 50,000,000 shares of Common Stock, of which 17,995,344 shares are issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2021,
and (ii) 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.001 per share (“Preferred Stock”), of which no shares are issued and outstanding.

Issuances of Common Stock

On April 21, 2020, the Company issued and sold an aggregate of 2,742,750 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.001 per share at a price to
the public of $10.50 per share. The shares include the full exercise of the underwriter’s option to purchase an additional 357,750 shares of common stock.
The Company received net proceeds from the offering of approximately $26.5 million, after deducting underwriting discounts, commissions and offering
expenses of $2.3 million.

As of December 31, 2021, the Company had the following stock-based employee compensation plans:

2004 Equity Incentive Plan

In  1998,  the  Company  adopted  the  1998  Stock  Plan,  or  1998  Plan,  under  which  4,650,000  shares  of  the  Company’s  common  stock  were  reserved  for
issuance to employees, directors and consultants.

On January 12, 2004, the Board of Directors (“the Board”) adopted the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. A total of 1,750,000 shares of common stock were
originally reserved for issuance pursuant to the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. In addition, the shares reserved for issuance under the 2004 Equity Incentive
Plan  included  shares  reserved  but  un-issued  under  the  1998  Plan  and  shares  returned  to  the  1998  Plan  as  the  result  of  termination  of  options  or  the
repurchase of shares. In 2012 the stockholders approved a “fungible share” provision whereby each full-value award issued under the 2004 Equity Incentive
Plan results in a requirement to subtract 2.12 shares from the shares reserved under the Plan.

2019 Equity Incentive Plan

At the Company’s Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 14, 2019, the Company’s stockholders approved the 2019 Equity Incentive Plan, which is an
amendment and restatement of the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. The 2004 Equity Incentive Plan was amended to: (i) increase the number of shares available
for  future  grant  by  700,000  (in  addition  to  the  9,701,192  shares  provided  under  the  2004  Equity  Incentive  Plan;  (ii)  extend  the  term  of  the  2004  Equity
Incentive  Plan  to  the  date  of  the  Annual  Meeting  of  the  Company’s  stockholders  in  2029;  (iii)  amend  the  2004  Equity  Incentive  Plan  to  eliminate  the
requirement for awards granted on or after June 14, 2019 that any shares subject to awards with an exercise price less than fair market value on the date of
such grant will be counted against the Plan as 2.12 shares for each full value share awarded in accordance with the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan; (iv) amend
the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to remove the requirement that any shares subject to awards with an exercise price less than fair market value on the date of
such grant will be counted against the Plan as 2.12 shares for each full value share awarded; (v) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to remove certain
provisions  relating  to  the  “performance  based  compensation”  exception  under  Section  162(m)  of  the  Internal  Revenue  Code  of  1986,  as  amended;  (vi)
include a minimum one-year vesting period with respect to awards granted under the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan.

On June 11, 2019, the Board also approved, amended and restated the Company’s Stock Ownership Guidelines adopted on July 28, 2017 in their entirety, to
require all officers (as defined by Rule 16a-1(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) to hold at least 50% of any shares received pursuant to
stock options, stock appreciation rights, vested restricted stock awards (“RSAs”), restricted stock units (“RSUs”), or performance stock units (“PSUs”) (net
of taxes) for a minimum of one year following vesting and delivery.

On June 11, 2019, the Board also adopted a clawback policy to permit recovery of certain compensation paid to Named Executive Officers (as defined in
Item 402 of Regulation S-K) of the Company if the Compensation Committee of the Board determines that a Named Executive Officer (i) has violated law,
the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, or any significant ethics or compliance policies, and (ii) such conduct results in material financial or
reputational harm, or results in a need for a restatement of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The Amended and Restated Plan provides for
the grant of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, RSUs, stock appreciation rights, PSUs, and other stock or cash awards.

In June 2020, stockholders approved an amendment and restatement of the 2019 Equity Incentive Plan (the “Prior Plan”) as the Amended and Restated 2019
Equity Incentive Plan (the “Restated Plan”) and approved an additional 600,000 shares, available for future grants. The Restated Plan provides for the grant
of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, RSUs, stock appreciation rights, PSUs, and other stock or cash awards.

95

Table of Contents

The Company’s non-employee directors are granted $60,000 of RSUs annually on the date of the Company’s Annual Meeting of stockholders. These RSUs
cliff-vest on the one-year anniversary of the grant date. In the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019, the Company issued 41,301, 35,735 and
42,236 RSUs, respectively, to its non-employee directors.

In the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019, the Company’s Board of Directors granted 219,686, 405,248 and 475,166 RSUs, respectively, to its
executive officers, directors and certain members of the Company’s management related to annual grants and new hire grants. The annual grant RSUs vest
quarterly on each of the first four anniversaries of the vest date and the new hire RSUs vest one quarter on the first anniversary and monthly thereafter for
36  months.  The  Company  measured  the  fair  market  values  of  the  underlying  stock  on  the  dates  of  grant  and  recognizes  the  stock-based  compensation
expense over the vesting period. On the vesting date, the Company issues common stock, net of stock withheld to settle the recipient’s minimum statutory
tax liability. In addition to the 2020 annual RSU grants, on April 1, 2020, the Company issued RSUs to settle bonuses owed to management under the 2019
Management Bonus Program. In the past, the Company has paid these bonuses with cash. However, due to the economic conditions resulting from COVID-
19,  fully  vested  shares  were  issued  in  lieu  of  cash.  The  Company  issued  209,981  shares  related  to  this  bonus  payment  to  management  and  recognized
$2.6 million in stock-based compensation expense. The Company also recorded an equivalent reduction in bonus expense as a result of the settlement of the
bonus in shares.

In  the  years  ended  December  31,  2021,  2020  and  2019  the  Company’s  Board  of  Directors  granted  its  executive  officers  and  certain  senior  management
employees 178,222, 76,157, and 319,275 PSUs, respectively, related to its annual grants. The 2019 and 2020 grants vested on the first anniversary subject to
the achievement of pre-established performance goals. The 2021 grant quantity vested one half on the first anniversary subject to the achievement of pre-
established performance goals and the remaining half vested on the second anniversary subject to the recipient’s continued service. In addition to the 2021
annual PSU grants, in July 2021, the Company granted 265,002 PSUs to certain employees. This grant consists of four separate vesting tranches that will
vest from April 2023 through June 2024 upon the achievement of operational milestones associated with each tranche and continued service.

In July 2019, the Board awarded its new CEO, David H. Mowry, 67,897 PSUs, which are scheduled to vest over four years from 2019 through 2022. These
PSUs are subject to certain performance-based criteria related to achieving financial metrics in the Board approved annual budgets.

In August 2020, the Board awarded its new CFO, Rohan Seth, 60,000 stock options, which vests over five years, and 22,423 PSUs, which vests over 2.5
years and is subject to performance-based criteria relating to the achievement of certain department and financial goals.

On January 12, 2004, the Board of Directors adopted the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Under the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, or 2004
ESPP, eligible employees are permitted to purchase common stock at a discount through payroll deductions. The 2004 ESPP offering and purchase periods
are for six months. The 2004 ESPP has an evergreen provision based on which shares of common stock eligible for purchase are increased on the first day
of each fiscal year by an amount equal to the lesser of:

•
•
•

600,000 shares;
2.0% of the outstanding shares of common stock on such date; or
an amount as determined by the Board of Directors.

The  price  of  the  common  stock  purchased  is  the  lower  of  85%  of  the  fair  market  value  of  the  common  stock  at  the  beginning  or  end  of  the  six-month
offering  period.  In  the  years  ended  December  31,  2021,  2020,  and  2019,  under  the  2004  ESPP,  the  Company  issued  59,635,  56,751,  and  82,810  shares,
respectively. At December 31, 2021, 645,319 shares remained available for future issuance.

96

Table of Contents

Option and Award Activity

Activity under the 2004 Plan and 2019 Equity Incentive Plan is summarized as follows:

Shares
Available
For Grant

Number of
Shares

Options Outstanding

Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price

Weighted-Average
Remaining
Contractual Life
(in years)

Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(in millions ) 

(1)

(2)

Balances as of December 31, 2018
Additional shares reserved
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)

(2)

Balances as of December 31, 2019
Additional shares reserved
Options granted
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)

(2)

Balances as of December 31, 2020
Additional shares reserved
Options granted
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)

Balances as of December 31, 2021
Exercisable as of December 31, 2021
Vested and expected to vest as of December
31, 2021

1,141,305 

700,000 
— 
51,208 
(1,538,128)
407,320 
761,705 

600,000 
(71,088)
— 
76,553 
(804,949)
522,949 
1,085,170 

450,000 
(172,139)
— 
30,173 
(744,949)
299,092 
947,347 

507,705  $

20.52 

3.52 $

2.00 

(160,798) $
(51,208) $
— 
— 
295,699  $

71,088  $
(73,227) $
(76,553) $
— 
— 
217,007  $

172,139  $
(71,798) $
(30,173) $
— 
— 
287,175  $
83,855  $

10.03 
24.61 
— 
— 

25.52 

14.85 
12.91 
36.65 
— 
— 

22.35 

30.71 
22.02 
37.14 
— 
— 

25.89 
24.14 

287,175  $

25.89 

3.19 $

3.04 

3.75 $

1.47 

4.92 $
2.86 $

4.92 $

4.46 
1.47 

4.46 

(1) Based on the closing stock price of $41.32 of the Company’s stock on December 31, 2021, $24.11 on December 31, 2020, $35.81 on December 31,

2019 and $17.02 on December 31, 2018.

(2) Approved by the board of directors and stockholders in 2021, 2020 and 2019.

97

Table of Contents

The aggregate intrinsic value in the table above represents the total pre-tax intrinsic value and is the aggregate difference between the Company’s closing
stock  price  on  the  last  trading  day  of  the  fiscal  year  and  the  exercise  price,  multiplied  by  the  number  of  in-the-money  options.  The  aggregate  intrinsic
amount changes based on the fair market value of the Company’s common stock. Total intrinsic value of options exercised in 2021, 2020 and 2019 was $1.3
million, $0.4 million, and $1.0 million, respectively. The options outstanding and exercisable at December 31, 2021 were in the following exercise price
ranges:

Exercise Prices
—
$14.10
$15.32
$18.55
$18.93
$25.70
$29.28
$32.87
$39.30
$47.40
—

$10.79 

$10.79 

Number Outstanding

Contractual Life
(in years)

Number
Exercisable

$14.04 

$47.40 

25,480 
60,000 
2,396 
1,000 
11,088 
6,000 
93,844 
57,622 
25,000 
4,745 
287,175 

1.97
3.59
0.56
2.07
8.83
2.59
6.32
6.12
2.83
2.96
4.92

25,480 
16,000 
2,396 
1,000 
3,234 
6,000 
— 
— 
25,000 
4,745 
83,855 

Stock Awards (RSU and PSU) Activity Table

Information with respect to RSUs and PSUs activity is as follows (in thousands):

Outstanding at December 31, 2018
Granted
(3)
Vested
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2019
Granted
(3)
Vested
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2020
Granted
(3)
Vested
Forfeited

Outstanding at December 31, 2021

Number of
Shares

Weighted-
Average
Grant-
Date Fair
Value

Aggregate
(1)
Fair Value
(in thousands)

Aggregate
(2)
Intrinsic Value
(in thousands)

474,291  $
963,814  $
(172,281) $
(161,022) $
1,104,802  $
667,694  $
(684,491) $
(308,248) $
779,757  $
744,949  $
(254,946) $
(236,856) $
1,032,904  $

38.44 
18.68 
33.66  $
37.91 
22.10 
20.66 
17.82  $
23.24 
23.96 
40.16 
22.94  $
27.33 

35.00 

6,169 

(4)

12,036 

(5)

8,287 

(6)

$

$

$

$

8,072 

37,442 

18,800 

42,680 

(1) Represents the value of the Company’s stock on the date that the restricted stock units and performance stock units vest.
(2) Based on the closing stock price of the Company’s stock of $41.32 on December 31, 2021, $24.11 on December 31, 2020, $35.81 on December 31,

2019, and $17.02 on December 31, 2018.

(3) The number of restricted stock units vested includes shares that the Company withheld on behalf of the employees to satisfy the statutory tax

withholding requirements.

(4) On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $5.9 million.
(5) On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $12.2 million.
(6) On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $5.8 million.

98

Table of Contents

Stock-Based Compensation

Stock-based compensation expense for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 was as follows (in thousands):

Stock options
RSUs
PSUs
ESPP

Total stock-based compensation expense

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

$

$

782  $

5,305 
6,591 
494 
13,172  $

370  $

8,849 
666 
224 
10,109  $

622 
4,786 
3,948 
476 
9,832 

Total stock-based compensation expense recognized during the year ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 was recorded in the Consolidated Statement
of Operations as follows (in thousands):

Cost of revenue
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative

Total stock-based compensation expense

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

$

$

1,408  $
3,160 
2,784 
5,820 
13,172  $

1,665  $
3,385 
1,669 
3,390 
10,109  $

1,572 
4,510 
1,536 
2,214 
9,832 

Valuation Assumptions and Fair Value of Stock Options and ESPP Grants

The Company uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of options granted under its equity incentive plans and rights to acquire
stock granted under its employee stock purchase plan. The weighted average estimated fair values of the employee stock options and rights granted under
the employee stock purchase plan and the weighted average assumptions used to calculate the grant date fair values, are as follows:

(1)

Expected term (in years)
(2)
Risk-free interest rate
(3)
Volatility
Dividend yield

(4)

2021

Stock Options
2020

2019

Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP)
2020

2019

2021

3.97
0.48 %
66 %
— %

4.84
0.15 %
63 %
— %

3.65
1.64 %
54 %
— %

0.50
0.14 %
36 %
— %

0.50
0.11 %
76 %
— %

0.50
2.49 %
70 %
— %

Weighted average estimated
fair value at grant date

$

15.09 

$

7.63 

$

14.83 

$

9.64 

$

6.13 

$

9.60 

(1) The expected term represents the period during which the Company’s stock-based awards are expected to be outstanding. The estimated term is based
on historical experience of similar awards, giving consideration to the contractual terms of the awards, vesting requirements and expectation of future
employee behavior, including post-vesting terminations. The expected term of groups of employees that have similar historical exercise patterns has
been considered separately for valuation purposes.

(2) The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury debt securities with maturities close to the expected term of the option or ESPP participation right

as of the date of grant.

(3) Estimated volatility is based on historical volatility. The Company estimates volatility based on the Company’s historical volatility of its stock price. 
(4) The Company has not paid dividends since its inception.

99

Table of Contents

NOTE 7—INCOME TAXES

The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal and various state and local jurisdictions and foreign jurisdictions. The Company’s income (loss)
before provision for income taxes consisted of the following (in thousands):

U.S.
Foreign

Income (loss) before income taxes

The components of the provision for income taxes are as follows (in thousands):

Current:

Federal
State
Foreign

Total Current

Deferred:

Federal
State
Foreign
Total Deferred

Tax provision

The Company’s net deferred tax assets consist of the following (in thousands):

Net operating loss carryforwards
Stock-based compensation
Other accruals and reserves
Credits
Accrued warranty
Depreciation and amortization
Other
Operating lease liability

Deferred tax asset before valuation allowance

Valuation allowance

Deferred tax asset after valuation allowance

Deferred contract acquisition costs
Goodwill
Right of use asset

Net deferred tax asset (liability)

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

(356) $
3,741 
3,385  $

(25,793) $
2,386 
(23,407) $

(13,037)
774 
(12,263)

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

—  $
(87)
1,512 
1,425 

2 
1 
(105)
(102)
1,323  $

—  $
(53)
747 
694 

2 
1 
(227)
(224)
470  $

— 
101 
(76)
25 

2 
1 
57 
60 
85 

$

$

$

$

December 31,

2021

2020

$

$

18,274  $
3,160 
2,863 
13,634 
939 
2,226 
977 
3,784 
45,857 
(40,485)
5,372 
(990)
(124)
(3,480)

778  $

18,270 
869 
3,670 
12,653 
976 
2,191 
979 
4,311 
43,919 
(38,321)
5,598 
(803)
(110)
(4,042)
643 

The differences between the U.S. federal statutory income tax rates to the Company’s effective tax rate are as follows:

100

Table of Contents

U.S. federal statutory income tax rate
State tax rate
Meals and entertainment
Permanent differences
Stock-based compensation
Extinguishment of PPP loan
Excess compensation
Foreign rate differential
Other
General business credit
Valuation allowance
Change in prior year reserves
Deferred true-up
Effective tax rate

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

21.00 %
(2.55)
9.28 
1.11 
(13.08)
(44.59)
7.88 
17.03 
(0.08)
(17.95)
72.82 
— 
(11.76)
39.11 %

21.00 %
2.77 
(0.65)
(2.87)
(1.07)
— 
— 
(1.05)
0.15 
2.74 
(25.51)
0.40 
2.08 
(2.01)%

21.00 %
2.82 
(2.83)
(2.58)
3.78 
— 
— 
(0.34)
(0.33)
8.14 
(38.60)
2.53 
5.71 
(0.70)%

As of December 31, 2021, the Company recorded a valuation allowance of $40.5 million for the portion of the deferred tax asset that it does not expect to be
realized. The valuation allowance on the Company’s net deferred taxes increased by $2.2 million and $6.0 million during the years ended December 31,
2021  and  2020,  respectively.  The  changes  in  valuation  allowance  are  primarily  due  to  additional  U.S.  deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities  incurred  in  the
respective year. The Company has $0.8 million of net deferred tax assets in foreign jurisdictions, which management believes are more-likely-than-not to be
realized given the expectation of future earnings in these jurisdictions. The Company continues to monitor the realizability of the U.S. deferred tax assets
taking  into  account  multiple  factors,  including  the  results  of  operations  and  magnitude  of  excess  tax  deductions  for  stock-based  compensation.  The
Company intends to continue maintaining a full valuation allowance on its U.S. deferred tax assets until there is sufficient evidence to support the reversal
of all or some portion of these allowances. Release of all, or a portion, of the valuation allowance would result in the recognition of certain deferred tax
assets and a decrease to income tax expense for the period the release is recorded.

At December 31, 2021, the Company had approximately $75.9 million and $39.3 million of federal and state net operating loss carryforwards, respectively,
available to offset future taxable income. The federal and state net operating loss carryforwards, if not utilized will generally begin to expire in 2029 through
2039. Approximately $35.4 million of total federal net operating loss carryforwards were generated post December 31, 2017 and have no expiration. At
December 31, 2021, the Company had research and development tax credits available to offset federal and California tax liabilities in the amount of $6.9
million and $8.5 million, respectively. Federal credits will begin to expire in 2024 and California state tax credits have no expiration.

Federal and state laws can impose substantial restrictions on the utilization of net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards in the event of an “ownership
change,”  as  defined  in  Section  382  of  the  Internal  Revenue  Code.  The  Company  has  determined  that  no  significant  limitation  would  be  placed  on  the
utilization of the Company’s net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards due to prior ownership changes.

No  deferred  tax  liabilities  have  been  recorded  relating  to  the  earnings  of  the  Company’s  foreign  subsidiaries  since  all  such  earnings  are  intended  to  be
indefinitely reinvested. The amount of the unrecognized deferred tax liability associated with these earnings is immaterial.

Uncertain Tax Positions

The Company establishes reserves for uncertain tax positions based on the largest amount that is more-likely-than-not to be sustained. An uncertain income
tax position will not be recognized if it has less than a 50% likelihood of being sustained. The Company performs a two-step approach to recognizing and
measuring uncertain tax positions. The first step is to evaluate the tax position for recognition by determining if the weight of available evidence indicates
that it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on audit, including resolution of related appeals or litigation processes, if any. The second
step is to measure the tax benefit as the largest amount that is more than 50% likely of being realized upon settlement.

101

Table of Contents

Although  the  Company  believes  it  has  adequately  reserved  for  its  uncertain  tax  positions,  no  assurance  can  be  given  that  the  final  tax  outcome  of  these
matters will not be different. The Company adjusts these reserves in light of changing facts and circumstances, such as the closing of a tax audit or the
refinement of an estimate. To the extent that the final tax outcome of these matters is different than the amounts recorded, such differences will impact the
provision for income taxes in the period in which such determination is made. The provision for income taxes includes the impact of reserve provisions and
changes to reserves that are considered appropriate, as well as the related net interest and penalties.

The Company files U.S., state, and foreign income tax returns in jurisdictions with varying statutes of limitations. Tax years after 2006 remain subject to
examination by U.S. federal and California state tax authorities due to the Company’s net operating loss and credit carryforwards. For significant foreign
jurisdictions, tax years after 2016 remain subject to examination by their respective tax authorities.

The following table summarizes the activity related to the Company’s gross unrecognized tax benefits, excluding related interest and penalties, in December
31, 2019 to December 31, 2021 (in thousands):

Balance at beginning of year
Decreases related to prior year tax positions
Increases related to prior year tax positions
Increases related to current year tax positions

Balance at end of year

NOTE 8—NET INCOME (LOSS) PER SHARE

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

$

$

1,864  $
(37)
— 
919 
2,746  $

1,426  $
(32)
— 
470 
1,864  $

1,563 
(291)
25 
129 
1,426 

As of December 31, 2021, the Company’s convertible notes were potentially convertible into 4,167,232 shares of common stock. The Company used the if-
converted method to calculate the potential dilutive effect of the conversion spread on diluted net income per share for the year ended December 31, 2021.

The denominator for diluted net income (loss) per share does not include any effect from the capped call transactions the Company entered into concurrently
with  the  issuance  of  the  convertible  notes,  as  this  effect  would  be  anti-dilutive.  In  the  event  of  conversion  of  a  convertible  note,  shares  delivered  to  the
Company under the capped call will offset the dilutive effect of the shares that the Company would issue under the convertible notes.

For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, basic loss per common share and diluted loss per common share are the same in each respective period,
as the inclusion of any potentially issuable shares would be anti-dilutive.

The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted net loss and the weighted average number of shares used in computing basic and diluted
net loss per share (in thousands, except per share data):

102

Table of Contents

Numerator:
Net income (loss)
Denominator:
Weighted average shares of common stock outstanding used in computing net income (loss) per

share, basic

Dilutive effect of incremental shares and share equivalents:
Options
RSUs
PSUs
ESPP
Weighted average shares of common stock outstanding used in computing net income (loss)
per share, diluted
Net income (loss) per share:

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

$

2,062  $

(23,877) $

(12,348)

17,891 

16,691 

14,096 

68 
294 
104 
5 

— 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
— 

18,362 

16,691 

14,096 

Net income (loss) per share, basic

Net income (loss) per share, diluted

$

$

0.12  $

0.11  $

(1.43) $

(1.43) $

(0.88)

(0.88)

The following numbers of shares outstanding, prior to the application of the treasury stock method and the if-converted method, were excluded from the
computation of diluted net income (loss) per common share for the periods presented because including them would have had an anti-dilutive effect (in
thousands):

Capped call
Convertible debt
Options to purchase common stock
Restricted stock units
Employee stock purchase plan shares
Performance stock units

Total

NOTE 9—DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

4,167 
4,167 
166 
32 
— 
120 
8,652 

— 
— 
244 
724 
87 
68 
1,123 

— 
— 
417 
559 
111 
178 
1,265 

In the U.S., the Company has an employee savings plan (“401(k) Plan”) that qualifies as a deferred salary arrangement under Section 401(k) of the Internal
Revenue  Code.  Eligible  employees  may  make  voluntary  contributions  to  the  401(k)  Plan  up  to  100%  of  their  annual  compensation,  subject  to  statutory
annual limitations. In 2021, 2020 and 2019, the Company made discretionary contributions under the 401(k) Plan of $0.3 million, $0.2 million and $0.4
million, respectively.

For  the  Company’s  Japanese  subsidiary,  a  discretionary  employee  retirement  plan  has  been  established.  In  addition,  for  some  of  the  Company’s  other
foreign subsidiaries, the Company deposits funds with insurance companies, third-party trustees, or into government-managed accounts consistent with the
requirements of local laws. The Company has fully funded or accrued for its obligations as of December 31, 2021, and the related expense for each of the
three years then ended was not significant.

NOTE 10—SEGMENT INFORMATION AND REVENUE BY GEOGRAPHY AND PRODUCTS

Segment reporting is based on the “management approach,” following the method that management organizes the company’s reportable segments for which
separate financial information is made available to, and evaluated regularly by, the chief operating decision maker in allocating resources and in assessing
performance. The Company’s chief operating decision makers ("CODM") are its Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”),
who make decisions on allocating resources and in assessing performance. The CEO and CFO review the Company's consolidated results as one operating
segment.  In  making  operating  decisions,  the  CODM  primarily  considers  consolidated  financial  information,  accompanied  by  disaggregated  information
about revenues by geography and product. All of the Company’s principal operations and decision-making functions are located in the U.S. Substantially all
of the Company's long-lived assets are located in the U.S.

103

Table of Contents

The following table presents a summary of revenue by geography for the year ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):

Revenue mix by geography:
United States
Japan
Asia, excluding Japan
Europe
Rest of the world, other than United States, Asia and Europe

Total consolidated revenue

Revenue mix by product category:

Systems
Consumables
Skincare

Total product revenue

Service

Total consolidated revenue

NOTE 11– COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

LEASES

Year Ended December 31,
2020

2021

2019

$

$

$

$

96,629  $
70,235 
12,649 
19,444 
32,313 
231,270  $

139,633  $
16,401 
49,669 
205,703 
25,567 
231,270  $

61,238  $
43,265 
10,707 
11,185 
21,288 
147,683  $

90,765  $
9,287 
25,061 
125,113 
22,570 
147,683  $

106,372 
24,143 
14,414 
11,937 
24,846 
181,712 

140,478 
9,648 
8,512 
158,638 
23,074 
181,712 

The Company is a party to certain operating and finance leases for vehicles, office space and storage facilities. The Company’s material operating leases
consist of office space, as well as storage facilities and finance leases consist of automobiles. The Company’s leases generally have remaining terms of one
to 10 years, some of which include options to renew the leases for up to five years. The Company leases space for operations in the United States, Japan,
Belgium,  France,  and  Spain.  In  addition  to  the  above  facility  leases,  the  Company  also  routinely  leases  automobiles  for  certain  sales  and  field  service
employees under finance leases.

In  February  2016,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  2016-2,  "Leases,"  (also  known  as  ASC  Topic  842)  which  requires,  among  other  items,  lease  accounting  to
recognize most leases as assets and liabilities on the balance sheet. Qualitative and quantitative disclosures are enhanced to better present the amount, timing
and uncertainty of cash flows arising from leases.

The Company adopted ASU 2016-2, as of January 1, 2019, using the modified retrospective method, to all leases existing at the date of initial application.
The comparative period information has not been restated and continues to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for the period presented.
The  new  standard  provides  a  number  of  optional  practical  expedients  in  transition.  The  Company  elected  the  package  of  practical  expedients  permitted
under  the  transition  guidance  within  the  new  standard,  which  allowed  the  Company  to  carry  forward  the  Company’s  historical  conclusions  about  lease
identification,  lease  classification  and  initial  direct  costs.  The  Company  also  elected  the  practical  expedient  related  to  land  easements,  allowing  the
Company  to  carry  forward  the  Company’s  accounting  treatment  for  land  easements  on  existing  agreements.  The  Company  did  not  elect  the  practical
expedient to use hindsight in determining the lease term.

The adoption of the new standard resulted in the recording of additional lease assets and lease liabilities of $10.2 million and $10.1 million, respectively, as
of January 1, 2019, based on the present value of the remaining minimum rental payments under current leasing standards for existing operating leases. The
difference  between  the  additional  lease  assets  and  lease  liabilities  resulted  from  rent-free  periods  which  were  previously  recorded  as  deferred  rent.  The
Company’s  accounting  for  finance  leases  remained  substantially  unchanged.  The  standard  had  no  material  impact  on  the  Company’s  consolidated  net
earnings, results of operations, comprehensive loss, statements of changes in equity, and cash flows.

104

Table of Contents

Effect of Adoption of the New Lease Standard (ASC Topic 842) on Consolidated Financial Statements

The following table summarizes the effects of adopting Topic 842 on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet as of January 1, 2019 (in thousands):

Operating lease right-of-use assets

Operating lease liabilities

Other long-term liabilities*

Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion

*Deferred rent included in other long-term liabilities

As reported under
Topic 842

Adjustments

Balances under
Prior GAAP

$

10,049  $

(10,049) $

(2,430)

— 

(7,759)

2,430 

140 

7,759 

— 

— 

140 

— 

The Company determines if a contract contains a lease at inception. Operating lease assets and liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement date.
Operating lease liabilities represent the present value of lease payments not yet paid. Operating lease assets represent the right to use an underlying asset and
are based upon the operating lease liabilities adjusted for prepayments or accrued lease payments, initial direct costs, lease incentives, and impairment of
operating  lease  assets.  To  determine  the  present  value  of  lease  payments  not  yet  paid,  the  Company  estimates  the  incremental  secured  borrowing  rates
corresponding  to  the  maturities  of  the  leases.  The  Company  based  the  rate  estimates  on  prevailing  financial  market  conditions,  credit  analysis,  and
management judgment.

The  Company  recognizes  expense  for  these  leases  on  a  straight-line  basis  over  the  lease  term.  Additionally,  tenant  incentives  used  to  fund  leasehold
improvements are recognized when earned and reduce the Company’s right-of-use asset related to the lease. These are amortized through the right-of-use
asset as reductions of expense over the lease term. 

Below is supplemental balance sheet information related to leases (in thousands):

Assets

Right-of-use assets

Finance lease

Total leased assets

Classification

Operating lease right-of-use assets

Property and equipment, net

Liabilities

Operating lease liabilities

Classification

Operating lease liabilities, current

Operating lease liabilities

Operating lease liabilities , non-current

Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion

Total Operating lease liabilities

Finance lease liabilities

Finance lease liabilities, current

Finance lease liabilities, non-current

Total Finance lease liabilities

Classification

Accrued liabilities

Other long-term liabilities

Lease costs during the twelve months ended  December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020 (in thousands): 

105

Year Ended December 31,

2021

2020

14,627  $

392 

15,019  $

17,076 

467 

17,543 

Year Ended December 31,

2021

2020

2,419  $

13,483 

15,902  $

2,260 

15,950 

18,210 

Year Ended December 31,

2021

2020

554  $

730 

1,284  $

370 

241 

611 

$

$

$

$

$

$

Table of Contents

Finance lease cost

Finance lease cost

Operating lease cost

Amortization expense

Interest for finance lease

Operating lease expense

$

$

$

484  $

59  $

3,542  $

431  $

63  $

3,275  $

704 

88 

2,892 

Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities during the twelve months ended December 31, 2021 and December 31, 2020 were as
follows (in thousands):

Year Ended December 31,

2021

2020

2019

Operating cash flow

Financing cash flow

Operating cash flow

Maturities of lease liabilities 

Finance lease

Finance lease

Operating lease

Year Ended December 31,

2021

2020

2019

$

$

$

56  $

462  $

3,092  $

63  $

537  $

2,139  $

88 

649 

2,820 

Maturities of operating lease liabilities were as follows as of December 31, 2021 (in thousands):

2022

2023

2024

2025

2026

Thereafter

Total lease payments

Less: imputed interest

Present value of lease liabilities

Vehicle Leases

Amount

3,121 

3,160 

2,874 

2,875 

2,970 

3,338 

18,338 

(2,436)

15,902 

$

$

As of December 31, 2021, the Company was committed to minimum lease payments for vehicles leased under long-term non-cancelable finance leases as
follows (in thousands):

2022

2023

2024

2025

Total lease payments

Less: imputed interest

Present value of lease liabilities

106

Amount

601 

347 

409 

22 

1,379 

(95)

1,284 

$

$

Table of Contents

Weighted-average remaining lease term and discount rate, as of December 31, 2021, were as follows:

Lease Term and Discount Rate

Weighted-average remaining lease term (years)

Operating leases

Finance leases

Weighted-average discount rate

Operating leases

Finance leases

Lessor Information related to the Company’s system leasing

5.8

2.1

4.8 %

6.7 %

During  fiscal  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  entered  into  leasing  transactions,  in  which  the  Company  is  the  lessor,  offered  through  the
Company's  membership  program.  The  Company's  leases  for  equipment  rentals  were  all  accounted  for  as  operating  leases  during  the  second  and  third
quarters of 2020.

During the fourth quarter ended December 31, 2020, certain of the membership program agreements were amended, granting the customers the exclusive
right and option to purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of twelve months from signing the amended agreement. For
contracts  signed  under  the  amended  membership  agreement,  the  Company  classified  and  accounted  for  the  arrangements  as  sales-type  leases  as  of
December 31, 2020, as the Company determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option.

For the sales-type leases, the net investment of the Company’s lease receivable is measured at the commencement date and is included in the consolidated
balance sheets as a component of Other current assets and prepaid expenses. As of December 31, 2020, the Company recorded $0.7 million of revenue for
the sales-type leases in the consolidated statement of operations and the related lease receivable in other current assets of the consolidated balance sheet.
There was no revenue recognized from the sales-type lease arrangement in fiscal year 2021. During fiscal year 2021 the company received a full payment of
$0.4 million from customers who exercised the purchase option. As of December 31, 2021, the lease receivable balance included in Other current assets of
the consolidated balance sheet was $0.3 million.

The revenue related to non-lease components, which comprise service contracts and consumables, are deferred and recognized either over time or at the
point of delivery. The non-lease component revenue amount as of December 31, 2021 was immaterial.

Equipment lease revenue for operating lease agreements is recognized over the life of the lease. The following table summarizes the amount of operating
lease income included in product revenue in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations (in thousands):

Operating lease income from equipment rentals

Purchase Commitments

Year Ended
December 31,
2021

Year Ended
December 31, 2020

$

149 

$

367 

The Company maintains certain open inventory purchase commitments with its suppliers to ensure a smooth and continuous supply for key components.
The Company’s liability in these purchase commitments is generally restricted to an agreed-upon period. These periods can vary among different suppliers.
Although open purchase orders are considered enforceable and legally binding, the terms generally allow the Company the option to cancel, reschedule, and
adjust their requirements based on the Company's business needs prior to the delivery of goods or performance of services.

Indemnifications

In  the  normal  course  of  the  Company’s  business,  the  Company  enters  into  agreements  that  contain  a  variety  of  representations,  warranties,  and
indemnification obligations. For example, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements with each of its directors and executive officers and
certain key employees. The Company’s exposure under its various indemnification obligations is unknown and not reasonably estimable as they involve
future claims that may be made against the Company. As such, the Company has not accrued any amounts for such obligations.

107

Table of Contents

Contingencies

The Company is named from time to time as a party to other legal proceedings, product liability, commercial disputes, employee disputes, and contractual
lawsuits in the normal course of business. A liability and related charge are recorded to earnings in the Company’s consolidated financial statements for
legal  contingencies  when  the  loss  is  considered  probable  and  the  amount  can  be  reasonably  estimated.  The  assessment  is  re-evaluated  each  accounting
period and is based on all available information, including discussion with outside legal counsel. If a reasonable estimate of a known or probable loss cannot
be made, but a range of probable losses can be estimated, the low-end of the range of losses is recognized if no amount within the range is a better estimate
than any other. If a material loss is reasonably possible, but not probable and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed in
the notes to the consolidated financial statements. The Company expenses legal fees as incurred.

In  November  2019,  the  Company’s  former  Executive  Vice  President  and  CFO  Sandra  A.  Gardiner  announced  her  resignation  from  the  Company.  On
November 7, 2019, Ms. Gardiner filed an arbitration demand against the Company in connection with the terms of her employment and resignation. The
Company settled this matter with Ms. Gardiner during the second quarter of 2020 with a cash payment of $0.4 million and issuance of 15,408 shares of
common stock.

As  of  December  31,  2021  and  2020,  the  Company  had  accrued  $0.7  million  and  $0.4  million,  respectively,  related  to  various  pending  commercial  and
product liability lawsuits. The Company does not believe that a material loss in excess of accrued amounts is reasonably possible.

On January 31, 2020, Cutera filed a lawsuit against Lutronic Aesthetics in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of California. Lutronic
employs numerous former Cutera employees. The complaint against Lutronic generally alleges claims for (1) misappropriation of trade secrets in violation
of state and federal law; (2) violation of the Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act (RICO); (3) interference with contractual relations; (4)
interference with prospective economic advantage; (5) unfair competition; and (6) aiding and abetting. On March 13, 2020, the court entered a temporary
restraining  order  against  Lutronic  generally  prohibiting  it  from  using  or  disseminating  Cutera  confidential,  proprietary,  or  trade  secret  information.  The
order  also  prohibits  Lutronic,  for  2  years,  from  using  such  information  for  the  purpose  of  soliciting,  or  conducting  business  with,  certain  specified
customers. At the parties’ request, the Court subsequently entered a preliminary injunction providing for the same restrictions in the restraining order. On
February 9, 2022, Cutera filed a motion seeking leave from the court to file a second amended complaint. In addition to the above-referenced claims against
Lutronic Aesthetics, the proposed amended complaint alleges additional claims against it, including (1) violation of the Lanham Act; (2) unlawful business
practices;  (3)  false  advertising;  and  (4)  trademark  infringement.  The  proposed  amended  complaint  also  seeks  to  add  Lutronic  Corporation  (the  Korean
parent  company  of  Lutronic  Aesthetics)  as  an  additional  defendant,  and  also  alleges  against  it  the  above-described  claims  for  misappropriation  of  trade
secrets,  violation  of  RICO,  interference  with  contractual  relations  and  prospective  economic  advantage,  unfair  competition,  and  aiding  and  abetting.
Discovery is ongoing. No trial date has been scheduled.

NOTE 12—DEBT

Convertible notes, net of unamortized debt issuance costs

In March 2021, the Company issued $138.3 million aggregate principal amount of convertible senior notes ("convertible notes") due on March 15, 2026 in a
private placement offering. The convertible notes bear interest at a rate of 2.25% per year payable semiannually in arrears on March 15 and September 15 of
each year, beginning on September 15, 2021. Upon conversion, the convertible notes will be convertible into cash, shares of the Company’s common stock
or a combination thereof, at the Company’s election. The convertible notes are presented as convertible notes, net of unamortized debt issuance costs, on the
consolidated balance sheet. Proceeds from the offering were $133.6 million, net of issuance costs, including initial purchasers fees.

Initially, each $1,000 principal amount of Notes was convertible into 30.1427 shares of the Company’s common stock at a conversion price of $33.18 per
share. The conversion rate for the convertible notes is subject to adjustment for certain events as set forth in the Indenture governing the convertible notes.
The convertible notes will mature on March 15, 2026, unless earlier converted, redeemed, or repurchased in accordance with the terms of the convertible
notes. No sinking fund is provided for the Notes. As of December 31, 2021, the net carrying amount of the Company’s convertible notes was $134.2 million
and the unamortized debt issuance costs were $4.0 million.

Holders may convert their Notes at their option prior to the close of business on the business day immediately preceding December 15, 2025, in multiples of
$1,000 principal amount, only under the following circumstances:

108

Table of Contents

• During any fiscal quarter commencing after the fiscal quarter ended on June 30, 2021 (and only during such fiscal quarter), if the last reported sale
price of the common stock for at least 20 trading days (whether or not consecutive) during a period of 30 consecutive trading days ending on and
including,  the  last  trading  day  of  the  immediately  preceding  fiscal  quarter,  is  greater  than  or  equal  to  130%  of  the  conversion  price  for  the
convertible notes on each applicable trading day;

• During  the  five-business  day  period  after  any  five  consecutive  trading  day  period  (the  “measurement  period”)  in  which  the  “trading  price”  per
$1,000 principal amount of convertible notes for each trading day of the measurement period was less than 98% of the product of the last reported
sale price of the Company's common stock and the conversion rate on each such trading day;
The  Company  calls  such  convertible  notes  for  redemption,  at  any  time  prior  to  the  close  of  business  on  the  second  scheduled  trading  day
immediately preceding the redemption date; or
• Upon the occurrence of specified corporate events.

•

On or after December 15, 2025, and until the close of business on the second scheduled trading day immediately preceding the maturity date, holders may
convert all or any portion of their Notes, in multiples of $1,000 principal amount, at the option of the holder regardless of the foregoing circumstances.

The circumstances described in the first bullet of the paragraph above were met during the second and third quarters of 2021 as the Company's stock traded
at a price in excess of the conversion price for the required number of days during each of those quarters. These circumstances were not met during the
fourth quarter of 2021. As a result, holders of the Notes had the right to convert their Notes beginning July 1, 2021 and ending on December 31, 2021. As of
December 31, 2021, the Notes are not convertible and this condition will remain until March 31, 2022. The Notes may become convertible in future periods.
Upon any conversion requests of the convertible notes, the Company would be required to pay or deliver, as the case may be, cash, shares of its common
stock, or a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, at the Company’s election with respect to such conversion requests. To the extent there are
any  conversion  requests  in  the  year  ending  December  31,  2022,  the  Company  intends  to  settle  such  conversion  requests  in  shares  of  common  stock.
Therefore, as of December 31, 2021, the convertible notes have been included as Long-term debt on the consolidated balance sheet.

The Company may not redeem the convertible notes prior to March 20, 2024. On or after March 20, 2024, the Company may redeem for cash all or any
portion of the Notes, at the Company’s option, if the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock has been at least 130% of the conversion price
then in effect for at least 20 trading days (whether or not consecutive) during any 30 consecutive trading day period (including the last trading day of such
period) ending on, and including, the trading day immediately preceding the date on which the Company provides notice of redemption at a redemption
price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. If the
Company elects to redeem fewer than all of the outstanding Notes, at least $50.0 million aggregate principal amount of Notes must be outstanding and not
subject to redemption as of the relevant redemption notice date.

If a fundamental change occurs, note holders have the option to require the Company to repurchase any portion or all of their convertible notes in $1,000
principal increments for cash. The price for such repurchase is calculated as 100% of the principal amounts of Notes, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the
day  immediately  preceding  the  Fundamental  Change  repurchase  date.  Additionally,  holders  of  the  Notes  who  convert  in  connection  with  a  fundamental
change are, under certain circumstances, entitled to an increase in conversion rate.

The convertible notes are general senior unsecured obligations that rank senior to any of the Company’s indebtedness that is explicitly subordinated to the
Notes. The Notes have equal rank in right of payment with all existing and future unsecured indebtedness that is not subordinated to the Notes. The Notes
will be junior to any of the Company’s secured indebtedness to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness. The Notes do not contain
any financial or operating covenants or any restrictions on the payment of dividends, the issuance of other indebtedness or the issuance or repurchase of
securities by the Company.

The estimated fair value of the convertible notes was approximately $201.0 million as of December 31, 2021. The fair value is based on observable market
prices for this debt, which is traded in active markets and therefore is classified as a Level 2 fair value measurement, as defined in Note 1.

The following table presents the outstanding principal amount and carrying value of the convertible notes (in thousands):

109

Table of Contents

Outstanding principal amount
Unamortized debt issuance costs

Carrying Value

December 31, 2021
138,250 
(4,007)
134,243 

$

$

In connection with issuance of the convertible notes, the Company entered into capped call transactions with certain option counterparties. The capped call
transactions are generally intended to reduce the potential dilution of the Company's common stock upon any conversion or settlement of the Notes or to
offset any cash payment the Company is required to make in excess of the principal amount upon conversion of the Notes, as the case may be, with such
reduction or offset subject to a cap based on the cap price. If the market price per share of the Company’s common stock exceeds the cap price of the capped
calls transaction, then the Company’s stock would experience some dilution and/or the capped call would not fully offset the potential cash payments, in
each  case  to  the  extent  the  then-market  price  per  share  of  its  common  stock  exceeds  the  cap  price.  Under  the  capped  call  transactions,  the  Company
purchased  from  the  option  counterparties  capped  call  options  that  in  the  aggregate  relate  to  the  total  number  of  shares  of  the  Company's  common  stock
underlying the convertible notes, with a strike price equal to the conversion price of the convertible notes and with an initial cap price equal to $45.5350,
which  represents  a  75%  premium  over  the  last  reported  sale  price  of  the  Company's  common  stock  of  $26.02  per  share  on  March  4,  2021,  with  certain
adjustments to the settlement terms that reflect standard anti-dilution provisions. The capped call transactions expire over 40 consecutive scheduled trading
days ended on March 12, 2026. The capped calls were purchased for $16.1 million. The Company evaluated the capped call transaction under authoritative
accounting guidance and determined that it should be accounted for as a separate transaction and classified as a net reduction to Additional paid-in capital
within stockholders’ equity with no recurring fair value measurement recorded.

The Company early adopted ASU 2020-6, Debt—Debt with Conversion and Other Options (Subtopic 470-20) and Derivatives and Hedging— Contracts in
Entity’s Own Equity (Subtopic 815-40). In accordance with Subtopic 470-20 and 815-40, as revised by ASU 2020-6, the Company records the convertible
notes in long-term debt with no separation between the Notes and the conversion option. Each reporting period, the Company will determine whether any
criteria is met for the note holders to have the option to redeem the Notes early, which could result in a change in the classification of the Notes to current
liabilities.

Debt Issuance Cost

The issuance costs related to the convertible notes are presented in the consolidated balance sheet as a direct deduction from the carrying amount of the
convertible notes. During the year ended December 31, 2021, the Company incurred direct costs associated with the issuance of convertible notes of $4.7
million.

The  issuance  costs  are  amortized  using  an  effective  interest  method  basis  over  the  term  of  the  convertible  notes  and  accordingly  the  Company  recorded
approximately $0.7 million of amortization of debt issuance costs during the year ended December 31, 2021.

The effective interest rate on the convertible notes is 2.97%. Interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2021, including the amortization of debt
issuance cost, totaled approximately $3.2 million.

Loan and Security Agreement

On July 9, 2020, the Company entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB
Revolving Line of Credit”) in an aggregate principal amount of up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024.

In order to draw on the full amount of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit, the Company must satisfy certain liquidity ratios. If the Company is unable to
meet these liquidity ratios, then availability under the revolving line is calculated as 80% of the Company’s qualifying accounts receivable. The proceeds of
the revolving loans may be used for general corporate purposes. The Company’s obligations under the Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley
Bank  are  secured  by  substantially  all  of  the  assets  of  the  Company.  Interest  on  principal  amount  outstanding  under  the  revolving  line  shall  accrue  at  a
floating per annum rate equal to the greater of either 1.75% above the Prime Rate or five percent (5.0%). The Company paid a non-refundable revolving line
commitment fee of $0.3 million, on the effective date of the Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank of July 9, 2020, and the Company is
required to pay an anniversary fee of $0.3 million on each twelve-month anniversary of the effective date of the Loan and Security Agreement.

110

Table of Contents

The Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank contains customary affirmative covenants, such as financial statement reporting requirements
and  delivery  of  borrowing  base  certificates,  as  well  as  customary  covenants  that  restrict  the  Company’s  ability  to,  among  other  things,  incur  additional
indebtedness,  sell  certain  assets,  guarantee  obligations  of  third  parties,  declare  dividends,  or  make  certain  distributions,  and  undergo  a  merger  or
consolidation or certain other transactions. The Loan and Security Agreement also contains certain financial covenants, including maintaining a quarterly
minimum revenue of $90.0 million, determined in accordance with GAAP on a trailing twelve-month basis, but which is only applicable if the Company
has an outstanding balance under the loan facility.

On March 4, 2021, the Loan and Security Agreement dated July 9, 2020 was amended to (i) permit the Company to issue the Convertible notes and perform
its obligations in connection therewith, and (ii) permit the Capped Call transactions.

On or about May 28, 2021, the Loan and Security Agreement was amended. The amendment removed the quarterly minimum revenue requirement but kept
in place the other financial covenants.

As  of  December  31,  2021,  the  Company  had  not  drawn  on  the  SVB  Revolving  Line  of  Credit  and  the  Company  is  in  compliance  with  all  financial
covenants of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit.

The Paycheck Protection Program (PPP) Loan

On April 22, 2020, the Company received loan proceeds of $7.2 million pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (the “PPP”) under the CARES Act.
The loan, which was in the form of a promissory note dated April 21, 2020, between the Company and Silicon Valley Bank as the lender, originally matured
on April 21, 2022 and bore interest at a fixed rate of 1.00% per annum, payable monthly commencing September 2021. There was no prepayment penalty.
Under the terms of the PPP, all or a portion of the principal may be forgiven if the loan proceeds were used for qualifying expenses as described in the
CARES Act, such as payroll costs, benefits, rent, and utilities.

The PPP loan and related accrued interest were forgiven in June 2021 under the provisions of the CARES Act, and a $7.2 million Gain on extinguishment of
PPP loan was recorded in the consolidated statement of operations.

NOTE 13—SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

The Company has evaluated subsequent events through the date the financial statements were issued, and determined that there have been no events that
have occurred that would require adjustments to our disclosures in the consolidated financial statements.

111

Table of Contents

Deferred tax assets valuation allowance

Year ended December 31, 2021

Year ended December 31, 2020

Year ended December 31, 2019

Allowance for credit losses, accounts receivable
Year ended December 31, 2021

Year ended December 31, 2020

Year ended December 31, 2019

SCHEDULE II CUTERA, INC.
VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
(in thousands)
For the Years Ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019

Balance at
Beginning
of Year

Additions

Deductions

Balance
at End of
Year

38,321  $

32,350  $

27,865  $

7,503  $

7,986  $

7,396  $

5,337  $

2,015  $

2,911  $

40,487 

38,321 

32,350 

Balance at
Beginning
of Year

Additions

Deductions

Balance
at End of
Year

1,598  $

1,354  $

1,257  $

271  $

2,144  $

1,361  $

970  $

1,900  $

1,264  $

899 

1,598 

1,354 

$

$

$

$

$

$

112

Table of Contents

ITEM 9.    CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A.        CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended) that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the Company’s Exchange Act reports is recorded, processed, summarized
and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and that such information is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s
management,  including  the  Company’s  principal  executive  officer  and  principal  financial  officer,  as  appropriate,  to  allow  for  timely  decisions  regarding
required disclosure.

As  required  by  SEC  Rule  13a-15(b),  the  Company  carried  out  an  evaluation,  under  the  supervision  and  with  the  participation  of  the  Company’s
management,  including  the  Company’s  principal  executive  officer  and  principal  financial  officer,  of  the  effectiveness  of  the  design  and  operation  of  the
Company’s  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  as  of  the  end  of  the  period  covered  by  this  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K.  Based  on  the  foregoing,  the
Company’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”) concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were
not effective at the reasonable assurance level as a result of the material weakness disclosed below. Notwithstanding the material weakness, the Company’s
management, including the CEO and CFO, has concluded that the consolidated financial statements, included in the 2021 Annual Report on Form 10-K,
fairly present, in all material respects, our financial condition, results of operations and cash-flows for the periods presented in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.

Attached as exhibits to this Annual Report are certifications of the Company’s CEO and CFO, which are required in accordance with Rule 13a-14 of the
Securities  Exchange  Act  of  1934,  as  amended  (Exchange  Act).  This  Controls  and  Procedures  section  includes  the  information  concerning  the  controls
evaluation  referred  to  in  the  certifications,  and  it  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  the  certifications  for  a  more  complete  understanding  of  the  topics
presented.

Inherent Limitations Over Internal Controls

The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those
policies and procedures that:

•

•

•

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the Company’s
assets;
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP,
and that the Company’s receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of the Company’s management and
directors; and
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company’s assets that
could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Management, including the Company’s CEO and CFO, does not expect that the Company’s internal controls will prevent or detect all errors and all fraud. A
control system, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are
met. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative
to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of internal controls can provide absolute assurance that all control
issues and instances of fraud, if any, have been detected. Also, any evaluation of the effectiveness of controls in future periods are subject to the risk that
those internal controls may become inadequate because of changes in business conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures
may deteriorate.

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The  Company’s  management  is  responsible  for  establishing  and  maintaining  adequate  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  (as  defined  in  Rules  13a-
15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability

113

Table of Contents

of the Company’s financial reporting and the preparation of Consolidated Financial Statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

Management, including Company’s CEO and CFO, assessed the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021. Management
based  its  assessment  on  criteria  established  in  Internal  Control—Integrated  Framework  issued  by  the  Committee  of  Sponsoring  Organizations  of  the
Treadway Commission (2013 framework). Management’s assessment included evaluation of elements such as the design and operating effectiveness of key
financial  reporting  controls,  process  documentation,  accounting  policies,  and  the  Company's  overall  control  environment.  A  material  weakness  is  a
deficiency,  or  a  combination  of  deficiencies,  in  internal  control  over  financial  reporting,  such  that  there  is  a  reasonable  possibility  that  a  material
misstatement of the Company’s annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis.

Based on this assessment, management identified a material weakness in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. This material weakness is
related to ineffective information technology general controls (“ITGCs”) in the areas of user access and segregation of duties related to certain information
technology (“IT”) systems that support the Company’s financial reporting process at its Japan subsidiary. Although this material weakness did not result in
any material misstatement of the Company's consolidated financial statements for the periods presented, it could lead to a material misstatement of account
balances or disclosures. Accordingly, management has concluded that this deficiency constitutes a material weakness.

The  Company  has  begun  the  process  of  designing  and  implementing  effective  internal  control  measures  to  improve  its  internal  controls  over  financial
reporting  and  remediate  this  material  weakness.  The  Company's  efforts  include  implementing  additional  controls  designed  to  detect  potential  material
misstatements that may arise as a result of user access and segregation of duties conflicts at the Company's Japan subsidiary.

The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, has been audited by an independent registered public
accounting firm, as stated in their attestation report, which is included in their annual report under “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”
of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

There were no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the quarter ended December 31, 2021 that have materially affected,
or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B.    OTHER INFORMATION

None

ITEM 9C.    DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS

Not Applicable.

PART III

Certain information required by Part III is omitted from this report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference to the Company’s definitive Proxy
Statement for the Company’s next Annual Meeting of Stockholders (the “Proxy Statement”), which the Company intends to file pursuant to Regulation 14A
of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, within 120 days after December 31, 2021.

ITEM 10.    DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by
reference:  “Proposal  No.  1  –  Election  of  Class  I  Directors”,  “Board  and  Committee  Information”,  “Executive  Officers”  and  “Additional  Information  –
Stockholder Proposals to be Presented at Next Annual Meeting.”

ITEM 11.    EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information required by this item set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Executive Compensation.”

114

Table of Contents

ITEM 12.    SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER

MATTERS

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.”

ITEM 13.    CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Certain Relationships and Related-Party Transactions.”

ITEM 14.    PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES

The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, which is incorporated by reference herein by
reference: “Proposal No. 2, Ratification of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.”

115

Table of Contents

ITEM 15.    EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

(a) The following documents are filed in Part II of the Annual Report on the Original 10-K:

PART IV

1. Financial Statements: Financial Statements: See "Index to Consolidated Financial Statements" within the Consolidated Financial Statements.

2. Financial Statement Schedules: Financial Statement Schedules; not applicable or the required information is otherwise included in the Consolidated
Financial Statements and accompanying notes.

3. Exhibits: The exhibits listed in the accompanying index to exhibits are filed, furnished, or incorporated by reference as part of this Form 10-K. The
following is a list of such Exhibits:

Exhibit No.

Exhibit Index

Description

3.1

3.2

4.1

4.2

10.1*

10.2*

10.3*

10.4

10.5

10.6

10.7*

10.8*

10.9

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 3.5 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form
10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

Bylaws of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 3.4 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2015 and
incorporated herein by reference)

Specimen Common Stock certificate of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on
March 25, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference)

Description of the Registrant’s Securities (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16,
2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Indemnification Agreement for directors and executive officers (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on
Form 8-K filed on February 21, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

1998 Stock Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-1 filed on January 15, 2004 and
incorporated herein by reference)

2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2007
and incorporated herein by reference)

Brisbane Technology Park Lease dated August 5, 2003 by and between the Registrant and Gal-Brisbane, L.P. for office space located
at 3240 Bayshore Boulevard, Brisbane, California (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-1 filed on
January 15, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference)

Settlement Agreement between the Registrant and Palomar Medical Technologies, Inc. dated June  2, 2006 (filed as Exhibit 99.1 to
the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 6, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference)

Non-Exclusive Patent License between the Registrant and Palomar Medical Technologies, Inc. dated June 2, 2006 (filed as Exhibit
99.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 6, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Performance Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
November 14, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference)

2019 Equity Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix A to the Company’s definitive proxy statement on Form 14A filed on April  30, 2019
and incorporated herein by reference)

First Amendment to Brisbane Technology Park Lease dated August 11, 2010 by and between the Company and BMR-Bayshore
Boulevard LLC, as successor-in-interest to Gal-Brisbane, L.P., the original landlord, for office space located at 3240 Bayshore
Boulevard (filed as Exhibit 10.19 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 1, 2010 and incorporated
herein by reference)

10.10*

Change of Control and Severance Agreement between Kevin P. Connors and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)

116

Table of Contents

10.11*

10.12*

10.13*

10.14

10.15

10.16

10.17

10.18*

10.19*

10.20*

10.21

10.22

10.23

10.24

10.25

10.26

10.27*

10.28*

Change of Control and Severance Agreement between Ronald J. Santilli and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.22 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement between James Reinstein and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.23 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 11, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

Lease Termination Agreement dated July  6, 2017 by and between the Registrant and SI 28, LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the
Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

Second Amendment to Lease dated July  6, 2017 by and between the Company and BMR-Bayshore Boulevard LP (filed as Exhibit
10.27 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)

First Amendment and Wavier to the Loan and Security Agreement dated November  2, 2018 by and between the Company and Wells
Fargo Bank, N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020 and incorporated
herein by reference)

Second Amendment and Waiver to the Loan and Security Agreement dated March  11, 2019 by and between the Company and Wells
Fargo Bank N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020 and incorporated
herein by reference)

Employment Offer Letter dated June  22, 2019 by and between Cutera, Inc. and David Mowry (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 10, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement dated July  8, 2019 by and between Cutera, Inc. and David Mowry (filed as Exhibit 10.2
to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 10, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

Consulting Agreement between Cutera, Inc. and FLG Partners, effective November  11, 2019 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 18, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)

Purchase Agreement, dated April 16, 2020, by and between Cutera, Inc., and Piper Sandler & Co. (filed as Exhibit 1.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on April 21, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Opinion of Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation (filed as Exhibit 5.1 to the Company’s Current Report on
Form 8-K filed on April 21, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Promissory Note dated April 21, 2020, between Cutera, Inc. and Silicon Valley Bank (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current
Report on Form 8-K filed on April 24, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Cutera, Inc. 2019 Equity Incentive Plan (amended and restated as of June 15, 2020) (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current
Report on Form 8-K filed on June 17, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Loan and Security Agreement, dated as of July 9, 2020, by and among Cutera, Inc., as borrower, and Silicon Valley Bank, as lender
(filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 13, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Third Amendment to Lease by and between Cutera, Inc. and BMR-Bayshore Boulevard LP, successor-in-interest Gal-Brisbane, L.P.
(filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 13, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Employment Offer Letter dated July 29, 2020 by and between Cutera, Inc. and Rohan Seth (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 7, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement dated July 29, 2020 by and between Cutera, Inc. and Rohan Seth (filed as Exhibit 10.2
to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 7, 2020 and incorporated herein by reference)

117

Table of Contents

10.29

10.30

10.31

10.32

10.33*

10.34*

10.35*

10.36

10.37

10.38

10.39

10.40

10.41

Indenture, dated as of March 9, 2021, between Cutera, Inc. and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 9, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Purchase Agreement, dated March 4, 2021, between Cutera, Inc. and Stifel, Nicolaus & Company, Incorporated, as representative of
the several initial purchasers named in Schedule I thereto (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed
on March 9, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Form of Capped Call Transaction Confirmation (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on
March 9, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Amendment No. 1, dated March 4, 2021, to the Loan and Security Agreement, dated July 9, 2020 by and between Cutera, Inc., and
Silicon Valley Bank ((filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 9, 2021 and incorporated
herein by reference))

Separation and Release Agreement by and between Cutera, Inc. and Jason Richey (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current
Report on Form 8-K filed on May 12, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Employment Offer Letter dated May 19, 2021 by and between Cutera, Inc. and J. Daniel Plants (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 25, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Change of Control and Severance Agreement dated May 19, 2021 by and between Cutera, Inc. and J. Daniel Plants (filed as Exhibit
10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 25, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Cutera, Inc. 2019 Equity Incentive Plan (amended and restated as of June 15, 2021) (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current
Report on Form 8-K filed on June 21, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

ZO Medical and Cutera Agreement 5 Aug 2013 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
August 6, 2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

ZO Skin Health Amendment 21 Aug 2013 (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 6,
2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

ZO Skin Health Amendment 25 Jan 2021 (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 6,
2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

ZO Skin Health Amendment 14 Jun 2021 (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 6,
2021 and incorporated herein by reference)

Amendment, effective January 1, 2022, to Distribution Agreement dated August 5, 2013, between Cutera Inc., and ZO Skin Health,
Inc.

118

 
Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

Description

23.1+

24.1

31.3+

31.4+

32.1+

101.INS

101.SCH

101.CAL

101.DEF

101.LAB

101.PRE

104

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Power of Attorney

Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Inline XBRL Instance Document

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Document

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101)

*    Management contract or compensatory plan
+    Filed herewith

ITEM 16. FORM 10-K SUMMARY

None

119

Table of Contents

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Brisbane, State of California, on the 1th day of March, 2022.

SIGNATURES

CUTERA, INC.

By:

Power of Attorney

/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY

David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer

KNOW ALL MEN AND WOMEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints David H.

Mowry, and Rohan Seth, and each of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution for
him or her and in his or her name, place, and stead, in any and all capacities to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to file
the same, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto
said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be
done therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes as they might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and
agents, and any of them or their substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the

registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

120

Table of Contents

Signature

Title

Date

/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY

David H. Mowry

/s/ ROHAN SETH

Rohan Seth

Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)

March 01, 2022

Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

March 1, 2022

/s/ J. DANIEL PLANTS

Executive Chairman of the Board of Directors

J. Daniel Plants

/s/ GREGORY A. BARRETT

Director

Gregory A. Barrett

/s/ JOSEPH E. WHITTERS

Director

Joseph E. Whitters

/s/ TIM J. O’SHEA

Tim J. O’Shea

Director

/s/ KATHERINE S. ZANOTTI

Director

Katherine S. Zanotti

/s/ SHEILA A. HOPKINS

Director

Sheila A. Hopkins

/s/ JANET L. WIDMAN

Director

Janet L. Widman

/s/ JULIANE T. PARK

Juliane T. Park

Director

121

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

March 1, 2022

CERTAIN IDENTIFIED INFORMATION HAS BEEN OMITTED FROM THIS
DOCUMENT BECAUSE IT IS NOT MATERIAL AND (I) WOULD BE
COMPETITIVELY HARMFUL TO THE REGISTRANT IF PUBLICLY DISCLOSED
OR (II) IS INFORMATION THAT THE REGISTRANT TREATS AS PRIVATE OR
CONFIDENTIAL. SUCH INFORMATION HAS BEEN MARKED WITH “[***]” TO
INDICATE WHERE OMISSIONS HAVE BEEN MADE.

AMENDMENT TO DISTRIBUTION AGREEMENT

This Amendment (this “Amendment”) to the Existing Agreement (as hereinafter defined), is made by and between ZO Skin Health, Inc., a
California corporation, having its principal place of business at 9685 Research Drive, Irvine, CA 92618 (“ZO SKIN HEALTH”), and Cutera,
Inc., a Delaware corporation, having its principal place of business at 3240 Bayshore Blvd., Brisbane, CA 94005 (“Distributor,” and together
with ZO SKIN HEALTH, the “Parties,” and each, a “Party”), effective as of January 1, 2022 (“Amendment Effective Date”).

WHEREAS, the Parties have entered into a Distribution Agreement, dated August 5, 2013 (the “Agreement”), as amended by an amendment
effective August 21, 2013 (the “August 2013 Amendment”), an amendment effective January 25, 2021 (the “January 2021 Amendment”),
and an amendment effective June 14, 2021 (the “June 2021 Amendment”). The Agreement as amended by the August 2013 Amendment, the
January 2021 Amendment and the June 2021 Amendment are collectively referred to herein as the “Existing Agreement”.

WHEREAS, the Parties hereto desire to amend the Existing Agreement on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are
hereby acknowledged, the Parties agree as follows:

1. Definitions. Capitalized terms used and not defined in this Amendment have the respective meanings assigned to them in the Existing
Agreement.

2. Amendments to the Existing Agreement. As of the Amendment Effective Date, the Existing Agreement is hereby amended and modified
as follows:

(a)

Section 4.1. of the Existing Agreement is hereby modified by adding the following as Section 4.4(e):

“(e)  2022  Minimum  Sales  Requirement.  For  calendar  year  2022,  Distributor  must  achieve  in-Territory  sales  of  Products  and
Related  Products  of  at  least  XXX%  of  Distributor’s  actual  in-Territory  sales  of  Products  and  Related  Products  for  the  2021
calendar  year  (the  “2022  Minimum  Sales  Requirement”).  Should  Distributor  fail  to  achieve  the  2022  Minimum  Sales
Requirement, the Parties shall follow the procedures set forth in Section 4.1(c) of the Existing Agreement as if Distributor failed
to achieve a Minimum Purchase Requirement, and the Parties shall have the same rights and obligations as set forth therein in
connection with such failure to achieve the 2022 Minimum Sales Requirement.”

(b)

Section 4.4. of the Existing Agreement is hereby deleted in its entirety and replaced with the following:

“4.4.    Business Plan and Reporting.

(a) Business Plan. By March 1, 2022, Distributor shall provide to ZO SKIN HEALTH a business plan (“Business Plan”) for the
promotion,  marketing,  distribution  and  sale  of  Products  and  Related  Products  in  the  Territory  during  the  calendar  year  of  this
Amendment.  A  Business  Plan  for  each  subsequent  year  shall  be  provided  to  ZO  by  October  1   of  the  preceding  year.  The
Business Plan shall include, at a minimum, those items set forth in Exhibit E, which may be modified unilaterally by ZO SKIN
HEALTH upon written notice to Distributor.

st

(b) Reporting. Not later than the tenth business day of each calendar month, Distributor shall provide ZO SKIN HEALTH with
updated in-market activity containing sales by account and sales by Product/SKU data for the prior calendar month. Following the
end of each calendar year during the term of this Agreement, but no later than February 15  of the following year, Distributor
shall  send  to  ZO  SKIN  HEALTH  a  report  containing  sell  in  and  sell  through  data  by  country,  to  be  approved  by  ZO  SKIN
HEALTH.”

th

(c)

Section 4.8. of the Existing Agreement is hereby deleted in its entirety and replaced with the following:

“4.8.     Quarterly Notices, Reports and Forecasts. Distributor shall provide ZO SKIN HEALTH with at least three (3) months’
prior notice of all in-market Product and Related Product campaigns and shall provide ZO SKIN HEALTH with such reports of
its other activities, competitor activities, and other information regarding the Products and Related Products and the markets for
them in the Territory in such detail and with such frequency as ZO SKIN HEALTH shall reasonably require from time to time. In
order to help ZO SKIN HEALTH provide inventory on a timely and consistent basis to Distributor, Distributor agrees to provide
to ZO SKIN HEALTH on a quarterly basis, a binding three (3) month rolling forward minimum unit-based shipping forecast, as
well as an estimated twelve (12) month rolling forecast of Distributor’s projected purchase orders on the form attached hereto as
Exhibit B, which form, including the information to be contained therein, may be amended by ZO from time to time. Distributor’s
provision  of  the  above-mentioned  estimated  forecast  shall  not  be  interpreted  as  a  commitment  from  Distributor  to  buy  any
Products or Related Products in excess of Distributor’s Minimum Purchase Requirement, unless otherwise agreed to in writing by
the Parties; provided, that, ZO may refuse to ship Products to Distributor, in ZO’s sole discretion, in the event they exceed any
forecast in order to ensure availability of Products to other territories, including the United States.”

(d)

Section 4.10. of the Existing Agreement is hereby deleted in its entirety and replaced with the following:

“4.10.        Free  Goods  and  Discounts.  During  the  term  of  this  Agreement,  ZO  SKIN  HEALTH  will  provide  to  Distributor:  (a)
XXX%  of  Net  Sales  worth  as  Free  Goods  and  Related  Products  and  collaterals;  and  (b)  a  XXX%  discount  on  the  Distributor
Purchase  Prices  of  Products  and  Related  Products  set  forth  in  Exhibit  A-1.  Free  Goods  allowances  and  discounts  will  be
calculated on each order and shall not roll-over from one order to the next, or form one year to the next.

In  addition  to  the  foregoing,  for  calendar  year  2022  only,  ZO  SKIN  HEALTH  will  provide  Distributor  with  a  one-time,
incremental  discount  in  the  aggregate  of  $XXX,  which  shall  be  calculated  as  an  incremental  XXX%  discount  on  Distributor’s
first $XXX of purchases made in 2022 for ZO SKIN HEALTH Products and Related Products.”

(e)

Exhibit A of the Existing Agreement is hereby deleted in its entirety and replaced with Exhibit A as attached hereto.

3. Date of Effectiveness; Limited Effect. This Amendment will become effective as of the Amendment Effective Date. Except as expressly
provided in this Amendment, all of the terms and provisions of the Existing Agreement are and will remain in full force and effect and are
hereby ratified and confirmed by the Parties. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the amendments contained

herein will not be construed as an amendment to or waiver of any other provision of the Existing Agreement or as a waiver of or consent to
any  further  or  future  action  on  the  part  of  either  Party  that  would  require  the  waiver  or  consent  of  the  other  Party.  On  and  after  the
Amendment  Effective  Date,  each  reference  in  the  Existing  Agreement  to  “this  Agreement,”  “the  Agreement,”  “hereunder,”  “hereof,”
“herein,” or words of like import, and each reference to the Existing Agreement in any other agreements, documents, or instruments executed
and delivered pursuant to, or in connection with, the Existing Agreement, will mean and be a reference to the Existing Agreement as amended
by this Amendment.

4. Miscellaneous.

(a)
conflict of laws provisions of such State.

This  Amendment  is  governed  by  and  construed  in  accordance  with,  the  laws  of  the  State  of  California,  without  regard  to  the

(b)
successors and permitted assigns.

This  Amendment  shall  inure  to  the  benefit  of  and  be  binding  upon  each  of  the  Parties  and  each  of  their  respective  permitted

(c)

The headings in this Amendment are for reference only and do not affect the interpretation of this Amendment.

(d)
This Amendment may be executed in counterparts, each of which is deemed an original, but all of which constitute one and the
same agreement. Delivery of an executed counterpart of this Amendment electronically or by facsimile shall be effective as delivery of an
original executed counterpart of this Amendment.

(e)
This Amendment constitutes the sole and entire agreement between the Parties with respect to the subject matter contained herein,
and supersedes all prior and contemporaneous understandings, agreements, representations, and warranties, both written and oral, with
respect to such subject matter.

[REMAINDER OF THIS SECTION SHALL REMAIN BLANK]

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Amendment on the date first written above.

ZO SKIN HEALTH, INC.

CUTERA, INC.

EXHIBIT A

PRODUCTS, TERRITORY, MINIMUMS

A.

Products. Attached hereto as Exhibit A-1 shall be a list of the ZO Skin Health products subject to this Distribution
Agreement. This product list is non-exhaustive and is subject to modification and change at the sole discretion of ZO at any time
pursuant to the terms of this Agreement; further, travel size versions of the foregoing may be available at pricing to be provided
by ZO from time to time. Additionally, pricing specified in Exhibit A-1 will be then current pricing at the time the list is provided to
Distributor. Pricing is subject to change at ZO’s sole discretion pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.

B.

Territory.  The  territory  shall  be  Japan  and  any  other  territory  designated  by  ZO  in  writing  and  agreed  to  by

distributor for the exercise of Distributor’s rights and obligations in the Distributor Agreement.

C.

Distributor Minimum Purchase Requirements. Distributor Minimum Purchase Requirements of Products within

the Territory shall be:

Year
2021
2022
2023 and beyond

Minimum Purchase Requirement
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

ZO’s remedies for Distributor’s failure to meet the Minimum Purchase Requirements of Products and Related Products are set
forth in Section 4.1 of this Agreement. The above dollar amounts refer to United States Currency.

EXHIBIT A-1

PRODUCT LIST

ITEM NO.

PRODUCT DESCRIPTION

SIZE

Suggested
Retail Price

Suggested Price
to Customers

DISTRIBUTOR PRICE

GETTING SKIN READY®

962000

965000

900300

900400
900500
928000
900800

920500

Exfoliating Cleanser Normal to Oily

Hydrating Cleanser Normal to Dry

Gentle Cleanser All Skin Types

Exfoliating Polish
Dual Action Scrub
Complexion Renewal Pads
Oil Control Pads
Calming Toner pH Balancer

PREVENT + CORRECT

905400

906000

Pigment Control Crème (4% HQ)
Pigment Control + Brightening Crème (4% HQ +
20% Vit C)

905700
Pigment Control & Blending Crème (4% HQ)
904200
Daily Power Defense
904400
Growth Factor Serum
Firming Serum
912700
918400 Wrinkle + Texture Repair

200 mL / 6.7 Fl. Oz.

200 mL / 6.7 Fl. Oz.

200 mL / 6.7 Fl. Oz.

65 g / 2.3 Oz.
116 g / 4 Oz
60 Pads
60 Pads

180 mL / 6 Fl. Oz.

80 mL / 2.7 Fl. Oz.

81 mL / 2.8 Fl. Oz.

80 mL / 2.7 Fl. Oz.
50 mL / 1.7 Fl. Oz.
30 mL / 1 Fl. Oz.
47 mL / 1.6 Fl. Oz.
50 mL / 1.7 FL. Oz

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

 
 
 
 
 
904000
904000
905200

Radical Night Repair
10% Vitamin C
Exfoliation Accelerator

941800

Instant Pore Refiner

905100

Enzymatic Peel

940700

950500
950300
950400
907000
930700
907100
907200

907400

PROTECT
919300
902700
902400
903400
972400
972500

®
Brightalive

Retinol Skin Brightener (1%)
Retinol Skin Brightener (0.5%)
Retinol Skin Brightener (0.25%)
Acne Control
Complexion Clearing Masque

Correct & Conceal Acne Treatment - Light

Correct & Conceal Acne Treatment - Medium

®
Rozatrol

Sunscreen + Primer SPF 30
Smart Tone Broad Spectrum SPF 50
Daily Sheer Broad Spectrum SPF 50
Broad Spectrum Sunscreen SPF 50
Sunscreen + Powder SPF 30 - Light
Sunscreen + Powder SPF 30 - Medium

60 mL / 2 Fl. Oz.
50 mL / 1.7 Oz.
50 mL /1.7 FL. Oz
 29 g / 1 Oz.

50 mL / 1.7 Oz.

50 mL / 1.7 Oz.

50 mL /1.7 FL. Oz
50 mL /1.7 FL. Oz
50 mL /1.7 FL. Oz
60 mL / 2 Fl. Oz.
85 g / 3 Oz.
2.3 g / .09 Oz
2.3 g / .09 Oz

50 mL / 1.7 Oz.

30 mL / 1 Fl. Oz.
45 mL / 1.5 Fl. Oz.
45 mL / 1.5 Fl. Oz.
118 g / 4 Fl. Oz.
2.7 g / 0.09 Oz.
2.7 g / 0.09 Oz.

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

 
972600

Sunscreen + Powder SPF 30 – Deep

2.7 g / 0.09 Oz.

SUPPLEMENTARY

950200
950100
915300
907700
907600
907900
918300
940300

Renewal Crème
Recovery Crème
Hydrating Crème
Cellulite Control
Body Emulsion
Intense Eye Repair
Eye Brightening Crème
Growth Factor Eye Serum

PROGRAMS + KITS

912100

926400

926300

909400

926500

969000
973330
913100

910500

Daily Skincare Program

Anti-Aging Program

Aggressive Anti-Aging Program

Skin Normalizing System

Complexion Clearing Program

Skin Brightening Program
Skin Brightening Program + Texture
3 Step Peel

® 

ZO Controlled Depth Peel  Kit

®

50 mL / 1.7 Fl. Oz.
50 mL / 1.7 Fl. Oz.
113 g / 4 Oz.
150 g / 5.3 Oz.
240 mL / 8 Fl Oz.
15 mL / 0.5 Fl. Oz.
15 g / 0.5 Oz.
15 mL / 0.5 Fl. Oz.

4 Product Regimen

5 Product Regimen

6 Product Regimen

5 Product Regimen

5 Product Regimen

5 Product Regimen
4 Product Regimen
6 peels

12 peels

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX

$XXX
$XXX
$XXX

$XXX

* This product list is non-exhaustive and is subject to modification and change at the sole discretion of ZO.

 
EXHIBIT B

PURCHASE ORDER AND ROLLING FORECAST FORM

[To be provided by ZO SKIN HEALTH from time to time.]

* Note: Forms are subject to change.

EXHIBIT E

BUSINESS PLAN GUIDELINES

1. Distributor Mission Statement

2. ZO  Brand  Positioning  in  the  market  and  in  the  Distributors  product  line,  including  all  Distributor  product  and  service

offerings, whether by Distributor or its affiliates

3. Currently Targeted Sales Channels – XXX

4. Financial Summary

◦ Including without limitation XXX

5. Strategy

◦ XXX

6. Market Analysis

◦ XXX
◦ Current number of XXX
◦ Distributor estimation of XXX

7. Business Expansion Strategy

◦ XXX

8. Operations

◦ Distribution Center and all information pertaining to operations

9. Management Structure

10. Organizational Structure

◦ XXX

If the Distributor’s Territory includes more than one country, the above information shall be provided separately for each country.

* ZO may update these Business Plan Guidelines from time to time.

EXHIBIT G

MONTHLY REPORTING GUIDELINES

* This list is non-exhaustive and may be updated by ZO from time to time.

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Exhibit 23.1

Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form S-3 (No. 333-237552) and Form S-8 (No. 333-114149, 333-
123495, 333-132583, 333-141376, 333-149703, 333-158160, 333-187502, 333-206864, 333-221542, and 333-258283) of Cutera, Inc. of our reports dated
March  1,  2022,  relating  to  the  consolidated  financial  statements  and  schedule,  and  the  effectiveness  of  Cutera,  Inc.’s  internal  control  over  financial
reporting, which appear in this Form 10-K.

/s/ BDO USA, LLP
San Francisco, California

March 1, 2022

CERTIFICATION OF CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241, AS
ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 31.3

I, David H. Mowry, certify that:

1.

2.

3.

4.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc.:

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
report;

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the
financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-
15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under the Company’s
supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to the Company by
others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under the
Company’s supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for
external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report the Company’s conclusions about the
effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent
fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially
affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5.

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on the Company’s most recent evaluation of internal control over financial
reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably
likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control
over financial reporting.

Date: March 1, 2022

 /s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)

CERTIFICATION OF CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241, AS
ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 31.4

I, Rohan Seth, certify that:

1.

2.

3.

4.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc.:

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
report;

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the
financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-
15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under the Company’s
supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to the Company by
others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under the
Company’s supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for
external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report the Company’s conclusions about the
effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent
fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially
affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5.

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on the Company’s most recent evaluation of internal control over financial
reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably
likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control
over financial reporting.

Date: March 1, 2022

 /s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and
Accounting Officer)

CERTIFICATION OF
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER AND CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

Exhibit 32.1

In connection with the annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc. a Delaware corporation, for the period ended December 31, 2021, as filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission, each of the undersigned officers of Cutera, Inc. certifies pursuant to section 1350 of chapter 63 of title 18 of the
United States Code, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to his respective knowledge:

(1)

(2)

the annual report of Cutera, Inc. on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2021, fully complies with the requirements of
Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and
the information contained in the annual report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations
of Cutera, Inc. for the periods presented therein.

Date: March 1, 2022

Date: March 1, 2022

 /s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)

 /s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and
Accounting Officer)